* gdb.texinfo: Change the introduce of "disassemble-next-line".
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Software development
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @copying
47 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996,
48 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009
49 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
50
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
54 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
55 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
56 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
57
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
59 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
61 @end copying
62
63 @ifnottex
64 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
65
66 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
67 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
68 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
69 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
70 @end ifset
71 Version @value{GDBVN}.
72
73 @insertcopying
74 @end ifnottex
75
76 @titlepage
77 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
78 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
79 @sp 1
80 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
81 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
82 @sp 1
83 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
84 @end ifset
85 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
86 @page
87 @tex
88 {\parskip=0pt
89 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
90 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
91 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
92 }
93 @end tex
94
95 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
96 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
97 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
98 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
99 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
100
101 @insertcopying
102 @page
103 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
104 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
105 software in general. We will miss him.
106 @end titlepage
107 @page
108
109 @ifnottex
110 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
111
112 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
113
114 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
115
116 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
117 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
118 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
119 @end ifset
120 Version @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
125 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
126 software in general. We will miss him.
127
128 @menu
129 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
130 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
131
132 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
133 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
134 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
135 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
136 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
137 * Stack:: Examining the stack
138 * Source:: Examining source files
139 * Data:: Examining data
140 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
141 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
142 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
143
144 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
145
146 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
147 * Altering:: Altering execution
148 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
149 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
150 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
151 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
152 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
153 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
154 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
155 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
156 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
157 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
158 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
159
160 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
161
162 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
163 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
164 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
165 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
166 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
167 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
168 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
169 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
170 @value{GDBN}
171 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
172 the operating system
173 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
174 how you can copy and share GDB
175 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
176 * Index:: Index
177 @end menu
178
179 @end ifnottex
180
181 @contents
182
183 @node Summary
184 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
185
186 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
187 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
188 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
189
190 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
191 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
192
193 @itemize @bullet
194 @item
195 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
196
197 @item
198 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
199
200 @item
201 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
202
203 @item
204 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
205 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
206 @end itemize
207
208 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
209 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
210 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
211
212 @cindex Modula-2
213 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
214 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
215
216 @cindex Pascal
217 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
218 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
219 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
220 syntax.
221
222 @cindex Fortran
223 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
224 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
225 underscore.
226
227 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
228 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
229
230 @menu
231 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
232 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
233 @end menu
234
235 @node Free Software
236 @unnumberedsec Free Software
237
238 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
239 General Public License
240 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
241 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
242 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
243 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
244 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
245 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
246
247 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
248 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
249 from anyone else.
250
251 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
252
253 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
254 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
255 include with the free software. Many of our most important
256 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
257 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
258 when an important free software package does not come with a free
259 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
260 gaps today.
261
262 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
263 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
264 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
265 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
266 them from the free software world.
267
268 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
269 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
270 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
271 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
272 contract to make it non-free.
273
274 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
275 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
276 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
277 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
278 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
279 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
280 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
281
282 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
283 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
284 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
285 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
286
287 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
288 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
289 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
290 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
291 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
292 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
293 community.
294
295 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
296 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
297 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
298 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
299 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
300 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
301 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
302 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
303 of the manual.
304
305 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
306 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
307 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
308 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
309 manual to replace it.
310
311 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
312 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
313 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
314 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
315 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
316 the free software community.
317
318 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
319 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
320 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
321 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
322 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
323 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
324 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
325 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
326 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
327
328 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
329 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
330 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
331 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
332 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
333 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
334 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
335 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
336
337 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
338 published by other publishers, at
339 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
340
341 @node Contributors
342 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
343
344 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
345 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
346 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
347 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
348 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
349 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
350 blow-by-blow account.
351
352 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
353
354 @quotation
355 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
356 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
357 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
358 @end quotation
359
360 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
361 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
362 releases:
363 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
364 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
365 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
366 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
367 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
368 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
369 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
370 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
371 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
372
373 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
374 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
375
376 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
377 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
378 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
379 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
380 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
381
382 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
383 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
384 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
385
386 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
387 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
388
389 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
390
391 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
392 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
393 support.
394 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
395 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
396 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
397 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
398 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
399 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
400 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
401 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
402 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
403 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
404 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
405 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
406 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
407 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
408 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
409 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
410
411 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
412
413 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
414 libraries.
415
416 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
417 about several machine instruction sets.
418
419 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
420 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
421 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
422 and RDI targets, respectively.
423
424 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
425 command-line editing and command history.
426
427 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
428 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
429
430 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
431 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
432 symbols.
433
434 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
435 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
436
437 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
438
439 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
440 processors.
441
442 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
443
444 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
445
446 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
447
448 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
449 watchpoints.
450
451 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
452
453 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
454
455 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
456 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
457
458 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
459 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
460 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
461 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
462 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
463 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
464 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
465
466 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
467 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
468
469 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
470 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
471 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
472 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
473 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
474 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
475 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
476 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
477 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
478 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
479 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
480 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
481 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
482 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
483 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
484
485 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
486 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
487
488 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
489 Hat.
490
491 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
492 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
493 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
494 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
495 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
496 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
497
498 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
499 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
500 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
501 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
502 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
503 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
504 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
505 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
506 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
507 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
508 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
509 Weigand.
510
511 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
512 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
513 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
514 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
515
516 @node Sample Session
517 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
518
519 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
520 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
521 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
522
523 @iftex
524 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
525 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
526 @end iftex
527
528 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
529 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
530
531 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
532 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
533 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
534 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
535 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
536 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
537 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
538 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
539 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
540
541 @smallexample
542 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
543 $ @b{./m4}
544 @b{define(foo,0000)}
545
546 @b{foo}
547 0000
548 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
549
550 @b{bar}
551 0000
552 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
553
554 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
555 @b{baz}
556 @b{Ctrl-d}
557 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
558 @end smallexample
559
560 @noindent
561 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
562
563 @smallexample
564 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
565 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
566 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
567 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
568 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
569 the conditions.
570 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
571 for details.
572
573 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
574 (@value{GDBP})
575 @end smallexample
576
577 @noindent
578 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
579 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
580 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
581 that examples fit in this manual.
582
583 @smallexample
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
585 @end smallexample
586
587 @noindent
588 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
589 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
590 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
591 @code{break} command.
592
593 @smallexample
594 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
595 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
600 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
601 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
602
603 @smallexample
604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
605 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
606 @b{define(foo,0000)}
607
608 @b{foo}
609 0000
610 @end smallexample
611
612 @noindent
613 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
614 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
615 context where it stops.
616
617 @smallexample
618 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
619
620 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
621 at builtin.c:879
622 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
627 the next line of the current function.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
632 : nil,
633 @end smallexample
634
635 @noindent
636 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
637 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
638 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
639 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
643 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
644 at input.c:530
645 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
646 @end smallexample
647
648 @noindent
649 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
650 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
651 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
652 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
653 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
654 stack frame for each active subroutine.
655
656 @smallexample
657 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
658 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
659 at input.c:530
660 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
661 at builtin.c:882
662 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
663 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
664 at macro.c:71
665 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
666 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
671 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
672 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
673
674 @smallexample
675 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
676 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
677 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
678 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
679 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
681 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
682 : xstrdup(rq);
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
685 @end smallexample
686
687 @noindent
688 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
689 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
690 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
691 (@code{print}) to see their values.
692
693 @smallexample
694 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
695 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
697 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
698 @end smallexample
699
700 @noindent
701 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
702 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
703 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
704
705 @smallexample
706 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
707 533 xfree(rquote);
708 534
709 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
710 : xstrdup (lq);
711 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
712 : xstrdup (rq);
713 537
714 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
715 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
716 540 @}
717 541
718 542 void
719 @end smallexample
720
721 @noindent
722 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
723 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
724
725 @smallexample
726 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
727 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
728 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
729 540 @}
730 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
731 $3 = 9
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
733 $4 = 7
734 @end smallexample
735
736 @noindent
737 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
738 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
739 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
740 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
741 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
742 assignments.
743
744 @smallexample
745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
746 $5 = 7
747 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
748 $6 = 9
749 @end smallexample
750
751 @noindent
752 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
753 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
754 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
755 example that caused trouble initially:
756
757 @smallexample
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
759 Continuing.
760
761 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
762
763 baz
764 0000
765 @end smallexample
766
767 @noindent
768 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
769 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
770 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
771
772 @smallexample
773 @b{Ctrl-d}
774 Program exited normally.
775 @end smallexample
776
777 @noindent
778 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
779 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
780 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
784 @end smallexample
785
786 @node Invocation
787 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
788
789 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
790 The essentials are:
791 @itemize @bullet
792 @item
793 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
794 @item
795 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
796 @end itemize
797
798 @menu
799 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
800 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
801 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
802 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
803 @end menu
804
805 @node Invoking GDB
806 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
807
808 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
809 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
810
811 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
812 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
813
814 The command-line options described here are designed
815 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
816 options may effectively be unavailable.
817
818 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
819 specifying an executable program:
820
821 @smallexample
822 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
823 @end smallexample
824
825 @noindent
826 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
827 specified:
828
829 @smallexample
830 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
831 @end smallexample
832
833 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
834 to debug a running process:
835
836 @smallexample
837 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
838 @end smallexample
839
840 @noindent
841 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
842 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
843
844 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
845 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
846 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
847 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
848 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
849
850 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
851 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
852 option processing.
853 @smallexample
854 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
855 @end smallexample
856 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
857 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
858
859 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
860 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
861
862 @smallexample
863 @value{GDBP} -silent
864 @end smallexample
865
866 @noindent
867 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
868 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
869
870 @noindent
871 Type
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} -help
875 @end smallexample
876
877 @noindent
878 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
879 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
880
881 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
882 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
883 @samp{-x} option is used.
884
885
886 @menu
887 * File Options:: Choosing files
888 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
889 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
890 @end menu
891
892 @node File Options
893 @subsection Choosing Files
894
895 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
896 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
897 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
898 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
899 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
900 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
901 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
902 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
903 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
904 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
905 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
906 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
907 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
908
909 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
910 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
911 argument and ignore it.
912
913 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
914 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
915 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
916 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
917 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
918
919 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
920 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
921 @c it.
922
923 @table @code
924 @item -symbols @var{file}
925 @itemx -s @var{file}
926 @cindex @code{--symbols}
927 @cindex @code{-s}
928 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
929
930 @item -exec @var{file}
931 @itemx -e @var{file}
932 @cindex @code{--exec}
933 @cindex @code{-e}
934 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
935 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
936
937 @item -se @var{file}
938 @cindex @code{--se}
939 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
940 file.
941
942 @item -core @var{file}
943 @itemx -c @var{file}
944 @cindex @code{--core}
945 @cindex @code{-c}
946 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
947
948 @item -pid @var{number}
949 @itemx -p @var{number}
950 @cindex @code{--pid}
951 @cindex @code{-p}
952 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
953
954 @item -command @var{file}
955 @itemx -x @var{file}
956 @cindex @code{--command}
957 @cindex @code{-x}
958 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
959 Files,, Command files}.
960
961 @item -eval-command @var{command}
962 @itemx -ex @var{command}
963 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
964 @cindex @code{-ex}
965 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
966
967 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
968 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
969
970 @smallexample
971 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
972 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
973 @end smallexample
974
975 @item -directory @var{directory}
976 @itemx -d @var{directory}
977 @cindex @code{--directory}
978 @cindex @code{-d}
979 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
980
981 @item -r
982 @itemx -readnow
983 @cindex @code{--readnow}
984 @cindex @code{-r}
985 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
986 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
987 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
988
989 @end table
990
991 @node Mode Options
992 @subsection Choosing Modes
993
994 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
995 batch mode or quiet mode.
996
997 @table @code
998 @item -nx
999 @itemx -n
1000 @cindex @code{--nx}
1001 @cindex @code{-n}
1002 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
1003 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
1004 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
1005 Files}.
1006
1007 @item -quiet
1008 @itemx -silent
1009 @itemx -q
1010 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1011 @cindex @code{--silent}
1012 @cindex @code{-q}
1013 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1014 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1015
1016 @item -batch
1017 @cindex @code{--batch}
1018 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1019 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1020 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1021 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1022 in the command files.
1023
1024 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1025 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1026 make this more useful, the message
1027
1028 @smallexample
1029 Program exited normally.
1030 @end smallexample
1031
1032 @noindent
1033 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1034 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1035 mode.
1036
1037 @item -batch-silent
1038 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1039 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1040 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1041 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1042 for an interactive session.
1043
1044 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1045 messages, for example.
1046
1047 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1048 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1049
1050 @item -return-child-result
1051 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1052 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1053 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1054
1055 @itemize @bullet
1056 @item
1057 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1058 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1059 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1060 @item
1061 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1062 @item
1063 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1064 the exit code will be -1.
1065 @end itemize
1066
1067 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1068 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1069 interface.
1070
1071 @item -nowindows
1072 @itemx -nw
1073 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1074 @cindex @code{-nw}
1075 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1076 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1077 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1078
1079 @item -windows
1080 @itemx -w
1081 @cindex @code{--windows}
1082 @cindex @code{-w}
1083 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1084 used if possible.
1085
1086 @item -cd @var{directory}
1087 @cindex @code{--cd}
1088 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1089 instead of the current directory.
1090
1091 @item -fullname
1092 @itemx -f
1093 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1094 @cindex @code{-f}
1095 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1096 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1097 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1098 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1099 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1100 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1101 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1102 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1103 frame.
1104
1105 @item -epoch
1106 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1107 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1108 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1109 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1110 separate window.
1111
1112 @item -annotate @var{level}
1113 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1114 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1115 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1116 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1117 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1118 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1119 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1120 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1121 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1122
1123 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1124 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1125
1126 @item --args
1127 @cindex @code{--args}
1128 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1129 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1130 This option stops option processing.
1131
1132 @item -baud @var{bps}
1133 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1134 @cindex @code{--baud}
1135 @cindex @code{-b}
1136 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1137 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1138
1139 @item -l @var{timeout}
1140 @cindex @code{-l}
1141 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1142 for remote debugging.
1143
1144 @item -tty @var{device}
1145 @itemx -t @var{device}
1146 @cindex @code{--tty}
1147 @cindex @code{-t}
1148 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1149 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1150
1151 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1152 @item -tui
1153 @cindex @code{--tui}
1154 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1155 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1156 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1157 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Alternatively, the
1158 Text User Interface can be enabled by invoking the program
1159 @samp{@value{GDBTUI}}. Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from
1160 Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1161
1162 @c @item -xdb
1163 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1164 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1165 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1166 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1167 @c systems.
1168
1169 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1170 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1171 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1172 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1173 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1174 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1175
1176 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1177 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1178 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1179 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1180 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1181 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1182
1183 @item -write
1184 @cindex @code{--write}
1185 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1186 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1187 (@pxref{Patching}).
1188
1189 @item -statistics
1190 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1191 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1192 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1193
1194 @item -version
1195 @cindex @code{--version}
1196 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1197 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1198
1199 @end table
1200
1201 @node Startup
1202 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1203 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1204
1205 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1206
1207 @enumerate
1208 @item
1209 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1210 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1211
1212 @item
1213 @cindex init file
1214 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1215 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1216 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1217 that file.
1218
1219 @item
1220 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1221 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1222 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1223 that file.
1224
1225 @item
1226 Processes command line options and operands.
1227
1228 @item
1229 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1230 working directory. This is only done if the current directory is
1231 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1232 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1233 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1234 @value{GDBN}.
1235
1236 @item
1237 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option. @xref{Command
1238 Files}, for more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1239
1240 @item
1241 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1242 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1243 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1244 @end enumerate
1245
1246 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1247 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1248 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1249 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1250 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1251 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1252
1253 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1254 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1255
1256 @cindex init file name
1257 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1258 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1259 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1260 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1261 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1262 ports of @value{GDBN} use the standard name, but if they find a
1263 @file{gdb.ini} file, they warn you about that and suggest to rename
1264 the file to the standard name.
1265
1266
1267 @node Quitting GDB
1268 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1269 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1270 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1271
1272 @table @code
1273 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1274 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1275 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1276 @itemx q
1277 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1278 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1279 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1280 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1281 error code.
1282 @end table
1283
1284 @cindex interrupt
1285 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1286 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1287 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1288 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1289 until a time when it is safe.
1290
1291 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1292 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1293 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1294
1295 @node Shell Commands
1296 @section Shell Commands
1297
1298 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1299 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1300 just use the @code{shell} command.
1301
1302 @table @code
1303 @kindex shell
1304 @cindex shell escape
1305 @item shell @var{command string}
1306 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1307 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1308 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1309 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1310 @end table
1311
1312 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1313 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1314 @value{GDBN}:
1315
1316 @table @code
1317 @kindex make
1318 @cindex calling make
1319 @item make @var{make-args}
1320 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1321 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1322 @end table
1323
1324 @node Logging Output
1325 @section Logging Output
1326 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1327 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1328
1329 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1330 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1331
1332 @table @code
1333 @kindex set logging
1334 @item set logging on
1335 Enable logging.
1336 @item set logging off
1337 Disable logging.
1338 @cindex logging file name
1339 @item set logging file @var{file}
1340 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1341 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1342 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1343 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1344 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1345 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1346 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1347 @kindex show logging
1348 @item show logging
1349 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1350 @end table
1351
1352 @node Commands
1353 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1354
1355 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1356 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1357 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1358 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1359 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1360
1361 @menu
1362 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1363 * Completion:: Command completion
1364 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1365 @end menu
1366
1367 @node Command Syntax
1368 @section Command Syntax
1369
1370 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1371 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1372 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1373 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1374 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1375 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1376
1377 @cindex abbreviation
1378 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1379 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1380 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1381 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1382 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1383 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1384 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1385
1386 @cindex repeating commands
1387 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1388 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1389 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1390 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1391 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1392 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1393 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1394
1395 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1396 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1397 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1398
1399 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1400 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1401 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1402 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1403 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1404
1405 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1406 @cindex comment
1407 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1408 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1409 Files,,Command Files}).
1410
1411 @cindex repeating command sequences
1412 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1413 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1414 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1415 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1416 for editing.
1417
1418 @node Completion
1419 @section Command Completion
1420
1421 @cindex completion
1422 @cindex word completion
1423 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1424 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1425 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1426 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1427
1428 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1429 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1430 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1431 enter it). For example, if you type
1432
1433 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1434 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1435 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1436 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1437 @smallexample
1438 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1439 @end smallexample
1440
1441 @noindent
1442 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1443 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1444
1445 @smallexample
1446 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1447 @end smallexample
1448
1449 @noindent
1450 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1451 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1452 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1453 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1454 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1455 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1456
1457 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1458 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1459 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1460 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1461 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1462 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1463 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1464 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1465 example:
1466
1467 @smallexample
1468 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1469 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1470 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1471 make_abs_section make_function_type
1472 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1473 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1474 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1475 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1476 @end smallexample
1477
1478 @noindent
1479 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1480 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1481 command.
1482
1483 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1484 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1485 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1486 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1487 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1488
1489 @cindex quotes in commands
1490 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1491 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1492 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1493 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1494 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1495 @value{GDBN} commands.
1496
1497 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1498 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1499 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1500 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1501 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1502 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1503 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1504 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1505 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1506 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1507 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1508
1509 @smallexample
1510 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1511 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1512 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1513 @end smallexample
1514
1515 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1516 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1517 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1518 place:
1519
1520 @smallexample
1521 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1522 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1523 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1524 @end smallexample
1525
1526 @noindent
1527 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1528 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1529 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1530
1531 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1532 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1533 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1534 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1535
1536 @cindex completion of structure field names
1537 @cindex structure field name completion
1538 @cindex completion of union field names
1539 @cindex union field name completion
1540 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1541 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1542 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1543 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1544 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1545 left-hand-side:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1549 magic to_delete to_fputs to_put to_rewind
1550 to_data to_flush to_isatty to_read to_write
1551 @end smallexample
1552
1553 @noindent
1554 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1555 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1556 follows:
1557
1558 @smallexample
1559 struct ui_file
1560 @{
1561 int *magic;
1562 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1563 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1564 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1565 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1566 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1567 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1568 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1569 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1570 void *to_data;
1571 @}
1572 @end smallexample
1573
1574
1575 @node Help
1576 @section Getting Help
1577 @cindex online documentation
1578 @kindex help
1579
1580 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1581 using the command @code{help}.
1582
1583 @table @code
1584 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1585 @item help
1586 @itemx h
1587 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1588 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1589
1590 @smallexample
1591 (@value{GDBP}) help
1592 List of classes of commands:
1593
1594 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1595 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1596 data -- Examining data
1597 files -- Specifying and examining files
1598 internals -- Maintenance commands
1599 obscure -- Obscure features
1600 running -- Running the program
1601 stack -- Examining the stack
1602 status -- Status inquiries
1603 support -- Support facilities
1604 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1605 stopping the program
1606 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1607
1608 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1609 commands in that class.
1610 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1611 documentation.
1612 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1613 (@value{GDBP})
1614 @end smallexample
1615 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1616
1617 @item help @var{class}
1618 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1619 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1620 help display for the class @code{status}:
1621
1622 @smallexample
1623 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1624 Status inquiries.
1625
1626 List of commands:
1627
1628 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1629 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1630 info -- Generic command for showing things
1631 about the program being debugged
1632 show -- Generic command for showing things
1633 about the debugger
1634
1635 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1636 documentation.
1637 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1638 (@value{GDBP})
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 @item help @var{command}
1642 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1643 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1644
1645 @kindex apropos
1646 @item apropos @var{args}
1647 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1648 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1649 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1650
1651 @smallexample
1652 apropos reload
1653 @end smallexample
1654
1655 @noindent
1656 results in:
1657
1658 @smallexample
1659 @c @group
1660 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1661 multiple times in one run
1662 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1663 multiple times in one run
1664 @c @end group
1665 @end smallexample
1666
1667 @kindex complete
1668 @item complete @var{args}
1669 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1670 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1671 command you want completed. For example:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 complete i
1675 @end smallexample
1676
1677 @noindent results in:
1678
1679 @smallexample
1680 @group
1681 if
1682 ignore
1683 info
1684 inspect
1685 @end group
1686 @end smallexample
1687
1688 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1689 @end table
1690
1691 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1692 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1693 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1694 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1695 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1696 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1697
1698 @c @group
1699 @table @code
1700 @kindex info
1701 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1702 @item info
1703 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1704 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1705 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1706 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1707 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1708 @w{@code{help info}}.
1709
1710 @kindex set
1711 @item set
1712 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1713 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1714 @code{set prompt $}.
1715
1716 @kindex show
1717 @item show
1718 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1719 @value{GDBN} itself.
1720 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1721 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1722 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1723 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1724
1725 @kindex info set
1726 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1727 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1728 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1729 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1730 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1731 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1732 @end table
1733 @c @end group
1734
1735 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1736 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1737
1738 @table @code
1739 @kindex show version
1740 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1741 @item show version
1742 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1743 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1744 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1745 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1746 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1747 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1748 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1749 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1750 @value{GDBN}.
1751
1752 @kindex show copying
1753 @kindex info copying
1754 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1755 @item show copying
1756 @itemx info copying
1757 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1758
1759 @kindex show warranty
1760 @kindex info warranty
1761 @item show warranty
1762 @itemx info warranty
1763 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1764 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1765
1766 @end table
1767
1768 @node Running
1769 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1770
1771 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1772 debugging information when you compile it.
1773
1774 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1775 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1776 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1777 kill a child process.
1778
1779 @menu
1780 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1781 * Starting:: Starting your program
1782 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1783 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1784
1785 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1786 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1787 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1788 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1789
1790 * Inferiors:: Debugging multiple inferiors
1791 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1792 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1793 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1794 @end menu
1795
1796 @node Compilation
1797 @section Compiling for Debugging
1798
1799 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1800 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1801 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1802 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1803 and addresses in the executable code.
1804
1805 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1806 the compiler.
1807
1808 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1809 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, many
1810 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1811 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1812 executables containing debugging information.
1813
1814 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1815 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1816 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1817 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1818 in pushing your luck.
1819
1820 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1821 @cindex debugging optimized code
1822 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1823 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1824 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1825 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1826 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1827 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1828
1829 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1830 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1831 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1832 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1833 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
1834
1835 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1836 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1837 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1838
1839 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1840 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1841 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1842 the @option{-g} flag alone, because this information is rather large.
1843 Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
1844 provides macro information if you specify the options
1845 @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1846 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1847 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact
1848 ways to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1849 @option{-g} alone.
1850
1851 @need 2000
1852 @node Starting
1853 @section Starting your Program
1854 @cindex starting
1855 @cindex running
1856
1857 @table @code
1858 @kindex run
1859 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1860 @item run
1861 @itemx r
1862 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1863 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1864 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1865 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1866 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
1867
1868 @end table
1869
1870 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1871 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1872 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
1873 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
1874 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
1875 message like this one:
1876
1877 @smallexample
1878 The "remote" target does not support "run".
1879 Try "help target" or "continue".
1880 @end smallexample
1881
1882 @noindent
1883 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
1884 first (@pxref{load}).
1885
1886 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1887 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1888 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1889 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1890 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1891 divided into four categories:
1892
1893 @table @asis
1894 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1895 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1896 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1897 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1898 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1899 the arguments.
1900 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1901 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1902 @xref{Arguments, ,Your Program's Arguments}.
1903
1904 @item The @emph{environment.}
1905 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1906 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1907 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1908 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
1909
1910 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1911 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1912 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1913 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
1914
1915 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1916 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1917 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1918 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1919 set a different device for your program.
1920 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
1921
1922 @cindex pipes
1923 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1924 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1925 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1926 wrong program.
1927 @end table
1928
1929 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1930 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
1931 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1932 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1933 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1934
1935 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1936 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1937 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1938 your current breakpoints.
1939
1940 @table @code
1941 @kindex start
1942 @item start
1943 @cindex run to main procedure
1944 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
1945 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
1946 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
1947 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
1948 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
1949 procedure, depending on the language used.
1950
1951 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
1952 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
1953 the @samp{run} command.
1954
1955 @cindex elaboration phase
1956 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
1957 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
1958 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
1959 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
1960 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
1961 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
1962 will remain to halt execution.
1963
1964 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
1965 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
1966 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
1967 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
1968 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
1969
1970 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
1971 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
1972 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
1973 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
1974 elaboration code before running your program.
1975
1976 @kindex set exec-wrapper
1977 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
1978 @itemx show exec-wrapper
1979 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
1980 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
1981 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
1982 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
1983 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
1984 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
1985 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
1986 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
1987
1988 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
1989 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
1990 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
1991 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
1992
1993 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
1994 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
1995 environment:
1996
1997 @smallexample
1998 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
1999 (@value{GDBP}) run
2000 @end smallexample
2001
2002 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2003 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2004
2005 @kindex set disable-randomization
2006 @item set disable-randomization
2007 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2008 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2009 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2010 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2011 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2012
2013 This feature is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux. You can get the same
2014 behavior using
2015
2016 @smallexample
2017 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2018 @end smallexample
2019
2020 @item set disable-randomization off
2021 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2022 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2023 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2024 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2025 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2026 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2027
2028 The virtual address space randomization is implemented only on @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2029 It protects the programs against some kinds of security attacks. In these
2030 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2031 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2032 a code at its expected addresses.
2033
2034 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2035 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2036 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2037 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2038 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2039 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2040 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2041 a randomly chosen address.
2042
2043 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2044 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2045 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2046 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2047 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2048
2049 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2050 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2051
2052 @item show disable-randomization
2053 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2054 the virtual address space of the started program.
2055
2056 @end table
2057
2058 @node Arguments
2059 @section Your Program's Arguments
2060
2061 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2062 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2063 @code{run} command.
2064 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2065 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2066 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2067 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2068 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2069
2070 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2071 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2072 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2073 the program, not by the shell.
2074
2075 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2076 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2077
2078 @table @code
2079 @kindex set args
2080 @item set args
2081 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2082 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2083 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2084 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2085 it again without arguments.
2086
2087 @kindex show args
2088 @item show args
2089 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2090 @end table
2091
2092 @node Environment
2093 @section Your Program's Environment
2094
2095 @cindex environment (of your program)
2096 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2097 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2098 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2099 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2100 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2101 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2102 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2103
2104 @table @code
2105 @kindex path
2106 @item path @var{directory}
2107 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2108 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2109 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2110 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2111 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2112 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2113 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2114
2115 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2116 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2117 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2118 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2119 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2120 @var{directory} to the search path.
2121 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2122 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2123
2124 @kindex show paths
2125 @item show paths
2126 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2127 environment variable).
2128
2129 @kindex show environment
2130 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2131 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2132 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2133 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2134 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2135
2136 @kindex set environment
2137 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2138 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2139 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
2140 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
2141 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2142 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2143 null value.
2144 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2145 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2146
2147 For example, this command:
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 set env USER = foo
2151 @end smallexample
2152
2153 @noindent
2154 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2155 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2156 are not actually required.)
2157
2158 @kindex unset environment
2159 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2160 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2161 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2162 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2163 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2164 @end table
2165
2166 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2167 the shell indicated
2168 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
2169 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
2170 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
2171 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
2172 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
2173 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
2174 @file{.profile}.
2175
2176 @node Working Directory
2177 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2178
2179 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2180 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2181 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2182 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2183 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2184 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2185
2186 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2187 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2188 Specify Files}.
2189
2190 @table @code
2191 @kindex cd
2192 @cindex change working directory
2193 @item cd @var{directory}
2194 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
2195
2196 @kindex pwd
2197 @item pwd
2198 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2199 @end table
2200
2201 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2202 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2203 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2204 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2205 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2206 current working directory of the debuggee.
2207
2208 @node Input/Output
2209 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2210
2211 @cindex redirection
2212 @cindex i/o
2213 @cindex terminal
2214 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2215 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2216 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2217 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2218 running your program.
2219
2220 @table @code
2221 @kindex info terminal
2222 @item info terminal
2223 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2224 program is using.
2225 @end table
2226
2227 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2228 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2229
2230 @smallexample
2231 run > outfile
2232 @end smallexample
2233
2234 @noindent
2235 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2236
2237 @kindex tty
2238 @cindex controlling terminal
2239 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2240 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2241 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2242 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2243 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2244
2245 @smallexample
2246 tty /dev/ttyb
2247 @end smallexample
2248
2249 @noindent
2250 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2251 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2252 that as their controlling terminal.
2253
2254 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2255 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2256 terminal.
2257
2258 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2259 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2260 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2261 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2262
2263 @cindex inferior tty
2264 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2265 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2266 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2267 program.
2268
2269 @table @code
2270 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2271 @kindex set inferior-tty
2272 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2273
2274 @item show inferior-tty
2275 @kindex show inferior-tty
2276 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2277 @end table
2278
2279 @node Attach
2280 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2281 @kindex attach
2282 @cindex attach
2283
2284 @table @code
2285 @item attach @var{process-id}
2286 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2287 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2288 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2289 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2290 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2291
2292 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2293 executing the command.
2294 @end table
2295
2296 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2297 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2298 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2299 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2300
2301 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2302 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2303 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2304 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2305 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2306 Specify Files}.
2307
2308 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2309 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2310 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2311 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2312 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2313 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2314 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2315
2316 @table @code
2317 @kindex detach
2318 @item detach
2319 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2320 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2321 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2322 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2323 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2324 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2325 executing the command.
2326 @end table
2327
2328 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2329 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2330 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2331 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2332 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2333 Messages}).
2334
2335 @node Kill Process
2336 @section Killing the Child Process
2337
2338 @table @code
2339 @kindex kill
2340 @item kill
2341 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2342 @end table
2343
2344 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2345 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2346 is running.
2347
2348 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2349 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2350 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2351 outside the debugger.
2352
2353 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2354 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2355 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2356 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2357 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2358 breakpoint settings).
2359
2360 @node Inferiors
2361 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors
2362
2363 Some @value{GDBN} targets are able to run multiple processes created
2364 from a single executable. This can happen, for instance, with an
2365 embedded system reporting back several processes via the remote
2366 protocol.
2367
2368 @cindex inferior
2369 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2370 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2371 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2372 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2373 may (in future) be retained after a process exits. Each run of an
2374 executable creates a new inferior, as does each attachment to an
2375 existing process. Inferiors have unique identifiers that are
2376 different from process ids, and may optionally be named as well.
2377 Usually each inferior will also have its own distinct address space,
2378 although some embedded targets may have several inferiors running in
2379 different parts of a single space.
2380
2381 Each inferior may in turn have multiple threads running in it.
2382
2383 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @code{info inferiors}:
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex info inferiors
2387 @item info inferiors
2388 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2389
2390 @kindex set print inferior-events
2391 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2392 @item set print inferior-events
2393 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2394 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2395 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2396 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2397 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2398 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2399
2400 @kindex show print inferior-events
2401 @item show print inferior-events
2402 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2403 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2404 @end table
2405
2406 @node Threads
2407 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2408
2409 @cindex threads of execution
2410 @cindex multiple threads
2411 @cindex switching threads
2412 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2413 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2414 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2415 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2416 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2417 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2418 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2419
2420 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2421 programs:
2422
2423 @itemize @bullet
2424 @item automatic notification of new threads
2425 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2426 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2427 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2428 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2429 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2430 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2431 messages on thread start and exit.
2432 @end itemize
2433
2434 @quotation
2435 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2436 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2437 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2438 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2439 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2440 like this:
2441
2442 @smallexample
2443 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2444 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2445 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2446 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2447 @end smallexample
2448 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2449 @c doesn't support threads"?
2450 @end quotation
2451
2452 @cindex focus of debugging
2453 @cindex current thread
2454 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2455 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2456 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2457 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2458 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2459
2460 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2461 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2462 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2463 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2464 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2465 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2466 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2467 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2468 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2469 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2470
2471 @smallexample
2472 [New Thread 46912507313328 (LWP 25582)]
2473 @end smallexample
2474
2475 @noindent
2476 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2477 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2478 further qualifier.
2479
2480 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2481 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2482 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2483 @c program?
2484 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2485 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2486 @c threads ab initio?
2487
2488 @cindex thread number
2489 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2490 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2491 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2492
2493 @table @code
2494 @kindex info threads
2495 @item info threads
2496 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2497 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2498
2499 @enumerate
2500 @item
2501 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2502
2503 @item
2504 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2505
2506 @item
2507 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2508 @end enumerate
2509
2510 @noindent
2511 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2512 indicates the current thread.
2513
2514 For example,
2515 @end table
2516 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2517
2518 @smallexample
2519 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2520 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2521 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2522 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2523 at threadtest.c:68
2524 @end smallexample
2525
2526 On HP-UX systems:
2527
2528 @cindex debugging multithreaded programs (on HP-UX)
2529 @cindex thread identifier (GDB), on HP-UX
2530 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2531 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2532 thread in your program.
2533
2534 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2535 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2536 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2537 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2538 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2539 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2540 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2541 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2542 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2543 HP-UX, you see
2544
2545 @smallexample
2546 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2547 @end smallexample
2548
2549 @noindent
2550 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2551
2552 @table @code
2553 @kindex info threads (HP-UX)
2554 @item info threads
2555 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2556 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2557
2558 @enumerate
2559 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2560
2561 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2562
2563 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2564 @end enumerate
2565
2566 @noindent
2567 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2568 indicates the current thread.
2569
2570 For example,
2571 @end table
2572 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2573
2574 @smallexample
2575 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2576 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2577 at quicksort.c:137
2578 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2579 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2580 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2581 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2582 @end smallexample
2583
2584 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2585 Solaris-specific command:
2586
2587 @table @code
2588 @item maint info sol-threads
2589 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2590 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2591 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2592 @end table
2593
2594 @table @code
2595 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2596 @item thread @var{threadno}
2597 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2598 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2599 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2600 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2601 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2602
2603 @smallexample
2604 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2605 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2606 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2607 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2608 @end smallexample
2609
2610 @noindent
2611 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2612 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2613 threads.
2614
2615 @kindex thread apply
2616 @cindex apply command to several threads
2617 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{command}
2618 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2619 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2620 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2621 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2622 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2623 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply a
2624 command to all threads, type @kbd{thread apply all @var{command}}.
2625
2626 @kindex set print thread-events
2627 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
2628 @item set print thread-events
2629 @itemx set print thread-events on
2630 @itemx set print thread-events off
2631 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
2632 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
2633 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
2634 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
2635 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
2636
2637 @kindex show print thread-events
2638 @item show print thread-events
2639 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
2640 have started and exited.
2641 @end table
2642
2643 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
2644 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2645 programs with multiple threads.
2646
2647 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
2648 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2649
2650 @node Processes
2651 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Processes
2652
2653 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2654 @cindex multiple processes
2655 @cindex processes, multiple
2656 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2657 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2658 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2659 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2660 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2661 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2662 will cause it to terminate.
2663
2664 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2665 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2666 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2667 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2668 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2669 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2670 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2671 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2672 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2673 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2674
2675 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
2676 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
2677 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
2678 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
2679
2680 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2681 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2682
2683 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2684 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2685
2686 @table @code
2687 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2688 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2689 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2690 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2691 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
2692
2693 @table @code
2694 @item parent
2695 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2696 unimpeded. This is the default.
2697
2698 @item child
2699 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2700 unimpeded.
2701
2702 @end table
2703
2704 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
2705 @item show follow-fork-mode
2706 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2707 @end table
2708
2709 @cindex debugging multiple processes
2710 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
2711 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex set detach-on-fork
2715 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
2716 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
2717 retain debugger control over them both.
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @item on
2721 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
2722 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
2723 independently. This is the default.
2724
2725 @item off
2726 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2727 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
2728 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
2729 is held suspended.
2730
2731 @end table
2732
2733 @kindex show detach-on-fork
2734 @item show detach-on-fork
2735 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
2736 @end table
2737
2738 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then
2739 @value{GDBN} will retain control of all forked processes (including
2740 nested forks). You can list the forked processes under the control of
2741 @value{GDBN} by using the @w{@code{info forks}} command, and switch
2742 from one fork to another by using the @w{@code{fork}} command.
2743
2744 @table @code
2745 @kindex info forks
2746 @item info forks
2747 Print a list of all forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN}.
2748 The listing will include a fork id, a process id, and the current
2749 position (program counter) of the process.
2750
2751 @kindex fork @var{fork-id}
2752 @item fork @var{fork-id}
2753 Make fork number @var{fork-id} the current process. The argument
2754 @var{fork-id} is the internal fork number assigned by @value{GDBN},
2755 as shown in the first field of the @samp{info forks} display.
2756
2757 @kindex process @var{process-id}
2758 @item process @var{process-id}
2759 Make process number @var{process-id} the current process. The
2760 argument @var{process-id} must be one that is listed in the output of
2761 @samp{info forks}.
2762
2763 @end table
2764
2765 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
2766 from it by using the @w{@code{detach fork}} command (allowing it to
2767 run independently), or delete (and kill) it using the
2768 @w{@code{delete fork}} command.
2769
2770 @table @code
2771 @kindex detach fork @var{fork-id}
2772 @item detach fork @var{fork-id}
2773 Detach from the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number
2774 @var{fork-id}, and remove it from the fork list. The process will be
2775 allowed to run independently.
2776
2777 @kindex delete fork @var{fork-id}
2778 @item delete fork @var{fork-id}
2779 Kill the process identified by @value{GDBN} fork number @var{fork-id},
2780 and remove it from the fork list.
2781
2782 @end table
2783
2784 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2785 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2786 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2787 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2788 the child process's @code{main}.
2789
2790 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2791 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2792
2793 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2794 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2795 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2796 argument.
2797
2798 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2799 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2800 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
2801
2802 @node Checkpoint/Restart
2803 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
2804
2805 @cindex checkpoint
2806 @cindex restart
2807 @cindex bookmark
2808 @cindex snapshot of a process
2809 @cindex rewind program state
2810
2811 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
2812 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
2813 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
2814 later.
2815
2816 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
2817 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
2818 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
2819 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
2820 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
2821
2822 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
2823 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
2824 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
2825 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
2826 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
2827 start again from there.
2828
2829 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
2830 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
2831
2832 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
2833
2834 @table @code
2835 @kindex checkpoint
2836 @item checkpoint
2837 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
2838 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
2839 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
2840
2841 @kindex info checkpoints
2842 @item info checkpoints
2843 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
2844 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
2845 listed:
2846
2847 @table @code
2848 @item Checkpoint ID
2849 @item Process ID
2850 @item Code Address
2851 @item Source line, or label
2852 @end table
2853
2854 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2855 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
2856 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
2857 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
2858 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
2859 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
2860 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
2861
2862 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
2863 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
2864 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
2865 the debugger.
2866
2867 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2868 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
2869 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
2870
2871 @end table
2872
2873 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
2874 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
2875 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
2876 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
2877 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
2878 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
2879 previously read data can be read again.
2880
2881 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
2882 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
2883 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
2884 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
2885 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
2886 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
2887
2888 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
2889 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
2890 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
2891 different execution path this time.
2892
2893 @cindex checkpoints and process id
2894 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
2895 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
2896 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
2897 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
2898 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
2899 potentially pose a problem.
2900
2901 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
2902
2903 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
2904 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
2905 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
2906 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
2907 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
2908 next.
2909
2910 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
2911 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
2912 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
2913 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
2914 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
2915
2916 @node Stopping
2917 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2918
2919 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2920 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2921 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2922
2923 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2924 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2925 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2926 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2927 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2928 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2929 explicitly request this information at any time.
2930
2931 @table @code
2932 @kindex info program
2933 @item info program
2934 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2935 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2936 @end table
2937
2938 @menu
2939 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2940 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2941 * Signals:: Signals
2942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2943 @end menu
2944
2945 @node Breakpoints
2946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
2947
2948 @cindex breakpoints
2949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2955 program.
2956
2957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
2958 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
2959 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
2960 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
2961 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
2962 call).
2963
2964 @cindex watchpoints
2965 @cindex data breakpoints
2966 @cindex memory tracing
2967 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2968 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2969 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2970 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
2971 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
2972 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
2973 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
2974 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
2975 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
2976 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
2977 same commands.
2978
2979 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2980 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2981 Automatic Display}.
2982
2983 @cindex catchpoints
2984 @cindex breakpoint on events
2985 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2986 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2987 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2988 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2989 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2990 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2991 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2992
2993 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2994 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2995 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2996 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2997 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2998 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2999 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3000 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3001 enable it again.
3002
3003 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3004 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3005 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3006 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3007 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3008 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3009 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3010
3011 @menu
3012 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3013 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3014 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3015 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3016 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3017 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3018 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3019 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3020 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3021 @end menu
3022
3023 @node Set Breaks
3024 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3025
3026 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3027 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3028 @c
3029 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3030
3031 @kindex break
3032 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3033 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3034 @cindex latest breakpoint
3035 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3036 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3037 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3038 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3039 convenience variables.
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @item break @var{location}
3043 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3044 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3045 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3046 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3047 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3048
3049 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3050 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3051 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3052 that situation.
3053
3054 @item break
3055 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3056 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3057 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3058 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3059 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3060 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3061 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3062 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3063 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3064 inside loops.
3065
3066 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3067 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3068 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3069 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3070 existed when your program stopped.
3071
3072 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3073 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3074 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3075 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3076 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3077 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3078 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3079
3080 @kindex tbreak
3081 @item tbreak @var{args}
3082 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
3083 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3084 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3085 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3086
3087 @kindex hbreak
3088 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3089 @item hbreak @var{args}
3090 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
3091 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3092 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3093 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3094 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3095 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3096 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3097 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3098 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3099 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3100 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3101 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3102 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3103 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3104 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3105 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3106 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3107 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3108
3109 @kindex thbreak
3110 @item thbreak @var{args}
3111 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
3112 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3113 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3114 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3115 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3116 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3117 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3118 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3119
3120 @kindex rbreak
3121 @cindex regular expression
3122 @cindex breakpoints in functions matching a regexp
3123 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3124 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3125 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3126 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3127 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3128 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3129 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3130 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3131
3132 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3133 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3134 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3135 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3136 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3137 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3138
3139 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3140 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3141 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3142 classes.
3143
3144 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3145 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3146 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3147
3148 @smallexample
3149 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3150 @end smallexample
3151
3152 @kindex info breakpoints
3153 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3154 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3155 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3156 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3157 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3158 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3159 about the specified breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint). For
3160 each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3161
3162 @table @emph
3163 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3164 @item Type
3165 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3166 @item Disposition
3167 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3168 @item Enabled or Disabled
3169 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3170 that are not enabled.
3171 @item Address
3172 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3173 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3174 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3175 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3176 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3177 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3178 @item What
3179 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3180 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3181 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3182 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3183 @end table
3184
3185 @noindent
3186 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
3187 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
3188 are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is allowed to have a condition
3189 specified for it. The condition is not parsed for validity until a shared
3190 library is loaded that allows the pending breakpoint to resolve to a
3191 valid location.
3192
3193 @noindent
3194 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3195 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3196 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3197 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3198 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3199
3200 @noindent
3201 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3202 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3203 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3204 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3205 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3206 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3207 @end table
3208
3209 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3210 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3211 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3212 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3213
3214 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3215 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3216 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3217 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3218
3219 @itemize @bullet
3220 @item
3221 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3222 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3223
3224 @item
3225 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3226 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3227
3228 @item
3229 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3230 several places where that function is inlined.
3231 @end itemize
3232
3233 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3234 the relevant locations@footnote{
3235 As of this writing, multiple-location breakpoints work only if there's
3236 line number information for all the locations. This means that they
3237 will generally not work in system libraries, unless you have debug
3238 info with line numbers for them.}.
3239
3240 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3241 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3242 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3243 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3244 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3245 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3246 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3247
3248 For example:
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3252 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3253 stop only if i==1
3254 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3255 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3256 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3257 @end smallexample
3258
3259 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3260 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3261 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3262 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3263 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3264 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3265 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3266 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3267 that belong to that breakpoint.
3268
3269 @cindex pending breakpoints
3270 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3271 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3272 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3273 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3274 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3275 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3276 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3277 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3278 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3279 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3280 is not yet resolved.
3281
3282 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3283 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3284 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3285 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3286 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3287 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3288
3289 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3290 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3291 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3292 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3293
3294 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3295 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3296 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3297
3298 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3299 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3300 address specification to an address:
3301
3302 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3303 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3304 @table @code
3305 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3306 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3307 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3308
3309 @item set breakpoint pending on
3310 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3311 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3312
3313 @item set breakpoint pending off
3314 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3315 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3316 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3317
3318 @item show breakpoint pending
3319 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3320 @end table
3321
3322 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3323 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3324 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3325
3326 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3327 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3328 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3329 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3330 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3331 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3332 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3333 breakpoints.
3334
3335 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3336
3337 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3338 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3339 @table @code
3340 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3341 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3342 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3343 breakpoint must be used.
3344
3345 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3346 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3347 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3348 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3349 @end table
3350
3351 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3352 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3353 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3354 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3355 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3356 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3357 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3358 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3359 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3360
3361 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3362 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3363 @table @code
3364 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3365 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3366 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3367 removed from the target when it stops.
3368
3369 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3370 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3371 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3372 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3373 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is removed.
3374
3375 @cindex non-stop mode, and @code{breakpoint always-inserted}
3376 @item set breakpoint always-inserted auto
3377 This is the default mode. If @value{GDBN} is controlling the inferior
3378 in non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), gdb behaves as if
3379 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is on. If @value{GDBN} is
3380 controlling the inferior in all-stop mode, @value{GDBN} behaves as if
3381 @code{breakpoint always-inserted} mode is off.
3382 @end table
3383
3384 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3385 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3386 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3387 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3388 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3389 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3390 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3391 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3392
3393
3394 @node Set Watchpoints
3395 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3396
3397 @cindex setting watchpoints
3398 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3399 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3400 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3401 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3402 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3403
3404 @itemize @bullet
3405 @item
3406 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3407
3408 @item
3409 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3410 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3411 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3412
3413 @item
3414 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3415 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3416 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3417 @end itemize
3418
3419 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3420 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3421 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3422 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3423 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3424 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3425 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3426 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3427 the expression changes.
3428
3429 @cindex software watchpoints
3430 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3431 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3432 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3433 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3434 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3435 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3436 culprit.)
3437
3438 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3439 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3440 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3441
3442 @table @code
3443 @kindex watch
3444 @item watch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3445 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3446 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3447 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3448 to watch the value of a single variable:
3449
3450 @smallexample
3451 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3452 @end smallexample
3453
3454 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
3455 clause, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
3456 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
3457 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
3458 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
3459 with Hardware Watchpoints.
3460
3461 @kindex rwatch
3462 @item rwatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3463 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
3464 by the program.
3465
3466 @kindex awatch
3467 @item awatch @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}
3468 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
3469 or written into by the program.
3470
3471 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
3472 @item info watchpoints
3473 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
3474 it is the same as @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
3475 @end table
3476
3477 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
3478 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
3479 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
3480 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
3481 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
3482 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
3483
3484 @cindex use only software watchpoints
3485 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
3486 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
3487 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
3488 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
3489 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
3490 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
3491 mechanism of watching expression values.)
3492
3493 @table @code
3494 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3495 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
3496 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
3497
3498 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3499 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
3500 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
3501 @end table
3502
3503 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3504 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3505 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3506
3507 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
3508
3509 @smallexample
3510 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
3511 @end smallexample
3512
3513 @noindent
3514 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
3515
3516 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
3517 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
3518 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
3519 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
3520 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
3521 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
3522 will print a message like this:
3523
3524 @smallexample
3525 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
3526 @end smallexample
3527
3528 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
3529 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
3530 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
3531 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
3532 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
3533 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
3534 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
3535 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
3536
3537 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
3538 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
3539 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
3540 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
3541 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
3542 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
3543
3544 @smallexample
3545 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 @noindent
3549 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
3550
3551 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
3552 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
3553 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
3554 expression with separately allocated resources.
3555
3556 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
3557 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
3558 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
3559
3560 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
3561 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
3562 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
3563 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
3564 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
3565 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
3566 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
3567 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
3568 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
3569
3570 @cindex watchpoints and threads
3571 @cindex threads and watchpoints
3572 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
3573 watched expression from every thread.
3574
3575 @quotation
3576 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
3577 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
3578 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
3579 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
3580 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
3581 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
3582 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
3583 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
3584 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
3585 @end quotation
3586
3587 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
3588
3589 @node Set Catchpoints
3590 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
3591 @cindex catchpoints, setting
3592 @cindex exception handlers
3593 @cindex event handling
3594
3595 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
3596 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
3597 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
3598
3599 @table @code
3600 @kindex catch
3601 @item catch @var{event}
3602 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
3603 @table @code
3604 @item throw
3605 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
3606 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
3607
3608 @item catch
3609 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
3610
3611 @item exception
3612 @cindex Ada exception catching
3613 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
3614 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
3615 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
3616 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
3617 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
3618
3619 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
3620 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
3621 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
3622 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
3623 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
3624 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
3625 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
3626 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
3627
3628 @item exception unhandled
3629 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
3630
3631 @item assert
3632 A failed Ada assertion.
3633
3634 @item exec
3635 @cindex break on fork/exec
3636 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3637 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3638
3639 @item fork
3640 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3641 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3642
3643 @item vfork
3644 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
3645 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
3646
3647 @end table
3648
3649 @item tcatch @var{event}
3650 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
3651 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
3652
3653 @end table
3654
3655 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
3656
3657 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
3658 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
3659
3660 @itemize @bullet
3661 @item
3662 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
3663 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
3664 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
3665 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
3666 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
3667 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
3668 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
3669 disabled within interactive calls.
3670
3671 @item
3672 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
3673
3674 @item
3675 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
3676 @end itemize
3677
3678 @cindex raise exceptions
3679 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
3680 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
3681 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
3682 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
3683 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
3684 out where the exception was raised.
3685
3686 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
3687 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
3688 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
3689 which has the following ANSI C interface:
3690
3691 @smallexample
3692 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
3693 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
3694 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
3695 @end smallexample
3696
3697 @noindent
3698 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
3699 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
3700 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Exceptions}).
3701
3702 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions})
3703 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
3704 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
3705 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
3706 raised.
3707
3708
3709 @node Delete Breaks
3710 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
3711
3712 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3713 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
3714 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3715 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
3716 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
3717 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
3718
3719 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
3720 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
3721 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
3722 their breakpoint numbers.
3723
3724 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
3725 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
3726 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
3727
3728 @table @code
3729 @kindex clear
3730 @item clear
3731 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
3732 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
3733 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
3734 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
3735
3736 @item clear @var{location}
3737 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
3738 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
3739 most useful ones are listed below:
3740
3741 @table @code
3742 @item clear @var{function}
3743 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
3744 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
3745
3746 @item clear @var{linenum}
3747 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
3748 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
3749 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
3750 @end table
3751
3752 @cindex delete breakpoints
3753 @kindex delete
3754 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
3755 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3756 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
3757 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
3758 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
3759 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
3760 @end table
3761
3762 @node Disabling
3763 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
3764
3765 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
3766 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
3767 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
3768 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
3769 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
3770
3771 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
3772 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
3773 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
3774 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
3775 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
3776
3777 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
3778 affects all of its locations.
3779
3780 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
3781 states of enablement:
3782
3783 @itemize @bullet
3784 @item
3785 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
3786 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
3787 @item
3788 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
3789 @item
3790 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
3791 disabled.
3792 @item
3793 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
3794 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
3795 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
3796 @end itemize
3797
3798 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
3799 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
3800
3801 @table @code
3802 @kindex disable
3803 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
3804 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3805 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
3806 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
3807 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
3808 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
3809 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
3810
3811 @kindex enable
3812 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
3813 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
3814 become effective once again in stopping your program.
3815
3816 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
3817 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
3818 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
3819
3820 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3821 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3822 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3823 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
3824 @end table
3825
3826 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3827 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3828 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3829 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3830 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3831 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3832 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3833 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3834 Stepping}.)
3835
3836 @node Conditions
3837 @subsection Break Conditions
3838 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3839 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3840
3841 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3842 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3843 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3844 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3845 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3846 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3847 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3848 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3849
3850 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3851 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3852 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3853 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3854 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3855
3856 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3857 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3858 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3859 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3860 one.
3861
3862 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3863 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3864 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3865 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3866 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3867 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3868 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3869 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3870 conditions for the
3871 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3872 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
3873
3874 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3875 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3876 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3877 with the @code{condition} command.
3878
3879 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3880 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3881 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3882 catchpoint.
3883
3884 @table @code
3885 @kindex condition
3886 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3887 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3888 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3889 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3890 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3891 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3892 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3893 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3894 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3895 prints an error message:
3896
3897 @smallexample
3898 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3899 @end smallexample
3900
3901 @noindent
3902 @value{GDBN} does
3903 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3904 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3905 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3906
3907 @item condition @var{bnum}
3908 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3909 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3910 @end table
3911
3912 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3913 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3914 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3915 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3916 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3917 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3918 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3919 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3920 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3921 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3922 your program reaches it.
3923
3924 @table @code
3925 @kindex ignore
3926 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3927 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3928 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3929 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3930 takes no action.
3931
3932 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3933 a count of zero.
3934
3935 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3936 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3937 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3938 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
3939
3940 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3941 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3942 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3943
3944 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3945 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3946 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3947 Variables}.
3948 @end table
3949
3950 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3951
3952
3953 @node Break Commands
3954 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
3955
3956 @cindex breakpoint commands
3957 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3958 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3959 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3960 enable other breakpoints.
3961
3962 @table @code
3963 @kindex commands
3964 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
3965 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3966 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3967 @itemx end
3968 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3969 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3970 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3971
3972 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3973 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3974
3975 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3976 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3977 recently encountered).
3978 @end table
3979
3980 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3981 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3982
3983 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3984 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3985 that resumes execution.
3986
3987 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3988 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3989 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3990 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3991 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3992
3993 @kindex silent
3994 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3995 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3996 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3997 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3998 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3999 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4000
4001 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4002 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4003 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4004
4005 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4006 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4007
4008 @smallexample
4009 break foo if x>0
4010 commands
4011 silent
4012 printf "x is %d\n",x
4013 cont
4014 end
4015 @end smallexample
4016
4017 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4018 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4019 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4020 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4021 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4022 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4023 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4024
4025 @smallexample
4026 break 403
4027 commands
4028 silent
4029 set x = y + 4
4030 cont
4031 end
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
4035 @node Error in Breakpoints
4036 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4037
4038 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
4039 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
4040
4041 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
4042 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
4043 @smallexample
4044 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
4045 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
4046 @end smallexample
4047
4048 @noindent
4049 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
4050 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
4051 watchpoints it needs to insert.
4052
4053 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
4054 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
4055
4056 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
4057 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4058 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
4059
4060 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
4061 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
4062 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
4063 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
4064
4065 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
4066 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
4067 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
4068 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
4069 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
4070 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
4071 first in the bundle.
4072
4073 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
4074 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
4075 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
4076 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
4077 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
4078 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
4079 is hit.
4080
4081 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
4082 that's been subject to address adjustment:
4083
4084 @smallexample
4085 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
4086 @end smallexample
4087
4088 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
4089 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
4090 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
4091 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
4092 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
4093 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
4094 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
4095 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
4096
4097 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
4098 adjusted breakpoints:
4099
4100 @smallexample
4101 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
4102 to 0x00010410.
4103 @end smallexample
4104
4105 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
4106 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
4107 frequently than expected.
4108
4109 @node Continuing and Stepping
4110 @section Continuing and Stepping
4111
4112 @cindex stepping
4113 @cindex continuing
4114 @cindex resuming execution
4115 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
4116 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
4117 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
4118 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
4119 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
4120 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
4121 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
4122 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
4123
4124 @table @code
4125 @kindex continue
4126 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
4127 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
4128 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4129 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4130 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4131 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
4132 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
4133 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
4134 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
4135 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4136
4137 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
4138 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
4139 @code{continue} is ignored.
4140
4141 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
4142 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
4143 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
4144 @code{continue}.
4145 @end table
4146
4147 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
4148 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
4149 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
4150 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
4151
4152 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
4153 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
4154 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
4155 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
4156 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
4157 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
4158
4159 @table @code
4160 @kindex step
4161 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
4162 @item step
4163 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
4164 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
4165 abbreviated @code{s}.
4166
4167 @quotation
4168 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
4169 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
4170 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
4171 @c distinction here.
4172 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
4173 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
4174 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
4175 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
4176 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
4177 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
4178 below.
4179 @end quotation
4180
4181 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
4182 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4183 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
4184 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
4185 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
4186 called within the line.
4187
4188 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
4189 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
4190 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
4191 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
4192 was any debugging information about the routine.
4193
4194 @item step @var{count}
4195 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
4196 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
4197 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
4198
4199 @kindex next
4200 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
4201 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4202 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
4203 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
4204 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
4205 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
4206 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
4207 is abbreviated @code{n}.
4208
4209 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
4210
4211
4212 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
4213 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
4214 @c
4215 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
4216 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
4217 @c function are executed without stopping.
4218
4219 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
4220 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4221 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
4222
4223 @kindex set step-mode
4224 @item set step-mode
4225 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
4226 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
4227 @itemx set step-mode on
4228 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
4229 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
4230 information rather than stepping over it.
4231
4232 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
4233 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
4234 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
4235
4236 @item set step-mode off
4237 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
4238 debug information. This is the default.
4239
4240 @item show step-mode
4241 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
4242 source line debug information.
4243
4244 @kindex finish
4245 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
4246 @item finish
4247 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
4248 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
4249 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
4250
4251 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
4252 ,Returning from a Function}).
4253
4254 @kindex until
4255 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
4256 @cindex run until specified location
4257 @item until
4258 @itemx u
4259 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
4260 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
4261 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
4262 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
4263 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
4264 than the address of the jump.
4265
4266 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
4267 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
4268 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
4269 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
4270 through the next iteration.
4271
4272 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
4273 stack frame.
4274
4275 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
4276 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
4277 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
4278 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
4279 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
4280
4281 @smallexample
4282 (@value{GDBP}) f
4283 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
4284 206 expand_input();
4285 (@value{GDBP}) until
4286 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
4290 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
4291 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
4292 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
4293 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
4294 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
4295 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
4296
4297 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
4298 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
4299 argument.
4300
4301 @item until @var{location}
4302 @itemx u @var{location}
4303 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
4304 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
4305 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
4306 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
4307 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
4308 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
4309 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
4310 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
4311 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
4312 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
4313 invocations have returned.
4314
4315 @smallexample
4316 94 int factorial (int value)
4317 95 @{
4318 96 if (value > 1) @{
4319 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
4320 98 @}
4321 99 return (value);
4322 100 @}
4323 @end smallexample
4324
4325
4326 @kindex advance @var{location}
4327 @itemx advance @var{location}
4328 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
4329 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
4330 @ref{Specify Location}.
4331 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
4332 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
4333 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
4334 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
4335
4336
4337 @kindex stepi
4338 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
4339 @item stepi
4340 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
4341 @itemx si
4342 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
4343
4344 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
4345 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
4346 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
4347 Display,, Automatic Display}.
4348
4349 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
4350
4351 @need 750
4352 @kindex nexti
4353 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
4354 @item nexti
4355 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
4356 @itemx ni
4357 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
4358 proceed until the function returns.
4359
4360 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
4361 @end table
4362
4363 @node Signals
4364 @section Signals
4365 @cindex signals
4366
4367 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
4368 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
4369 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
4370 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
4371 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
4372 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
4373 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
4374 requested an alarm).
4375
4376 @cindex fatal signals
4377 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
4378 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
4379 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
4380 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
4381 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
4382 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
4383
4384 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
4385 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
4386 signal.
4387
4388 @cindex handling signals
4389 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
4390 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
4391 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
4392 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
4393 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
4394
4395 @table @code
4396 @kindex info signals
4397 @kindex info handle
4398 @item info signals
4399 @itemx info handle
4400 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
4401 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
4402 the defined types of signals.
4403
4404 @item info signals @var{sig}
4405 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
4406
4407 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
4408
4409 @kindex handle
4410 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
4411 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
4412 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
4413 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
4414 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
4415 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
4416 say what change to make.
4417 @end table
4418
4419 @c @group
4420 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
4421 Their full names are:
4422
4423 @table @code
4424 @item nostop
4425 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
4426 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
4427
4428 @item stop
4429 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
4430 the @code{print} keyword as well.
4431
4432 @item print
4433 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
4434
4435 @item noprint
4436 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
4437 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
4438
4439 @item pass
4440 @itemx noignore
4441 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
4442 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
4443 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
4444
4445 @item nopass
4446 @itemx ignore
4447 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
4448 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
4449 @end table
4450 @c @end group
4451
4452 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
4453 program until you
4454 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
4455 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
4456 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
4457 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
4458 program sees that signal when you continue.
4459
4460 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
4461 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
4462 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
4463 erroneous signals.
4464
4465 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
4466 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
4467 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
4468 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
4469 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
4470 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
4471 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
4472 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
4473 Program a Signal}.
4474
4475 @cindex extra signal information
4476 @anchor{extra signal information}
4477
4478 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
4479 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
4480 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
4481 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
4482 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
4483 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
4484 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
4485 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
4486 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
4487 system header.
4488
4489 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
4490 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
4491
4492 @smallexample
4493 @group
4494 (@value{GDBP}) continue
4495 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
4496 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
4497 69 *(int *)p = 0;
4498 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
4499 type = struct @{
4500 int si_signo;
4501 int si_errno;
4502 int si_code;
4503 union @{
4504 int _pad[28];
4505 struct @{...@} _kill;
4506 struct @{...@} _timer;
4507 struct @{...@} _rt;
4508 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
4509 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
4510 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
4511 @} _sifields;
4512 @}
4513 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
4514 type = struct @{
4515 void *si_addr;
4516 @}
4517 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
4518 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
4519 @end group
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
4523
4524 @node Thread Stops
4525 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
4526
4527 @cindex stopped threads
4528 @cindex threads, stopped
4529
4530 @cindex continuing threads
4531 @cindex threads, continuing
4532
4533 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
4534 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
4535 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
4536 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
4537 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
4538 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
4539 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
4540 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
4541 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
4542
4543 @menu
4544 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
4545 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
4546 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
4547 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
4548 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
4549 @end menu
4550
4551 @node All-Stop Mode
4552 @subsection All-Stop Mode
4553
4554 @cindex all-stop mode
4555
4556 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
4557 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
4558 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
4559 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
4560 underfoot.
4561
4562 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
4563 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
4564 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
4565
4566 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
4567 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
4568 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
4569 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
4570 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
4571 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
4572 stops.
4573
4574 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
4575 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
4576 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
4577 first thread completes whatever you requested.
4578
4579 @cindex automatic thread selection
4580 @cindex switching threads automatically
4581 @cindex threads, automatic switching
4582 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
4583 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
4584 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
4585 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
4586 thread.
4587
4588 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
4589 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
4590
4591 @table @code
4592 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
4593 @cindex scheduler locking mode
4594 @cindex lock scheduler
4595 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
4596 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
4597 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
4598 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
4599 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
4600 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
4601 Other threads only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
4602 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
4603 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
4604 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
4605 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
4606 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
4607
4608 @item show scheduler-locking
4609 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
4610 @end table
4611
4612 @node Non-Stop Mode
4613 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
4614
4615 @cindex non-stop mode
4616
4617 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
4618 @c with more details.
4619
4620 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
4621 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
4622 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
4623 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
4624 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
4625 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
4626
4627 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
4628 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
4629 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
4630 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
4631 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
4632 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
4633 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
4634 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
4635 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
4636 independently and simultaneously.
4637
4638 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
4639 or attach to your program:
4640
4641 @smallexample
4642 # Enable the async interface.
4643 set target-async 1
4644
4645 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
4646 set pagination off
4647
4648 # Finally, turn it on!
4649 set non-stop on
4650 @end smallexample
4651
4652 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
4653
4654 @table @code
4655 @kindex set non-stop
4656 @item set non-stop on
4657 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
4658 @item set non-stop off
4659 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
4660 @kindex show non-stop
4661 @item show non-stop
4662 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
4663 @end table
4664
4665 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
4666 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
4667 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
4668 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
4669 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
4670 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
4671 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
4672 default.
4673
4674 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
4675 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
4676 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
4677
4678 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
4679 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
4680 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
4681 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
4682 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
4683
4684 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
4685 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
4686 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
4687 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
4688 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
4689
4690 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
4691
4692 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
4693 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
4694 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
4695 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
4696 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
4697 previously current thread.
4698
4699 @node Background Execution
4700 @subsection Background Execution
4701
4702 @cindex foreground execution
4703 @cindex background execution
4704 @cindex asynchronous execution
4705 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
4706
4707 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
4708 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
4709 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
4710 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
4711 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
4712 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
4713
4714 You need to explicitly enable asynchronous mode before you can use
4715 background execution commands. You can use these commands to
4716 manipulate the asynchronous mode setting:
4717
4718 @table @code
4719 @kindex set target-async
4720 @item set target-async on
4721 Enable asynchronous mode.
4722 @item set target-async off
4723 Disable asynchronous mode.
4724 @kindex show target-async
4725 @item show target-async
4726 Show the current target-async setting.
4727 @end table
4728
4729 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
4730 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
4731
4732 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
4733 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
4734 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
4735 are:
4736
4737 @table @code
4738 @kindex run&
4739 @item run
4740 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
4741
4742 @item attach
4743 @kindex attach&
4744 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
4745
4746 @item step
4747 @kindex step&
4748 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
4749
4750 @item stepi
4751 @kindex stepi&
4752 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
4753
4754 @item next
4755 @kindex next&
4756 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
4757
4758 @item nexti
4759 @kindex nexti&
4760 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
4761
4762 @item continue
4763 @kindex continue&
4764 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
4765
4766 @item finish
4767 @kindex finish&
4768 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
4769
4770 @item until
4771 @kindex until&
4772 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
4773
4774 @end table
4775
4776 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
4777 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
4778 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
4779 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
4780 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
4781 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
4782
4783 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
4784 using the @code{interrupt} command.
4785
4786 @table @code
4787 @kindex interrupt
4788 @item interrupt
4789 @itemx interrupt -a
4790
4791 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
4792 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
4793 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
4794 use @code{interrupt -a}.
4795 @end table
4796
4797 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4798 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
4799
4800 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
4801 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
4802 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
4803
4804 @table @code
4805 @cindex breakpoints and threads
4806 @cindex thread breakpoints
4807 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
4808 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
4809 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
4810 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
4811 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
4812 specify some source line.
4813
4814 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
4815 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
4816 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
4817 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
4818 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
4819
4820 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
4821 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
4822 program.
4823
4824 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
4825 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
4826 breakpoint condition, like this:
4827
4828 @smallexample
4829 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
4830 @end smallexample
4831
4832 @end table
4833
4834 @node Interrupted System Calls
4835 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
4836
4837 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
4838 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
4839 @cindex premature return from system calls
4840 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
4841 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
4842 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
4843 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
4844 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
4845 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
4846 stop execution.
4847
4848 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
4849 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
4850 style anyways.
4851
4852 For example, do not write code like this:
4853
4854 @smallexample
4855 sleep (10);
4856 @end smallexample
4857
4858 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
4859 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
4860
4861 Instead, write this:
4862
4863 @smallexample
4864 int unslept = 10;
4865 while (unslept > 0)
4866 unslept = sleep (unslept);
4867 @end smallexample
4868
4869 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
4870 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
4871 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
4872 @value{GDBN}.
4873
4874 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
4875 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
4876 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
4877 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
4878
4879
4880 @node Reverse Execution
4881 @chapter Running programs backward
4882 @cindex reverse execution
4883 @cindex running programs backward
4884
4885 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
4886 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
4887 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
4888 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
4889
4890 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
4891 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
4892 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
4893 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
4894 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
4895 all target environments can support reverse execution.
4896
4897 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
4898 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
4899 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
4900 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
4901 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
4902 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
4903 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
4904 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
4905 prior values@footnote{
4906 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
4907 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
4908 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
4909
4910 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
4911 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
4912 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
4913 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
4914 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
4915 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
4916 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
4917 }.
4918
4919 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
4920 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
4921
4922 @table @code
4923 @kindex reverse-continue
4924 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
4925 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4926 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
4927 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
4928 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
4929 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
4930 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
4931
4932 @kindex reverse-step
4933 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
4934 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4935 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
4936 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
4937
4938 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
4939 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
4940 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
4941 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
4942 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
4943 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
4944
4945 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
4946 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
4947
4948 @kindex reverse-stepi
4949 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
4950 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4951 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
4952 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
4953 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
4954 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
4955 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
4956
4957 @kindex reverse-next
4958 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
4959 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4960 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
4961 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
4962 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
4963 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
4964 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
4965 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
4966 line of a function back to its return to its caller
4967 @footnote{Unles the code is too heavily optimized.}.
4968
4969 @kindex reverse-nexti
4970 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
4971 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
4972 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
4973 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
4974 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
4975 another instruction, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
4976 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
4977 frame) is reached.
4978
4979 @kindex reverse-finish
4980 @item reverse-finish
4981 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
4982 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
4983 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
4984 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
4985
4986 @kindex set exec-direction
4987 @item set exec-direction
4988 Set the direction of target execution.
4989 @itemx set exec-direction reverse
4990 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
4991 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
4992 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
4993 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
4994 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
4995 @item set exec-direction forward
4996 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
4997 This is the default.
4998 @end table
4999
5000
5001 @node Stack
5002 @chapter Examining the Stack
5003
5004 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
5005 stopped and how it got there.
5006
5007 @cindex call stack
5008 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
5009 is generated.
5010 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
5011 the arguments of the call,
5012 and the local variables of the function being called.
5013 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
5014 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
5015 stack}.
5016
5017 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
5018 stack allow you to see all of this information.
5019
5020 @cindex selected frame
5021 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
5022 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
5023 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
5024 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
5025 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
5026 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5027
5028 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5029 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
5030 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
5031
5032 @menu
5033 * Frames:: Stack frames
5034 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
5035 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
5036 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
5037
5038 @end menu
5039
5040 @node Frames
5041 @section Stack Frames
5042
5043 @cindex frame, definition
5044 @cindex stack frame
5045 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
5046 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
5047 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
5048 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
5049 which the function is executing.
5050
5051 @cindex initial frame
5052 @cindex outermost frame
5053 @cindex innermost frame
5054 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
5055 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
5056 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
5057 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
5058 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
5059 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
5060 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
5061 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
5062
5063 @cindex frame pointer
5064 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
5065 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
5066 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
5067 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
5068 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
5069 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
5070
5071 @cindex frame number
5072 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
5073 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
5074 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
5075 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
5076 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
5077
5078 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
5079 @c underflow problems.
5080 @cindex frameless execution
5081 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
5082 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
5083 @smallexample
5084 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
5085 @end smallexample
5086 generates functions without a frame.)
5087 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
5088 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
5089 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
5090 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
5091 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
5092 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
5093 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
5094
5095 @table @code
5096 @kindex frame@r{, command}
5097 @cindex current stack frame
5098 @item frame @var{args}
5099 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
5100 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5101 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
5102 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
5103
5104 @kindex select-frame
5105 @cindex selecting frame silently
5106 @item select-frame
5107 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
5108 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
5109 @code{frame}.
5110 @end table
5111
5112 @node Backtrace
5113 @section Backtraces
5114
5115 @cindex traceback
5116 @cindex call stack traces
5117 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
5118 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
5119 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
5120 stack.
5121
5122 @table @code
5123 @kindex backtrace
5124 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
5125 @item backtrace
5126 @itemx bt
5127 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
5128 frames in the stack.
5129
5130 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
5131 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
5132
5133 @item backtrace @var{n}
5134 @itemx bt @var{n}
5135 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
5136
5137 @item backtrace -@var{n}
5138 @itemx bt -@var{n}
5139 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
5140
5141 @item backtrace full
5142 @itemx bt full
5143 @itemx bt full @var{n}
5144 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
5145 Print the values of the local variables also. @var{n} specifies the
5146 number of frames to print, as described above.
5147 @end table
5148
5149 @kindex where
5150 @kindex info stack
5151 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
5152 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
5153
5154 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
5155 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
5156 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
5157 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
5158 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
5159 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
5160 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
5161 multi-threaded program.
5162
5163 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
5164 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
5165 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
5166 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
5167 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
5168 line number.
5169
5170 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
5171 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
5172
5173 @smallexample
5174 @group
5175 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5176 at builtin.c:993
5177 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
5178 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
5179 at macro.c:71
5180 (More stack frames follow...)
5181 @end group
5182 @end smallexample
5183
5184 @noindent
5185 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
5186 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
5187 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
5188
5189 @cindex value optimized out, in backtrace
5190 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
5191 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
5192 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
5193 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
5194 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
5195 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
5196 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
5197 such a backtrace might look like:
5198
5199 @smallexample
5200 @group
5201 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
5202 at builtin.c:993
5203 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<value optimized out>) at macro.c:242
5204 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<value optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
5205 at macro.c:71
5206 (More stack frames follow...)
5207 @end group
5208 @end smallexample
5209
5210 @noindent
5211 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
5212 shown as @samp{<value optimized out>}.
5213
5214 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
5215 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
5216 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
5217
5218 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
5219 @cindex program entry point
5220 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
5221 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
5222 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
5223 @code{main}@footnote{
5224 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
5225 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
5226 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
5227 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
5228 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
5229 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
5230
5231 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
5232 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
5233
5234 @table @code
5235 @item set backtrace past-main
5236 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
5237 @kindex set backtrace
5238 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
5239
5240 @item set backtrace past-main off
5241 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
5242 default.
5243
5244 @item show backtrace past-main
5245 @kindex show backtrace
5246 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
5247
5248 @item set backtrace past-entry
5249 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
5250 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
5251 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
5252 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
5253
5254 @item set backtrace past-entry off
5255 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
5256 application. This is the default.
5257
5258 @item show backtrace past-entry
5259 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
5260
5261 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
5262 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
5263 @cindex backtrace limit
5264 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of zero means
5265 unlimited.
5266
5267 @item show backtrace limit
5268 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
5269 @end table
5270
5271 @node Selection
5272 @section Selecting a Frame
5273
5274 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
5275 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
5276 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
5277 of the stack frame just selected.
5278
5279 @table @code
5280 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
5281 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
5282 @item frame @var{n}
5283 @itemx f @var{n}
5284 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
5285 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
5286 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
5287 @code{main}.
5288
5289 @item frame @var{addr}
5290 @itemx f @var{addr}
5291 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
5292 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
5293 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
5294 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
5295 switches between them.
5296
5297 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
5298 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
5299
5300 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
5301 pointer and a program counter.
5302
5303 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
5304 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
5305
5306 @kindex up
5307 @item up @var{n}
5308 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5309 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
5310 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
5311
5312 @kindex down
5313 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
5314 @item down @var{n}
5315 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
5316 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
5317 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
5318 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
5319 @end table
5320
5321 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
5322 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
5323 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5324 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
5325
5326 @need 1000
5327 For example:
5328
5329 @smallexample
5330 @group
5331 (@value{GDBP}) up
5332 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
5333 at env.c:10
5334 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
5335 @end group
5336 @end smallexample
5337
5338 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
5339 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
5340 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
5341 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
5342 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
5343 for details.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex down-silently
5347 @kindex up-silently
5348 @item up-silently @var{n}
5349 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
5350 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
5351 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
5352 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
5353 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
5354 distracting.
5355 @end table
5356
5357 @node Frame Info
5358 @section Information About a Frame
5359
5360 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
5361 stack frame.
5362
5363 @table @code
5364 @item frame
5365 @itemx f
5366 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
5367 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
5368 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
5369 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
5370 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5371
5372 @kindex info frame
5373 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
5374 @item info frame
5375 @itemx info f
5376 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
5377 including:
5378
5379 @itemize @bullet
5380 @item
5381 the address of the frame
5382 @item
5383 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
5384 @item
5385 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
5386 @item
5387 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
5388 @item
5389 the address of the frame's arguments
5390 @item
5391 the address of the frame's local variables
5392 @item
5393 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
5394 @item
5395 which registers were saved in the frame
5396 @end itemize
5397
5398 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
5399 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
5400 the usual conventions.
5401
5402 @item info frame @var{addr}
5403 @itemx info f @var{addr}
5404 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
5405 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
5406 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
5407 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
5408 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
5409
5410 @kindex info args
5411 @item info args
5412 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
5413
5414 @item info locals
5415 @kindex info locals
5416 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
5417 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
5418 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
5419
5420 @kindex info catch
5421 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
5422 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
5423 @item info catch
5424 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
5425 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
5426 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
5427 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
5428 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
5429
5430 @end table
5431
5432
5433 @node Source
5434 @chapter Examining Source Files
5435
5436 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
5437 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
5438 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
5439 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
5440 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
5441 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
5442 source files by explicit command.
5443
5444 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
5445 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
5446 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
5447
5448 @menu
5449 * List:: Printing source lines
5450 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
5451 * Edit:: Editing source files
5452 * Search:: Searching source files
5453 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
5454 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
5455 @end menu
5456
5457 @node List
5458 @section Printing Source Lines
5459
5460 @kindex list
5461 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
5462 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5463 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
5464 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
5465 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
5466
5467 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
5468
5469 @table @code
5470 @item list @var{linenum}
5471 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
5472 current source file.
5473
5474 @item list @var{function}
5475 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
5476 @var{function}.
5477
5478 @item list
5479 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
5480 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
5481 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
5482 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
5483 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
5484
5485 @item list -
5486 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5487 @end table
5488
5489 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
5490 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
5491 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
5492
5493 @table @code
5494 @kindex set listsize
5495 @item set listsize @var{count}
5496 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
5497 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
5498
5499 @kindex show listsize
5500 @item show listsize
5501 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
5502 @end table
5503
5504 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
5505 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
5506 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
5507 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
5508 each repetition moves up in the source file.
5509
5510 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
5511 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
5512 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
5513 to specify some source line.
5514
5515 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
5516
5517 @table @code
5518 @item list @var{linespec}
5519 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
5520
5521 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
5522 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
5523 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
5524 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
5525 the same source file as the first linespec.
5526
5527 @item list ,@var{last}
5528 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
5529
5530 @item list @var{first},
5531 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
5532
5533 @item list +
5534 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
5535
5536 @item list -
5537 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
5538
5539 @item list
5540 As described in the preceding table.
5541 @end table
5542
5543 @node Specify Location
5544 @section Specifying a Location
5545 @cindex specifying location
5546 @cindex linespec
5547
5548 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
5549 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
5550 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
5551 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
5552
5553 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
5554 @value{GDBN} understands:
5555
5556 @table @code
5557 @item @var{linenum}
5558 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
5559
5560 @item -@var{offset}
5561 @itemx +@var{offset}
5562 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
5563 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
5564 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
5565 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
5566 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
5567 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
5568 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
5569 linespec.
5570
5571 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5572 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
5573
5574 @item @var{function}
5575 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
5576 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
5577
5578 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
5579 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
5580 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
5581 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
5582 functions in different source files.
5583
5584 @item *@var{address}
5585 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
5586 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
5587 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
5588 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
5589 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
5590 source files.
5591
5592 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
5593 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
5594 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
5595 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
5596 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
5597 of @var{address}:
5598
5599 @table @code
5600 @item @var{expression}
5601 Any expression valid in the current working language.
5602
5603 @item @var{funcaddr}
5604 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
5605 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
5606 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
5607 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
5608 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
5609 (although the Pascal form also works).
5610
5611 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
5612 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
5613
5614 @item '@var{filename}'::@var{funcaddr}
5615 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
5616 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
5617 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
5618 functions with identical names in different source files.
5619 @end table
5620
5621 @end table
5622
5623
5624 @node Edit
5625 @section Editing Source Files
5626 @cindex editing source files
5627
5628 @kindex edit
5629 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
5630 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
5631 The editing program of your choice
5632 is invoked with the current line set to
5633 the active line in the program.
5634 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
5635 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
5636
5637 @table @code
5638 @item edit @var{location}
5639 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
5640 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
5641 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
5642 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
5643 command most commonly used:
5644
5645 @table @code
5646 @item edit @var{number}
5647 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
5648
5649 @item edit @var{function}
5650 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
5651 @end table
5652
5653 @end table
5654
5655 @subsection Choosing your Editor
5656 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
5657 @footnote{
5658 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
5659 following command-line syntax:
5660 @smallexample
5661 ex +@var{number} file
5662 @end smallexample
5663 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
5664 the file where to start editing.}.
5665 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
5666 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
5667 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
5668 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
5669 @smallexample
5670 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
5671 export EDITOR
5672 gdb @dots{}
5673 @end smallexample
5674 or in the @code{csh} shell,
5675 @smallexample
5676 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
5677 gdb @dots{}
5678 @end smallexample
5679
5680 @node Search
5681 @section Searching Source Files
5682 @cindex searching source files
5683
5684 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
5685 regular expression.
5686
5687 @table @code
5688 @kindex search
5689 @kindex forward-search
5690 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
5691 @itemx search @var{regexp}
5692 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
5693 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5694 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
5695 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
5696 @code{fo}.
5697
5698 @kindex reverse-search
5699 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
5700 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
5701 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
5702 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
5703 this command as @code{rev}.
5704 @end table
5705
5706 @node Source Path
5707 @section Specifying Source Directories
5708
5709 @cindex source path
5710 @cindex directories for source files
5711 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
5712 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
5713 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
5714 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
5715 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
5716 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
5717 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
5718
5719 For example, suppose an executable references the file
5720 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
5721 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
5722 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
5723 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
5724 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
5725 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
5726 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
5727 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
5728 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
5729 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
5730
5731 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
5732 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
5733 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
5734 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
5735 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
5736 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
5737
5738 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
5739 source files.
5740
5741 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
5742 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
5743 each line is in the file.
5744
5745 @kindex directory
5746 @kindex dir
5747 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
5748 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
5749 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
5750
5751 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
5752 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
5753
5754 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
5755 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
5756 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
5757 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
5758 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
5759 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
5760 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
5761 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
5762 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
5763 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
5764 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
5765 name to look up the sources.
5766
5767 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
5768 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
5769 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
5770 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
5771 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
5772 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
5773 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
5774 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
5775
5776 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
5777 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
5778 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
5779 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
5780 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
5781 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
5782 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
5783
5784 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
5785 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
5786 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
5787 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
5788 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
5789 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
5790 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
5791 command.
5792
5793 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
5794 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
5795 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
5796 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
5797 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
5798 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
5799 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
5800
5801 @table @code
5802 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
5803 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
5804 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
5805 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
5806 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
5807 part of absolute file names) or
5808 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
5809 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
5810
5811 @kindex cdir
5812 @kindex cwd
5813 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
5814 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
5815 @cindex compilation directory
5816 @cindex current directory
5817 @cindex working directory
5818 @cindex directory, current
5819 @cindex directory, compilation
5820 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
5821 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
5822 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
5823 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
5824 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
5825 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
5826
5827 @item directory
5828 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
5829
5830 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
5831 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
5832
5833 @item show directories
5834 @kindex show directories
5835 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
5836
5837 @anchor{set substitute-path}
5838 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
5839 @kindex set substitute-path
5840 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
5841 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
5842 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
5843
5844 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
5845 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
5846
5847 @smallexample
5848 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
5849 @end smallexample
5850
5851 @noindent
5852 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
5853 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
5854 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
5855
5856 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
5857 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
5858 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
5859 the substitution.
5860
5861 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
5862
5863 @smallexample
5864 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
5865 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
5866 @end smallexample
5867
5868 @noindent
5869 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
5870 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
5871 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
5872 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
5873
5874
5875 @item unset substitute-path [path]
5876 @kindex unset substitute-path
5877 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
5878 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
5879 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
5880
5881 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
5882
5883 @item show substitute-path [path]
5884 @kindex show substitute-path
5885 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
5886 which would rewrite that path, if any.
5887
5888 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
5889 rules.
5890
5891 @end table
5892
5893 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
5894 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
5895 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
5896
5897 @enumerate
5898 @item
5899 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
5900
5901 @item
5902 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
5903 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
5904 directories in one command.
5905 @end enumerate
5906
5907 @node Machine Code
5908 @section Source and Machine Code
5909 @cindex source line and its code address
5910
5911 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
5912 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
5913 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
5914 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
5915 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
5916 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5917 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
5918 well as hex.
5919
5920 @table @code
5921 @kindex info line
5922 @item info line @var{linespec}
5923 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
5924 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
5925 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
5926 @end table
5927
5928 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
5929 the object code for the first line of function
5930 @code{m4_changequote}:
5931
5932 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
5933 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
5934 @smallexample
5935 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
5936 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
5937 @end smallexample
5938
5939 @noindent
5940 @cindex code address and its source line
5941 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
5942 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
5943 @smallexample
5944 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
5945 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
5946 @end smallexample
5947
5948 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
5949 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
5950 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
5951 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
5952 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
5953 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
5954 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
5955 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5956 Variables}).
5957
5958 @table @code
5959 @kindex disassemble
5960 @cindex assembly instructions
5961 @cindex instructions, assembly
5962 @cindex machine instructions
5963 @cindex listing machine instructions
5964 @item disassemble
5965 @itemx disassemble /m
5966 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
5967 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
5968 the @code{/m} modifier.
5969 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
5970 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
5971 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
5972 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
5973 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
5974 @end table
5975
5976 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
5977 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
5978
5979 @smallexample
5980 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
5981 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
5982 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
5983 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
5984 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5985 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
5986 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
5987 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
5988 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
5989 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
5990 End of assembler dump.
5991 @end smallexample
5992
5993 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86:
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
5997 Dump of assembler code for function main:
5998 5 @{
5999 0x08048330 <main+0>: push %ebp
6000 0x08048331 <main+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
6001 0x08048333 <main+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
6002 0x08048336 <main+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
6003 0x08048339 <main+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
6004
6005 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
6006 0x0804833c <main+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
6007 0x08048343 <main+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
6008
6009 7 return 0;
6010 8 @}
6011 0x08048348 <main+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
6012 0x0804834d <main+29>: leave
6013 0x0804834e <main+30>: ret
6014
6015 End of assembler dump.
6016 @end smallexample
6017
6018 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
6019 mnemonics or other syntax.
6020
6021 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
6022 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
6023 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
6024 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
6025 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
6026
6027 @table @code
6028 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
6029 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
6030 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
6031 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
6032 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
6033 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
6034
6035 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
6036 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
6037 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
6038 assemblers for x86-based targets.
6039
6040 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
6041 @item show disassembly-flavor
6042 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
6043 @end table
6044
6045 @table @code
6046 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
6047 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
6048 @item set disassemble-next-line
6049 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
6050 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble next source line
6051 when execution stops. If ON, GDB will display disassembly of the next
6052 source line when execution of the program being debugged stops.
6053 If AUTO (which is the default), or there's no line info to determine
6054 the source line of the next instruction, display disassembly of next
6055 instruction instead.
6056 @end table
6057
6058
6059 @node Data
6060 @chapter Examining Data
6061
6062 @cindex printing data
6063 @cindex examining data
6064 @kindex print
6065 @kindex inspect
6066 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
6067 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
6068 @c different window or something like that.
6069 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
6070 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
6071 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
6072 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
6073 Different Languages}).
6074
6075 @table @code
6076 @item print @var{expr}
6077 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
6078 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
6079 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
6080 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
6081 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
6082 Formats}.
6083
6084 @item print
6085 @itemx print /@var{f}
6086 @cindex reprint the last value
6087 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
6088 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
6089 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
6090 @end table
6091
6092 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
6093 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
6094 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6095
6096 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
6097 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
6098 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
6099 Table}.
6100
6101 @menu
6102 * Expressions:: Expressions
6103 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
6104 * Variables:: Program variables
6105 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
6106 * Output Formats:: Output formats
6107 * Memory:: Examining memory
6108 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
6109 * Print Settings:: Print settings
6110 * Value History:: Value history
6111 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
6112 * Registers:: Registers
6113 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
6114 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
6115 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
6116 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
6117 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
6118 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
6119 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
6120 character set than GDB does
6121 * Caching Remote Data:: Data caching for remote targets
6122 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
6123 @end menu
6124
6125 @node Expressions
6126 @section Expressions
6127
6128 @cindex expressions
6129 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
6130 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
6131 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
6132 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
6133 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
6134 you compiled your program to include this information; see
6135 @ref{Compilation}.
6136
6137 @cindex arrays in expressions
6138 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
6139 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
6140 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
6141 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
6142 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
6143 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
6144
6145 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
6146 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
6147 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
6148 languages.
6149
6150 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
6151 expressions regardless of your programming language.
6152
6153 @cindex casts, in expressions
6154 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
6155 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
6156 at that address in memory.
6157 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
6158
6159 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
6160 to programming languages:
6161
6162 @table @code
6163 @item @@
6164 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
6165 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
6166
6167 @item ::
6168 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
6169 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
6170
6171 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
6172 @cindex type casting memory
6173 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
6174 @cindex casts, to view memory
6175 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
6176 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
6177 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
6178 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
6179 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
6180 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
6181 @end table
6182
6183 @node Ambiguous Expressions
6184 @section Ambiguous Expressions
6185 @cindex ambiguous expressions
6186
6187 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
6188 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
6189 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
6190 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
6191 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
6192 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
6193 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
6194
6195 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
6196 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
6197 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
6198 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
6199 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
6200 as well.
6201
6202 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
6203 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
6204 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
6205 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
6206 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
6207 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
6208 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
6209 choices.
6210
6211 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
6212 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
6213 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
6214
6215 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
6216 @smallexample
6217 @group
6218 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
6219 [0] cancel
6220 [1] all
6221 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
6222 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
6223 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
6224 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
6225 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
6226 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
6227 > 2 4 6
6228 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
6229 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
6230 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
6231 Multiple breakpoints were set.
6232 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
6233 breakpoints.
6234 (@value{GDBP})
6235 @end group
6236 @end smallexample
6237
6238 @table @code
6239 @kindex set multiple-symbols
6240 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
6241 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
6242
6243 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
6244 is ambiguous.
6245
6246 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
6247 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
6248 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
6249 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
6250 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
6251 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
6252 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
6253 in the use of the menu.
6254
6255 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
6256 when an ambiguity is detected.
6257
6258 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
6259 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
6260
6261 @kindex show multiple-symbols
6262 @item show multiple-symbols
6263 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
6264 @end table
6265
6266 @node Variables
6267 @section Program Variables
6268
6269 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
6270 in your program.
6271
6272 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
6273 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
6274
6275 @itemize @bullet
6276 @item
6277 global (or file-static)
6278 @end itemize
6279
6280 @noindent or
6281
6282 @itemize @bullet
6283 @item
6284 visible according to the scope rules of the
6285 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
6286 @end itemize
6287
6288 @noindent This means that in the function
6289
6290 @smallexample
6291 foo (a)
6292 int a;
6293 @{
6294 bar (a);
6295 @{
6296 int b = test ();
6297 bar (b);
6298 @}
6299 @}
6300 @end smallexample
6301
6302 @noindent
6303 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
6304 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
6305 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
6306 the block where @code{b} is declared.
6307
6308 @cindex variable name conflict
6309 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
6310 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
6311 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
6312 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
6313 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
6314 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
6315 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
6316
6317 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
6318 @ifnotinfo
6319 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
6320 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
6321 @end ifnotinfo
6322 @smallexample
6323 @var{file}::@var{variable}
6324 @var{function}::@var{variable}
6325 @end smallexample
6326
6327 @noindent
6328 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
6329 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
6330 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
6331 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
6332
6333 @smallexample
6334 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
6335 @end smallexample
6336
6337 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
6338 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
6339 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
6340 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
6341 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
6342 @c conflict?? --mew
6343
6344 @cindex wrong values
6345 @cindex variable values, wrong
6346 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
6347 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
6348 @quotation
6349 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
6350 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
6351 scope, and just before exit.
6352 @end quotation
6353 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
6354 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
6355 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
6356 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
6357 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
6358 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
6359 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
6360 variable definitions may be gone.
6361
6362 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
6363 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
6364 when compiling.
6365
6366 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
6367 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
6368 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
6369 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
6370 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
6371 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
6372 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
6373
6374 @smallexample
6375 No symbol "foo" in current context.
6376 @end smallexample
6377
6378 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
6379 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
6380 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler,
6381 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
6382 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
6383 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
6384 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
6385 for Debugging Your Program or GCC, gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu}
6386 Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
6387 @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug info formats
6388 that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
6389
6390 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
6391 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
6392 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
6393 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
6394
6395 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
6396 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
6397 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
6398 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
6399 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
6400 For program code
6401
6402 @smallexample
6403 char var0[] = "A";
6404 signed char var1[] = "A";
6405 @end smallexample
6406
6407 You get during debugging
6408 @smallexample
6409 (gdb) print var0
6410 $1 = "A"
6411 (gdb) print var1
6412 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
6413 @end smallexample
6414
6415 @node Arrays
6416 @section Artificial Arrays
6417
6418 @cindex artificial array
6419 @cindex arrays
6420 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
6421 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
6422 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
6423 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
6424 program.
6425
6426 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
6427 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
6428 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
6429 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
6430 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
6431 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
6432 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
6433 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
6434 example. If a program says
6435
6436 @smallexample
6437 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
6438 @end smallexample
6439
6440 @noindent
6441 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
6442
6443 @smallexample
6444 p *array@@len
6445 @end smallexample
6446
6447 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
6448 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
6449 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
6450 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
6451 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
6452
6453 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
6454 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
6455 The value need not be in memory:
6456 @smallexample
6457 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
6458 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6459 @end smallexample
6460
6461 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
6462 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
6463 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
6464 @smallexample
6465 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
6466 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
6467 @end smallexample
6468
6469 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
6470 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
6471 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
6472 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
6473 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
6474 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
6475 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
6476 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
6477 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
6478 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 set $i = 0
6482 p dtab[$i++]->fv
6483 @key{RET}
6484 @key{RET}
6485 @dots{}
6486 @end smallexample
6487
6488 @node Output Formats
6489 @section Output Formats
6490
6491 @cindex formatted output
6492 @cindex output formats
6493 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
6494 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
6495 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
6496 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
6497 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
6498
6499 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
6500 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
6501 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
6502 letters supported are:
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @item x
6506 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
6507 hexadecimal.
6508
6509 @item d
6510 Print as integer in signed decimal.
6511
6512 @item u
6513 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
6514
6515 @item o
6516 Print as integer in octal.
6517
6518 @item t
6519 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
6520 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
6521 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
6522 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
6523
6524 @item a
6525 @cindex unknown address, locating
6526 @cindex locate address
6527 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
6528 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
6529 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
6530
6531 @smallexample
6532 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
6533 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
6534 @end smallexample
6535
6536 @noindent
6537 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
6538 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
6539
6540 @item c
6541 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
6542 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
6543 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
6544 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
6545
6546 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
6547 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
6548 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
6549 data.
6550
6551 @item f
6552 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
6553 using typical floating point syntax.
6554
6555 @item s
6556 @cindex printing strings
6557 @cindex printing byte arrays
6558 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
6559 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
6560 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
6561 natural types.
6562
6563 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
6564 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
6565 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
6566 array.
6567 @end table
6568
6569 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 p/x $pc
6573 @end smallexample
6574
6575 @noindent
6576 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
6577 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
6578
6579 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
6580 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
6581 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
6582
6583 @node Memory
6584 @section Examining Memory
6585
6586 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
6587 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
6588
6589 @cindex examining memory
6590 @table @code
6591 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
6592 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
6593 @itemx x @var{addr}
6594 @itemx x
6595 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
6596 @end table
6597
6598 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
6599 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
6600 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
6601 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
6602 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
6603
6604 @table @r
6605 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
6606 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
6607 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
6608 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
6609 @c 4.1.2.
6610
6611 @item @var{f}, the display format
6612 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
6613 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
6614 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
6615 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
6616 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
6617
6618 @item @var{u}, the unit size
6619 The unit size is any of
6620
6621 @table @code
6622 @item b
6623 Bytes.
6624 @item h
6625 Halfwords (two bytes).
6626 @item w
6627 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
6628 @item g
6629 Giant words (eight bytes).
6630 @end table
6631
6632 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
6633 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
6634 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
6635
6636 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
6637 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
6638 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
6639 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
6640 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
6641 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
6642 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
6643 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
6644 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
6645 a value from memory).
6646 @end table
6647
6648 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
6649 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
6650 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
6651 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
6652 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
6653
6654 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
6655 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
6656 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
6657 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
6658 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
6659
6660 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
6661 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
6662 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
6663 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
6664 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
6665 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
6666 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
6667 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
6668 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
6669
6670 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
6671 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
6672 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
6673 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
6674 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
6675 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
6676 for successive uses of @code{x}.
6677
6678 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
6679 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
6680 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
6681 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
6682 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
6683 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
6684 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
6685 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
6686 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
6687
6688 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
6689 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
6690 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
6691
6692 @cindex remote memory comparison
6693 @cindex verify remote memory image
6694 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
6695 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image in the
6696 remote machine's memory against the executable file you downloaded to
6697 the target. The @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such
6698 situations.
6699
6700 @table @code
6701 @kindex compare-sections
6702 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{]}
6703 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
6704 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
6705 the remote machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
6706 arguments, compares all loadable sections. This command's
6707 availability depends on the target's support for the @code{"qCRC"}
6708 remote request.
6709 @end table
6710
6711 @node Auto Display
6712 @section Automatic Display
6713 @cindex automatic display
6714 @cindex display of expressions
6715
6716 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
6717 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
6718 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
6719 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
6720 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
6721 The automatic display looks like this:
6722
6723 @smallexample
6724 2: foo = 38
6725 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
6726 @end smallexample
6727
6728 @noindent
6729 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
6730 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
6731 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
6732 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
6733 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
6734 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
6735
6736 @table @code
6737 @kindex display
6738 @item display @var{expr}
6739 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
6740 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
6741
6742 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
6743
6744 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
6745 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
6746 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
6747 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
6748 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
6749
6750 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
6751 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
6752 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
6753 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
6754 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
6755 @end table
6756
6757 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
6758 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
6759 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
6760
6761 @table @code
6762 @kindex delete display
6763 @kindex undisplay
6764 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
6765 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6766 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
6767
6768 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
6769 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
6770
6771 @kindex disable display
6772 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6773 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
6774 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
6775 enabled again later.
6776
6777 @kindex enable display
6778 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
6779 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
6780 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
6781
6782 @item display
6783 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
6784 done when your program stops.
6785
6786 @kindex info display
6787 @item info display
6788 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
6789 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
6790 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
6791 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
6792 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
6793 @end table
6794
6795 @cindex display disabled out of scope
6796 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
6797 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
6798 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
6799 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
6800 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
6801 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
6802 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
6803 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
6804 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
6805 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
6806
6807 @node Print Settings
6808 @section Print Settings
6809
6810 @cindex format options
6811 @cindex print settings
6812 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
6813 and symbols are printed.
6814
6815 @noindent
6816 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
6817
6818 @table @code
6819 @kindex set print
6820 @item set print address
6821 @itemx set print address on
6822 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
6823 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
6824 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
6825 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
6826 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
6827 @code{set print address on}:
6828
6829 @smallexample
6830 @group
6831 (@value{GDBP}) f
6832 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
6833 at input.c:530
6834 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6835 @end group
6836 @end smallexample
6837
6838 @item set print address off
6839 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
6840 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
6841
6842 @smallexample
6843 @group
6844 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
6845 (@value{GDBP}) f
6846 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
6847 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
6848 @end group
6849 @end smallexample
6850
6851 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
6852 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
6853 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
6854 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
6855
6856 @kindex show print
6857 @item show print address
6858 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
6859 @end table
6860
6861 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
6862 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
6863 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
6864 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
6865 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
6866 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
6867 it prints a symbolic address:
6868
6869 @table @code
6870 @item set print symbol-filename on
6871 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
6872 @cindex symbol, source file and line
6873 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
6874 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6875
6876 @item set print symbol-filename off
6877 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
6878 default.
6879
6880 @item show print symbol-filename
6881 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
6882 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
6883 @end table
6884
6885 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
6886 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
6887 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
6888
6889 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
6890 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
6891
6892 @table @code
6893 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
6894 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
6895 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
6896 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
6897 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
6898 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
6899
6900 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
6901 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
6902 symbolic address.
6903 @end table
6904
6905 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
6906 @cindex pointer, finding referent
6907 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
6908 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
6909 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
6910 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
6911 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
6912 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
6913
6914 @smallexample
6915 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
6916 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
6917 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
6918 @end smallexample
6919
6920 @quotation
6921 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
6922 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
6923 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
6924 @end quotation
6925
6926 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
6927
6928 @table @code
6929 @item set print array
6930 @itemx set print array on
6931 @cindex pretty print arrays
6932 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
6933 but uses more space. The default is off.
6934
6935 @item set print array off
6936 Return to compressed format for arrays.
6937
6938 @item show print array
6939 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
6940 arrays.
6941
6942 @cindex print array indexes
6943 @item set print array-indexes
6944 @itemx set print array-indexes on
6945 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
6946 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
6947 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
6948
6949 @item set print array-indexes off
6950 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
6951
6952 @item show print array-indexes
6953 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
6954 arrays.
6955
6956 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
6957 @cindex number of array elements to print
6958 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
6959 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
6960 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
6961 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
6962 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
6963 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
6964 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
6965
6966 @item show print elements
6967 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
6968 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
6969
6970 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
6971 @cindex printing frame argument values
6972 @cindex print all frame argument values
6973 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
6974 @cindex do not print frame argument values
6975 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
6976 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
6977 values are:
6978
6979 @table @code
6980 @item all
6981 The values of all arguments are printed. This is the default.
6982
6983 @item scalars
6984 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
6985 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
6986 by @code{@dots{}}. Here is an example where only scalar arguments are shown:
6987
6988 @smallexample
6989 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
6990 at frame-args.c:23
6991 @end smallexample
6992
6993 @item none
6994 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
6995 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
6996
6997 @smallexample
6998 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
6999 at frame-args.c:23
7000 @end smallexample
7001 @end table
7002
7003 By default, all argument values are always printed. But this command
7004 can be useful in several cases. For instance, it can be used to reduce
7005 the amount of information printed in each frame, making the backtrace
7006 more readable. Also, this command can be used to improve performance
7007 when displaying Ada frames, because the computation of large arguments
7008 can sometimes be CPU-intensive, especiallly in large applications.
7009 Setting @code{print frame-arguments} to @code{scalars} or @code{none}
7010 avoids this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
7011
7012 @item show print frame-arguments
7013 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
7014
7015 @item set print repeats
7016 @cindex repeated array elements
7017 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
7018 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
7019 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
7020 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
7021 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
7022 themselves. Setting the threshold to zero will cause all elements to
7023 be individually printed. The default threshold is 10.
7024
7025 @item show print repeats
7026 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
7027 elements.
7028
7029 @item set print null-stop
7030 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
7031 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
7032 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
7033 contain only short strings.
7034 The default is off.
7035
7036 @item show print null-stop
7037 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
7038 @sc{null} character.
7039
7040 @item set print pretty on
7041 @cindex print structures in indented form
7042 @cindex indentation in structure display
7043 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
7044 per line, like this:
7045
7046 @smallexample
7047 @group
7048 $1 = @{
7049 next = 0x0,
7050 flags = @{
7051 sweet = 1,
7052 sour = 1
7053 @},
7054 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
7055 @}
7056 @end group
7057 @end smallexample
7058
7059 @item set print pretty off
7060 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
7061
7062 @smallexample
7063 @group
7064 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
7065 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
7066 @end group
7067 @end smallexample
7068
7069 @noindent
7070 This is the default format.
7071
7072 @item show print pretty
7073 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
7074
7075 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
7076 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
7077 @cindex octal escapes in strings
7078 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
7079 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
7080 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
7081 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
7082 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
7083
7084 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
7085 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
7086 international character sets, and is the default.
7087
7088 @item show print sevenbit-strings
7089 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
7090
7091 @item set print union on
7092 @cindex unions in structures, printing
7093 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
7094 and other unions. This is the default setting.
7095
7096 @item set print union off
7097 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
7098 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
7099 instead.
7100
7101 @item show print union
7102 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
7103 structures and other unions.
7104
7105 For example, given the declarations
7106
7107 @smallexample
7108 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
7109 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
7110 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
7111 Bug_forms;
7112
7113 struct thing @{
7114 Species it;
7115 union @{
7116 Tree_forms tree;
7117 Bug_forms bug;
7118 @} form;
7119 @};
7120
7121 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
7122 @end smallexample
7123
7124 @noindent
7125 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
7126
7127 @smallexample
7128 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
7129 @end smallexample
7130
7131 @noindent
7132 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
7133
7134 @smallexample
7135 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
7136 @end smallexample
7137
7138 @noindent
7139 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
7140 and in Pascal.
7141 @end table
7142
7143 @need 1000
7144 @noindent
7145 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
7146
7147 @table @code
7148 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
7149 @item set print demangle
7150 @itemx set print demangle on
7151 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
7152 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
7153 linkage. The default is on.
7154
7155 @item show print demangle
7156 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
7157
7158 @item set print asm-demangle
7159 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
7160 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
7161 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
7162 The default is off.
7163
7164 @item show print asm-demangle
7165 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
7166 or demangled form.
7167
7168 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
7169 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
7170 @kindex set demangle-style
7171 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
7172 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
7173 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
7174
7175 @table @code
7176 @item auto
7177 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
7178
7179 @item gnu
7180 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
7181 This is the default.
7182
7183 @item hp
7184 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
7185
7186 @item lucid
7187 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
7188
7189 @item arm
7190 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
7191 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
7192 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
7193 require further enhancement to permit that.
7194
7195 @end table
7196 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
7197
7198 @item show demangle-style
7199 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
7200
7201 @item set print object
7202 @itemx set print object on
7203 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
7204 @cindex display derived types
7205 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
7206 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
7207 the virtual function table.
7208
7209 @item set print object off
7210 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
7211 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
7212
7213 @item show print object
7214 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
7215
7216 @item set print static-members
7217 @itemx set print static-members on
7218 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
7219 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
7220
7221 @item set print static-members off
7222 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
7223
7224 @item show print static-members
7225 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
7226
7227 @item set print pascal_static-members
7228 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
7229 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
7230 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
7231 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
7232
7233 @item set print pascal_static-members off
7234 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
7235
7236 @item show print pascal_static-members
7237 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
7238
7239 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
7240 @item set print vtbl
7241 @itemx set print vtbl on
7242 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
7243 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
7244 @cindex VTBL display
7245 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
7246 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
7247 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
7248
7249 @item set print vtbl off
7250 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
7251
7252 @item show print vtbl
7253 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
7254 @end table
7255
7256 @node Value History
7257 @section Value History
7258
7259 @cindex value history
7260 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
7261 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
7262 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
7263 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
7264 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
7265 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
7266 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
7267 symbol table.
7268
7269 @cindex @code{$}
7270 @cindex @code{$$}
7271 @cindex history number
7272 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
7273 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
7274 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
7275 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
7276 history number.
7277
7278 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
7279 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
7280 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
7281 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
7282 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
7283 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
7284 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
7285
7286 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
7287 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
7288
7289 @smallexample
7290 p *$
7291 @end smallexample
7292
7293 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
7294 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
7295
7296 @smallexample
7297 p *$.next
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 @noindent
7301 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
7302 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
7303
7304 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
7305 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
7306
7307 @smallexample
7308 print x
7309 set x=5
7310 @end smallexample
7311
7312 @noindent
7313 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
7314 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
7315
7316 @table @code
7317 @kindex show values
7318 @item show values
7319 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
7320 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
7321 values} does not change the history.
7322
7323 @item show values @var{n}
7324 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
7325
7326 @item show values +
7327 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
7328 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
7329 @end table
7330
7331 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
7332 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
7333
7334 @node Convenience Vars
7335 @section Convenience Variables
7336
7337 @cindex convenience variables
7338 @cindex user-defined variables
7339 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
7340 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
7341 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
7342 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
7343 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
7344
7345 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
7346 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
7347 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
7348 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
7349 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
7350
7351 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
7352 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
7353 For example:
7354
7355 @smallexample
7356 set $foo = *object_ptr
7357 @end smallexample
7358
7359 @noindent
7360 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
7361 @code{object_ptr}.
7362
7363 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
7364 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
7365 value with another assignment at any time.
7366
7367 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
7368 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
7369 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
7370 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
7371
7372 @table @code
7373 @kindex show convenience
7374 @cindex show all user variables
7375 @item show convenience
7376 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
7377 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
7378
7379 @kindex init-if-undefined
7380 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
7381 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
7382 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
7383 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
7384 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
7385 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
7386 override default values used in a command script.
7387
7388 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
7389 any side-effects do not occur.
7390 @end table
7391
7392 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
7393 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
7394 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
7395
7396 @smallexample
7397 set $i = 0
7398 print bar[$i++]->contents
7399 @end smallexample
7400
7401 @noindent
7402 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
7403
7404 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
7405 values likely to be useful.
7406
7407 @table @code
7408 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
7409 @item $_
7410 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
7411 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
7412 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
7413 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
7414 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
7415 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
7416 to the type of @code{$__}.
7417
7418 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
7419 @item $__
7420 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
7421 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
7422 to match the format in which the data was printed.
7423
7424 @item $_exitcode
7425 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
7426 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
7427 the program being debugged terminates.
7428
7429 @item $_siginfo
7430 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
7431 The variable @code{$_siginfo} is bound to extra signal information
7432 inspection (@pxref{extra signal information}).
7433 @end table
7434
7435 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
7436 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
7437 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
7438
7439 @node Registers
7440 @section Registers
7441
7442 @cindex registers
7443 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
7444 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
7445 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
7446 your machine.
7447
7448 @table @code
7449 @kindex info registers
7450 @item info registers
7451 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
7452 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7453
7454 @kindex info all-registers
7455 @cindex floating point registers
7456 @item info all-registers
7457 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
7458 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
7459
7460 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
7461 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
7462 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
7463 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
7464 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
7465 @end table
7466
7467 @cindex stack pointer register
7468 @cindex program counter register
7469 @cindex process status register
7470 @cindex frame pointer register
7471 @cindex standard registers
7472 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
7473 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
7474 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
7475 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
7476 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
7477 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
7478 register that contains the processor status. For example,
7479 you could print the program counter in hex with
7480
7481 @smallexample
7482 p/x $pc
7483 @end smallexample
7484
7485 @noindent
7486 or print the instruction to be executed next with
7487
7488 @smallexample
7489 x/i $pc
7490 @end smallexample
7491
7492 @noindent
7493 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
7494 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
7495 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
7496 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
7497 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
7498 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
7499 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
7500
7501 @smallexample
7502 set $sp += 4
7503 @end smallexample
7504
7505 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
7506 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
7507 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
7508 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
7509 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
7510 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
7511 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
7512
7513 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
7514 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
7515 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
7516 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
7517 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
7518 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
7519 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
7520
7521 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
7522 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
7523 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
7524 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
7525 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
7526 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
7527 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
7528 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
7529 prints the data in both formats.
7530
7531 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
7532 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
7533 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
7534 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
7535 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
7536 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
7537 registers in @code{struct} notation:
7538
7539 @smallexample
7540 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
7541 $1 = @{
7542 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
7543 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
7544 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
7545 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
7546 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
7547 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
7548 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
7549 @}
7550 @end smallexample
7551
7552 @noindent
7553 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
7554 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
7555 value to a @code{struct} member:
7556
7557 @smallexample
7558 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
7559 @end smallexample
7560
7561 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
7562 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
7563 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
7564 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
7565 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
7566 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
7567
7568 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
7569 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
7570 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
7571 frame makes no difference.
7572
7573 @node Floating Point Hardware
7574 @section Floating Point Hardware
7575 @cindex floating point
7576
7577 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
7578 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
7579
7580 @table @code
7581 @kindex info float
7582 @item info float
7583 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
7584 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
7585 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
7586 the ARM and x86 machines.
7587 @end table
7588
7589 @node Vector Unit
7590 @section Vector Unit
7591 @cindex vector unit
7592
7593 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
7594 more information about the status of the vector unit.
7595
7596 @table @code
7597 @kindex info vector
7598 @item info vector
7599 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
7600 layout vary depending on the hardware.
7601 @end table
7602
7603 @node OS Information
7604 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
7605 @cindex OS information
7606
7607 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
7608 you debug your program.
7609
7610 @cindex @code{ptrace} system call
7611 @cindex @code{struct user} contents
7612 When @value{GDBN} runs on a @dfn{Posix system} (such as GNU or Unix
7613 machines), it interfaces with the inferior via the @code{ptrace}
7614 system call. The operating system creates a special sata structure,
7615 called @code{struct user}, for this interface. You can use the
7616 command @code{info udot} to display the contents of this data
7617 structure.
7618
7619 @table @code
7620 @item info udot
7621 @kindex info udot
7622 Display the contents of the @code{struct user} maintained by the OS
7623 kernel for the program being debugged. @value{GDBN} displays the
7624 contents of @code{struct user} as a list of hex numbers, similar to
7625 the @code{examine} command.
7626 @end table
7627
7628 @cindex auxiliary vector
7629 @cindex vector, auxiliary
7630 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
7631 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
7632 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
7633 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
7634 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
7635 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
7636 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
7637 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
7638 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
7639 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
7640 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
7641
7642 @table @code
7643 @kindex info auxv
7644 @item info auxv
7645 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
7646 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
7647 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
7648 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
7649 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
7650 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
7651 an unrecognized tag.
7652 @end table
7653
7654 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating-system-specific information
7655 and display it to user, without interpretation. For remote targets,
7656 this functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
7657 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
7658
7659 @table @code
7660 @kindex info os processes
7661 @item info os processes
7662 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
7663 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, and
7664 the command corresponding to the process.
7665 @end table
7666
7667 @node Memory Region Attributes
7668 @section Memory Region Attributes
7669 @cindex memory region attributes
7670
7671 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
7672 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
7673 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
7674 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
7675 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
7676 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
7677 user can override the fetched regions.
7678
7679 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
7680 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
7681 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
7682 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
7683 all memory.
7684
7685 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
7686 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
7687
7688 @table @code
7689 @kindex mem
7690 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
7691 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
7692 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
7693 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
7694 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
7695 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
7696
7697 @item mem auto
7698 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
7699 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
7700
7701 @kindex delete mem
7702 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7703 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
7704 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
7705
7706 @kindex disable mem
7707 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7708 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7709 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
7710 It may be enabled again later.
7711
7712 @kindex enable mem
7713 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
7714 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
7715
7716 @kindex info mem
7717 @item info mem
7718 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
7719 for each region:
7720
7721 @table @emph
7722 @item Memory Region Number
7723 @item Enabled or Disabled.
7724 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
7725 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
7726
7727 @item Lo Address
7728 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
7729
7730 @item Hi Address
7731 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
7732
7733 @item Attributes
7734 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
7735 @end table
7736 @end table
7737
7738
7739 @subsection Attributes
7740
7741 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
7742 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
7743 write accesses to a memory region.
7744
7745 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
7746 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
7747 etc.@: from accessing memory.
7748
7749 @table @code
7750 @item ro
7751 Memory is read only.
7752 @item wo
7753 Memory is write only.
7754 @item rw
7755 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
7756 @end table
7757
7758 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
7759 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
7760 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
7761 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
7762 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
7763
7764 @table @code
7765 @item 8
7766 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
7767 @item 16
7768 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
7769 @item 32
7770 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
7771 @item 64
7772 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
7773 @end table
7774
7775 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
7776 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7777 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
7778 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
7779 @c
7780 @c @table @code
7781 @c @item hwbreak
7782 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
7783 @c @item swbreak (default)
7784 @c @end table
7785
7786 @subsubsection Data Cache
7787 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
7788 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
7789 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
7790 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
7791 registers.
7792
7793 @table @code
7794 @item cache
7795 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
7796 @item nocache
7797 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
7798 @end table
7799
7800 @subsection Memory Access Checking
7801 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
7802 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
7803 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
7804 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
7805
7806 @table @code
7807 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
7808 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
7809 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
7810 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
7811 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
7812 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
7813 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
7814 The default value is @code{on}.
7815 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
7816 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
7817 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
7818 @end table
7819
7820
7821 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
7822 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
7823 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
7824 @c
7825 @c @table @code
7826 @c @item verify
7827 @c @item noverify (default)
7828 @c @end table
7829
7830 @node Dump/Restore Files
7831 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
7832 @cindex dump/restore files
7833 @cindex append data to a file
7834 @cindex dump data to a file
7835 @cindex restore data from a file
7836
7837 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
7838 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
7839 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
7840 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
7841 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
7842 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
7843 files.
7844
7845 @table @code
7846
7847 @kindex dump
7848 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7849 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7850 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7851 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
7852
7853 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
7854 @table @code
7855 @item binary
7856 Raw binary form.
7857 @item ihex
7858 Intel hex format.
7859 @item srec
7860 Motorola S-record format.
7861 @item tekhex
7862 Tektronix Hex format.
7863 @end table
7864
7865 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
7866 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
7867 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
7868 form.
7869
7870 @kindex append
7871 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
7872 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
7873 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
7874 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
7875 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
7876
7877 @kindex restore
7878 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
7879 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
7880 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
7881 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
7882 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
7883
7884 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
7885 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
7886 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
7887 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
7888 from that location.
7889
7890 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
7891 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
7892 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
7893 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
7894
7895 @end table
7896
7897 @node Core File Generation
7898 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
7899 @cindex dump core from inferior
7900
7901 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
7902 image of a running process and its process status (register values
7903 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
7904 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
7905 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
7906 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
7907 the post-mortem debugging mode.
7908
7909 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
7910 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
7911 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @kindex gcore
7915 @kindex generate-core-file
7916 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
7917 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
7918 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
7919 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
7920 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
7921 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
7922
7923 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
7924 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, Unixware, and S390).
7925 @end table
7926
7927 @node Character Sets
7928 @section Character Sets
7929 @cindex character sets
7930 @cindex charset
7931 @cindex translating between character sets
7932 @cindex host character set
7933 @cindex target character set
7934
7935 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
7936 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
7937 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
7938 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
7939 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
7940 @dfn{target character set}.
7941
7942 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
7943 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
7944 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
7945 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
7946 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
7947 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
7948 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
7949 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
7950 character and string literals in expressions.
7951
7952 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
7953 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
7954 target-charset} command, described below.
7955
7956 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
7957 support:
7958
7959 @table @code
7960 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
7961 @kindex set target-charset
7962 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
7963 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
7964 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7965 list the target character sets it supports.
7966 @end table
7967
7968 @table @code
7969 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
7970 @kindex set host-charset
7971 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
7972
7973 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
7974 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
7975 @code{set host-charset} command.
7976
7977 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
7978 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
7979 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
7980 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
7981 list the host character sets it supports.
7982
7983 @item set charset @var{charset}
7984 @kindex set charset
7985 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
7986 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
7987 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
7988 for both host and target.
7989
7990
7991 @item show charset
7992 @kindex show charset
7993 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
7994
7995 @itemx show host-charset
7996 @kindex show host-charset
7997 Show the name of the current host charset.
7998
7999 @itemx show target-charset
8000 @kindex show target-charset
8001 Show the name of the current target charset.
8002
8003 @end table
8004
8005 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
8006 sets:
8007
8008 @table @code
8009
8010 @item ASCII
8011 @cindex ASCII character set
8012 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
8013 character set.
8014
8015 @item ISO-8859-1
8016 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
8017 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
8018 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
8019 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
8020 this as its host character set.
8021
8022 @item EBCDIC-US
8023 @itemx IBM1047
8024 @cindex EBCDIC character set
8025 @cindex IBM1047 character set
8026 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
8027 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
8028 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
8029
8030 @end table
8031
8032 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
8033 @value{GDBN} is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
8034 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
8035
8036 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
8037 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
8038 @file{charset-test.c}:
8039
8040 @smallexample
8041 #include <stdio.h>
8042
8043 char ascii_hello[]
8044 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
8045 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
8046 char ibm1047_hello[]
8047 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
8048 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
8049
8050 main ()
8051 @{
8052 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8053 @}
8054 @end smallexample
8055
8056 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
8057 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
8058 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
8059
8060 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
8061
8062 @smallexample
8063 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
8064 $ gdb -nw charset-test
8065 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
8066 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8067 @dots{}
8068 (@value{GDBP})
8069 @end smallexample
8070
8071 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
8072 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
8073 strings:
8074
8075 @smallexample
8076 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8077 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
8078 (@value{GDBP})
8079 @end smallexample
8080
8081 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
8082 initial character set:
8083 @smallexample
8084 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
8085 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8086 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
8087 (@value{GDBP})
8088 @end smallexample
8089
8090 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
8091 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
8092 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
8093 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
8094 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
8095
8096 @smallexample
8097 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8098 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
8099 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8100 $2 = 72 'H'
8101 (@value{GDBP})
8102 @end smallexample
8103
8104 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
8105 literals you use in expressions:
8106
8107 @smallexample
8108 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8109 $3 = 43 '+'
8110 (@value{GDBP})
8111 @end smallexample
8112
8113 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
8114 character.
8115
8116 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
8117 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
8118 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
8119
8120 @smallexample
8121 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8122 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
8123 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8124 $5 = 200 '\310'
8125 (@value{GDBP})
8126 @end smallexample
8127
8128 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
8129 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
8130
8131 @smallexample
8132 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8133 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
8134 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
8135 @end smallexample
8136
8137 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
8138 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
8139 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
8140 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
8141 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
8142
8143 @smallexample
8144 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
8145 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
8146 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
8147 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
8148 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
8149 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
8150 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
8151 $7 = 72 '\110'
8152 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
8153 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
8154 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
8155 $9 = 200 'H'
8156 (@value{GDBP})
8157 @end smallexample
8158
8159 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
8160 string literals you use in expressions:
8161
8162 @smallexample
8163 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
8164 $10 = 78 '+'
8165 (@value{GDBP})
8166 @end smallexample
8167
8168 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
8169 character.
8170
8171 @node Caching Remote Data
8172 @section Caching Data of Remote Targets
8173 @cindex caching data of remote targets
8174
8175 @value{GDBN} can cache data exchanged between the debugger and a
8176 remote target (@pxref{Remote Debugging}). Such caching generally improves
8177 performance, because it reduces the overhead of the remote protocol by
8178 bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks. Unfortunately,
8179 @value{GDBN} does not currently know anything about volatile
8180 registers, and thus data caching will produce incorrect results when
8181 volatile registers are in use.
8182
8183 @table @code
8184 @kindex set remotecache
8185 @item set remotecache on
8186 @itemx set remotecache off
8187 Set caching state for remote targets. When @code{ON}, use data
8188 caching. By default, this option is @code{OFF}.
8189
8190 @kindex show remotecache
8191 @item show remotecache
8192 Show the current state of data caching for remote targets.
8193
8194 @kindex info dcache
8195 @item info dcache
8196 Print the information about the data cache performance. The
8197 information displayed includes: the dcache width and depth; and for
8198 each cache line, how many times it was referenced, and its data and
8199 state (invalid, dirty, valid). This command is useful for debugging
8200 the data cache operation.
8201 @end table
8202
8203 @node Searching Memory
8204 @section Search Memory
8205 @cindex searching memory
8206
8207 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
8208 @code{find} command.
8209
8210 @table @code
8211 @kindex find
8212 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8213 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
8214 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
8215 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
8216 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
8217 @end table
8218
8219 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
8220 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
8221
8222 @table @r
8223 @item @var{s}, search query size
8224 The size of each search query value.
8225
8226 @table @code
8227 @item b
8228 bytes
8229 @item h
8230 halfwords (two bytes)
8231 @item w
8232 words (four bytes)
8233 @item g
8234 giant words (eight bytes)
8235 @end table
8236
8237 All values are interpreted in the current language.
8238 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
8239 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
8240
8241 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
8242 value's type in the current language.
8243 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
8244 pattern as a mixture of types.
8245 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
8246 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
8247 which is typically four bytes.
8248
8249 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
8250 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
8251 @end table
8252
8253 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
8254 (@code{"}).
8255 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
8256 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
8257
8258 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
8259 number of matches found.
8260
8261 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
8262 @samp{$_}.
8263 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
8264
8265 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
8266
8267 @smallexample
8268 void
8269 hello ()
8270 @{
8271 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
8272 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
8273 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
8274 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
8275 printf ("%s\n", hello);
8276 @}
8277 @end smallexample
8278
8279 @noindent
8280 you get during debugging:
8281
8282 @smallexample
8283 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
8284 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8285 1 pattern found
8286 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
8287 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8288 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
8289 2 patterns found
8290 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
8291 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
8292 1 pattern found
8293 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
8294 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
8295 1 pattern found
8296 (gdb) print $numfound
8297 $1 = 1
8298 (gdb) print $_
8299 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
8300 @end smallexample
8301
8302 @node Macros
8303 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
8304
8305 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
8306 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
8307 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
8308 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
8309 where it was defined.
8310
8311 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
8312 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
8313 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
8314 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
8315
8316 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
8317 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
8318 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
8319 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
8320 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
8321 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
8322 see @ref{List}.
8323
8324 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
8325 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
8326 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
8327
8328 @table @code
8329
8330 @kindex macro expand
8331 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
8332 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
8333 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
8334 @item macro expand @var{expression}
8335 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
8336 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
8337 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
8338 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
8339 it can be any string of tokens.
8340
8341 @kindex macro exp1
8342 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
8343 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
8344 @cindex expand macro once
8345 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
8346 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
8347 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
8348 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
8349 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
8350 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
8351 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
8352 can be any string of tokens.
8353
8354 @kindex info macro
8355 @cindex macro definition, showing
8356 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
8357 @item info macro @var{macro}
8358 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
8359 source location where that definition was established.
8360
8361 @kindex macro define
8362 @cindex user-defined macros
8363 @cindex defining macros interactively
8364 @cindex macros, user-defined
8365 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
8366 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
8367 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
8368 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
8369 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
8370 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
8371 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
8372 @var{arglist}.
8373
8374 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
8375 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
8376 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
8377 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
8378 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
8379
8380 @kindex macro undef
8381 @item macro undef @var{macro}
8382 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
8383 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
8384 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
8385 in the program being debugged.
8386
8387 @kindex macro list
8388 @item macro list
8389 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
8390 @end table
8391
8392 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
8393 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
8394 show our source files:
8395
8396 @smallexample
8397 $ cat sample.c
8398 #include <stdio.h>
8399 #include "sample.h"
8400
8401 #define M 42
8402 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8403
8404 main ()
8405 @{
8406 #define N 28
8407 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8408 #undef N
8409 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8410 #define N 1729
8411 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8412 @}
8413 $ cat sample.h
8414 #define Q <
8415 $
8416 @end smallexample
8417
8418 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
8419 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
8420 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
8421 information.
8422
8423 @smallexample
8424 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
8425 $
8426 @end smallexample
8427
8428 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
8429
8430 @smallexample
8431 $ gdb -nw sample
8432 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
8433 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
8434 GDB is free software, @dots{}
8435 (@value{GDBP})
8436 @end smallexample
8437
8438 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
8439 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
8440 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
8441
8442 @smallexample
8443 (@value{GDBP}) list main
8444 3
8445 4 #define M 42
8446 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8447 6
8448 7 main ()
8449 8 @{
8450 9 #define N 28
8451 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8452 11 #undef N
8453 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8454 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
8455 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
8456 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
8457 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
8458 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
8459 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
8460 #define Q <
8461 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
8462 expands to: (42 + 1)
8463 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
8464 expands to: once (M + 1)
8465 (@value{GDBP})
8466 @end smallexample
8467
8468 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
8469 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
8470 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
8471 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
8472
8473 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
8474 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
8475
8476 @smallexample
8477 (@value{GDBP}) break main
8478 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
8479 (@value{GDBP}) run
8480 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
8481
8482 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
8483 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
8484 (@value{GDBP})
8485 @end smallexample
8486
8487 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
8488
8489 @smallexample
8490 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8491 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
8492 #define N 28
8493 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8494 expands to: 28 < 42
8495 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8496 $1 = 1
8497 (@value{GDBP})
8498 @end smallexample
8499
8500 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
8501 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
8502 thereof) in force at each point:
8503
8504 @smallexample
8505 (@value{GDBP}) next
8506 Hello, world!
8507 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
8508 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8509 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
8510 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
8511 (@value{GDBP}) next
8512 We're so creative.
8513 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
8514 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
8515 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
8516 #define N 1729
8517 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
8518 expands to: 1729 < 42
8519 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
8520 $2 = 0
8521 (@value{GDBP})
8522 @end smallexample
8523
8524
8525 @node Tracepoints
8526 @chapter Tracepoints
8527 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
8528 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
8529
8530 @cindex tracepoints
8531 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
8532 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
8533 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
8534 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
8535 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
8536 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
8537 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
8538
8539 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
8540 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
8541 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
8542 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
8543 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
8544 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
8545 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
8546 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
8547 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
8548 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
8549 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
8550
8551 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
8552 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
8553 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
8554 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
8555 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
8556 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
8557 Packets}.
8558
8559 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
8560
8561 @menu
8562 * Set Tracepoints::
8563 * Analyze Collected Data::
8564 * Tracepoint Variables::
8565 @end menu
8566
8567 @node Set Tracepoints
8568 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
8569
8570 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
8571 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
8572 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
8573 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
8574 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
8575 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
8576 work on.
8577
8578 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
8579 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
8580 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
8581 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
8582 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
8583 tracepoint was hit.
8584
8585 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
8586 conditions and actions.
8587
8588 @menu
8589 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
8590 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
8591 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
8592 * Tracepoint Actions::
8593 * Listing Tracepoints::
8594 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
8595 @end menu
8596
8597 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
8598 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
8599
8600 @table @code
8601 @cindex set tracepoint
8602 @kindex trace
8603 @item trace
8604 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
8605 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
8606 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
8607 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
8608 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
8609 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
8610 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
8611 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
8612 running.
8613
8614 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
8615
8616 @smallexample
8617 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
8618
8619 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
8620
8621 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
8622
8623 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
8624
8625 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
8626 @end smallexample
8627
8628 @noindent
8629 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
8630
8631 @vindex $tpnum
8632 @cindex last tracepoint number
8633 @cindex recent tracepoint number
8634 @cindex tracepoint number
8635 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
8636 of the most recently set tracepoint.
8637
8638 @kindex delete tracepoint
8639 @cindex tracepoint deletion
8640 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8641 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
8642 default is to delete all tracepoints.
8643
8644 Examples:
8645
8646 @smallexample
8647 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
8648
8649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
8650 @end smallexample
8651
8652 @noindent
8653 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
8654 @end table
8655
8656 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8657 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
8658
8659 @table @code
8660 @kindex disable tracepoint
8661 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8662 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
8663 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
8664 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
8665 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
8666
8667 @kindex enable tracepoint
8668 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8669 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
8670 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
8671 run.
8672 @end table
8673
8674 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
8675 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
8676
8677 @table @code
8678 @kindex passcount
8679 @cindex tracepoint pass count
8680 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
8681 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
8682 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
8683 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
8684 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
8685 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
8686 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
8687 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
8688 user.
8689
8690 Examples:
8691
8692 @smallexample
8693 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
8694 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
8695
8696 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
8697 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
8698 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8699 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
8700 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
8701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
8702 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
8703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
8704 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
8705 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
8706 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
8707 @end smallexample
8708 @end table
8709
8710 @node Tracepoint Actions
8711 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
8712
8713 @table @code
8714 @kindex actions
8715 @cindex tracepoint actions
8716 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8717 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
8718 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
8719 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
8720 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
8721 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
8722 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
8723 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
8724 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
8725 @code{while-stepping}.
8726
8727 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
8728 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
8729 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
8730
8731 @smallexample
8732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
8733
8734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
8735
8736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
8737 @end smallexample
8738
8739 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
8740 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
8741 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
8742 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
8743 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
8744 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
8745 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
8746 @code{end} command.
8747
8748 @smallexample
8749 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
8750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8751 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
8752 > collect bar,baz
8753 > collect $regs
8754 > while-stepping 12
8755 > collect $fp, $sp
8756 > end
8757 end
8758 @end smallexample
8759
8760 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
8761 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
8762 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
8763 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
8764 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
8765 special arguments are supported:
8766
8767 @table @code
8768 @item $regs
8769 collect all registers
8770
8771 @item $args
8772 collect all function arguments
8773
8774 @item $locals
8775 collect all local variables.
8776 @end table
8777
8778 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
8779 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
8780 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
8781
8782 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
8783 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
8784
8785 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
8786 @item while-stepping @var{n}
8787 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
8788 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
8789 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
8790 its own @code{end} command):
8791
8792 @smallexample
8793 > while-stepping 12
8794 > collect $regs, myglobal
8795 > end
8796 >
8797 @end smallexample
8798
8799 @noindent
8800 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
8801 @code{stepping}.
8802 @end table
8803
8804 @node Listing Tracepoints
8805 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
8806
8807 @table @code
8808 @kindex info tracepoints
8809 @kindex info tp
8810 @cindex information about tracepoints
8811 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8812 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
8813 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
8814 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
8815 shown:
8816
8817 @itemize @bullet
8818 @item
8819 its number
8820 @item
8821 whether it is enabled or disabled
8822 @item
8823 its address
8824 @item
8825 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
8826 @item
8827 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
8828 @item
8829 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
8830 @item
8831 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
8832 @end itemize
8833
8834 @smallexample
8835 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
8836 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
8837 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
8838 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
8839 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
8840 (@value{GDBP})
8841 @end smallexample
8842
8843 @noindent
8844 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
8845 @end table
8846
8847 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8848 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
8849
8850 @table @code
8851 @kindex tstart
8852 @cindex start a new trace experiment
8853 @cindex collected data discarded
8854 @item tstart
8855 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
8856 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
8857 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
8858 experiment.
8859
8860 @kindex tstop
8861 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
8862 @item tstop
8863 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
8864 stops collecting data.
8865
8866 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
8867 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
8868 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
8869
8870 @kindex tstatus
8871 @cindex status of trace data collection
8872 @cindex trace experiment, status of
8873 @item tstatus
8874 This command displays the status of the current trace data
8875 collection.
8876 @end table
8877
8878 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
8879
8880 @smallexample
8881 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
8882 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
8883 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
8884 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
8885 > while-stepping 11
8886 > collect $regs
8887 > end
8888 > end
8889 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
8890 [time passes @dots{}]
8891 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
8892 @end smallexample
8893
8894
8895 @node Analyze Collected Data
8896 @section Using the Collected Data
8897
8898 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
8899 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
8900 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
8901 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
8902 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
8903 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
8904 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
8905 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
8906 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
8907 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
8908 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
8909 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
8910 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
8911 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
8912 the buffer will fail.
8913
8914 @menu
8915 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
8916 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
8917 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
8918 @end menu
8919
8920 @node tfind
8921 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
8922
8923 @kindex tfind
8924 @cindex select trace snapshot
8925 @cindex find trace snapshot
8926 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
8927 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
8928 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
8929 snapshot is selected.
8930
8931 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
8932
8933 @table @code
8934 @item tfind start
8935 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
8936 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
8937
8938 @item tfind none
8939 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
8940
8941 @item tfind end
8942 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
8943
8944 @item tfind
8945 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
8946
8947 @item tfind -
8948 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
8949 retracing earlier steps.
8950
8951 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
8952 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
8953 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
8954 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
8955 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
8956
8957 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
8958 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
8959 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
8960 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
8961 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
8962
8963 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8964 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
8965 addresses.
8966
8967 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
8968 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
8969 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
8970
8971 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
8972 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
8973 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
8974 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
8975 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
8976 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
8977 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
8978 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
8979 @end table
8980
8981 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
8982 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
8983 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
8984 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
8985 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
8986 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
8987 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
8988 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
8989 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
8990 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
8991 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
8992 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
8993 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
8994 tracepoint as the current one.
8995
8996 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
8997 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
8998 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
8999 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
9000 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
9001
9002 @smallexample
9003 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9004 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9005 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
9006 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
9007 > tfind
9008 > end
9009
9010 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
9011 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
9012 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
9013 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
9014 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
9015 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
9016 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
9017 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
9018 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
9019 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
9020 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
9021 @end smallexample
9022
9023 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
9024 the buffer:
9025
9026 @smallexample
9027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
9029 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
9030 > tfind line
9031 > end
9032
9033 Frame 0, X = 1
9034 Frame 7, X = 2
9035 Frame 13, X = 255
9036 @end smallexample
9037
9038 @node tdump
9039 @subsection @code{tdump}
9040 @kindex tdump
9041 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
9042 @cindex tracepoint data, display
9043
9044 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
9045 the current trace snapshot.
9046
9047 @smallexample
9048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
9049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
9050 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
9051 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
9052 > end
9053
9054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
9055
9056 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
9057 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
9058 at gdb_test.c:444
9059 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
9060
9061 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
9062 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
9063 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
9064 d1 0x18 24
9065 d2 0x80 128
9066 d3 0x33 51
9067 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
9068 d5 0x22 34
9069 d6 0xe0 224
9070 d7 0x380035 3670069
9071 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
9072 a1 0x3000668 50333288
9073 a2 0x100 256
9074 a3 0x322000 3284992
9075 a4 0x3000698 50333336
9076 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
9077 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
9078 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
9079 ps 0x0 0
9080 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
9081 fpcontrol 0x0 0
9082 fpstatus 0x0 0
9083 fpiaddr 0x0 0
9084 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
9085 p1 = (void *) 0x11
9086 p2 = (void *) 0x22
9087 p3 = (void *) 0x33
9088 p4 = (void *) 0x44
9089 p5 = (void *) 0x55
9090 p6 = (void *) 0x66
9091 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
9092
9093 (@value{GDBP})
9094 @end smallexample
9095
9096 @node save-tracepoints
9097 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
9098 @kindex save-tracepoints
9099 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
9100
9101 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
9102 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
9103 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
9104 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
9105 Files}).
9106
9107 @node Tracepoint Variables
9108 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
9109 @cindex tracepoint variables
9110 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
9111
9112 @table @code
9113 @vindex $trace_frame
9114 @item (int) $trace_frame
9115 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
9116 snapshot is selected.
9117
9118 @vindex $tracepoint
9119 @item (int) $tracepoint
9120 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
9121
9122 @vindex $trace_line
9123 @item (int) $trace_line
9124 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
9125
9126 @vindex $trace_file
9127 @item (char []) $trace_file
9128 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
9129
9130 @vindex $trace_func
9131 @item (char []) $trace_func
9132 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
9133 @end table
9134
9135 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
9136 use @code{output} instead.
9137
9138 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
9139 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
9140 data.
9141
9142 @smallexample
9143 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
9144
9145 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
9146 > output $trace_file
9147 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
9148 > tfind
9149 > end
9150 @end smallexample
9151
9152 @node Overlays
9153 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
9154 @cindex overlays
9155
9156 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
9157 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
9158 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
9159 use overlays.
9160
9161 @menu
9162 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
9163 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
9164 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
9165 mapped by asking the inferior.
9166 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
9167 @end menu
9168
9169 @node How Overlays Work
9170 @section How Overlays Work
9171 @cindex mapped overlays
9172 @cindex unmapped overlays
9173 @cindex load address, overlay's
9174 @cindex mapped address
9175 @cindex overlay area
9176
9177 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
9178 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
9179 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
9180 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
9181 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
9182
9183 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
9184 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
9185 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
9186 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
9187 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
9188 largest overlay as well.
9189
9190 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
9191 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
9192 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
9193 there.
9194
9195 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
9196 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
9197 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
9198
9199 @smallexample
9200 @group
9201 Data Instruction Larger
9202 Address Space Address Space Address Space
9203 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
9204 | | | | | |
9205 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
9206 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
9207 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
9208 | and heap | | | | | |
9209 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
9210 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
9211 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
9212 | | | | | |
9213 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
9214 address | | | | | |
9215 | overlay | <-' | | |
9216 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
9217 | | <---. | | load address
9218 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
9219 | | | |
9220 +-----------+ | |
9221 +-----------+
9222 | |
9223 +-----------+
9224
9225 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
9226 @end group
9227 @end smallexample
9228
9229 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
9230 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
9231 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
9232 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
9233 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
9234 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
9235 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
9236 program and the overlay area.
9237
9238 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
9239 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
9240 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
9241 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
9242 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
9243 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
9244 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
9245
9246 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
9247 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
9248 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
9249
9250 @itemize @bullet
9251
9252 @item
9253 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
9254 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
9255 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
9256 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
9257
9258 @item
9259 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
9260 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
9261 your program's performance.
9262
9263 @item
9264 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
9265 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
9266 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
9267 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
9268 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
9269 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
9270 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
9271
9272 @item
9273 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
9274 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
9275 instruction and data spaces.
9276
9277 @end itemize
9278
9279 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
9280 improved in many ways:
9281
9282 @itemize @bullet
9283
9284 @item
9285 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
9286 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
9287 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
9288 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
9289 area in the usual way.
9290
9291 @item
9292 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
9293 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
9294
9295 @item
9296 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
9297 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
9298 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
9299 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
9300 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
9301 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
9302 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
9303
9304 @end itemize
9305
9306
9307 @node Overlay Commands
9308 @section Overlay Commands
9309
9310 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
9311 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
9312 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
9313 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
9314 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
9315 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
9316
9317 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
9318 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
9319
9320 @table @code
9321 @item overlay off
9322 @kindex overlay
9323 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
9324 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
9325 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
9326 overlay support is disabled.
9327
9328 @item overlay manual
9329 @cindex manual overlay debugging
9330 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9331 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
9332 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
9333 commands described below.
9334
9335 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
9336 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
9337 @cindex map an overlay
9338 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
9339 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
9340 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
9341 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
9342 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
9343 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
9344
9345 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
9346 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
9347 @cindex unmap an overlay
9348 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
9349 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
9350 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
9351 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
9352
9353 @item overlay auto
9354 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
9355 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
9356 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
9357 Overlay Debugging}.
9358
9359 @item overlay load-target
9360 @itemx overlay load
9361 @cindex reloading the overlay table
9362 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
9363 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
9364 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
9365 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
9366 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
9367
9368 @item overlay list-overlays
9369 @itemx overlay list
9370 @cindex listing mapped overlays
9371 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
9372 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
9373
9374 @end table
9375
9376 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
9377 of the function the address falls in:
9378
9379 @smallexample
9380 (@value{GDBP}) print main
9381 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
9382 @end smallexample
9383 @noindent
9384 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
9385 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
9386 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
9387 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
9388
9389 @smallexample
9390 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9391 No sections are mapped.
9392 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9393 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
9394 @end smallexample
9395 @noindent
9396 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
9397 name normally:
9398
9399 @smallexample
9400 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
9401 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
9402 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
9403 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
9404 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
9405 @end smallexample
9406
9407 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
9408 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
9409 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
9410 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
9411 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
9412
9413 @itemize @bullet
9414 @item
9415 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
9416 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
9417 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
9418 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
9419 @item
9420 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
9421 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
9422 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
9423 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
9424 breakpoints properly.
9425 @end itemize
9426
9427
9428 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
9429 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
9430 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
9431
9432 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
9433 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
9434 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
9435 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
9436 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
9437 current state of the overlays.
9438
9439 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
9440 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
9441
9442 @table @asis
9443
9444 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
9445 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
9446
9447 @smallexample
9448 struct
9449 @{
9450 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
9451 unsigned long vma;
9452
9453 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
9454 unsigned long size;
9455
9456 /* The overlay's load address. */
9457 unsigned long lma;
9458
9459 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
9460 zero otherwise. */
9461 unsigned long mapped;
9462 @}
9463 @end smallexample
9464
9465 @item @code{_novlys}:
9466 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
9467 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
9468
9469 @end table
9470
9471 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
9472 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
9473 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
9474 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
9475 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
9476 currently mapped.
9477
9478 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
9479 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
9480 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
9481 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
9482 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
9483 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
9484 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
9485 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
9486 are not being executed.
9487
9488 @node Overlay Sample Program
9489 @section Overlay Sample Program
9490 @cindex overlay example program
9491
9492 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
9493 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
9494 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
9495 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
9496 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
9497 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
9498 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
9499
9500 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
9501 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
9502 suite. The program consists of the following files from
9503 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
9504
9505 @table @file
9506 @item overlays.c
9507 The main program file.
9508 @item ovlymgr.c
9509 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
9510 @item foo.c
9511 @itemx bar.c
9512 @itemx baz.c
9513 @itemx grbx.c
9514 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
9515 @item d10v.ld
9516 @itemx m32r.ld
9517 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
9518 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
9519 @end table
9520
9521 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
9522 cross-compiler like this:
9523
9524 @smallexample
9525 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
9526 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
9527 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
9528 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
9529 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
9530 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
9531 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
9532 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
9533 @end smallexample
9534
9535 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
9536 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
9537 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
9538
9539
9540 @node Languages
9541 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
9542 @cindex languages
9543
9544 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
9545 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
9546 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
9547 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
9548 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
9549 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
9550
9551 @cindex working language
9552 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
9553 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
9554 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
9555 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
9556 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
9557 language}.
9558
9559 @menu
9560 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
9561 * Show:: Displaying the language
9562 * Checks:: Type and range checks
9563 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
9564 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
9565 @end menu
9566
9567 @node Setting
9568 @section Switching Between Source Languages
9569
9570 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
9571 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
9572 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
9573 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
9574 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
9575 are printed, etc.
9576
9577 In addition to the working language, every source file that
9578 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
9579 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
9580 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
9581 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
9582 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
9583 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
9584 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
9585 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
9586 Displaying the Language}.
9587
9588 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
9589 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
9590 another language. In that case, make the
9591 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
9592 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
9593 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
9594
9595 @menu
9596 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
9597 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
9598 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
9599 @end menu
9600
9601 @node Filenames
9602 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
9603
9604 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
9605 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
9606
9607 @table @file
9608 @item .ada
9609 @itemx .ads
9610 @itemx .adb
9611 @itemx .a
9612 Ada source file.
9613
9614 @item .c
9615 C source file
9616
9617 @item .C
9618 @itemx .cc
9619 @itemx .cp
9620 @itemx .cpp
9621 @itemx .cxx
9622 @itemx .c++
9623 C@t{++} source file
9624
9625 @item .m
9626 Objective-C source file
9627
9628 @item .f
9629 @itemx .F
9630 Fortran source file
9631
9632 @item .mod
9633 Modula-2 source file
9634
9635 @item .s
9636 @itemx .S
9637 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
9638 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
9639 @end table
9640
9641 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
9642 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
9643
9644 @node Manually
9645 @subsection Setting the Working Language
9646
9647 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
9648 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
9649 your program.
9650
9651 @kindex set language
9652 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
9653 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
9654 a language, such as
9655 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
9656 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
9657
9658 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
9659 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
9660 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
9661 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
9662 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
9663 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
9664 command such as:
9665
9666 @smallexample
9667 print a = b + c
9668 @end smallexample
9669
9670 @noindent
9671 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
9672 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
9673 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
9674 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
9675
9676 @node Automatically
9677 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
9678
9679 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
9680 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
9681 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
9682 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
9683 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
9684 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
9685 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
9686 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
9687 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
9688
9689 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
9690 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
9691 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
9692 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
9693 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
9694
9695 @node Show
9696 @section Displaying the Language
9697
9698 The following commands help you find out which language is the
9699 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
9700
9701 @table @code
9702 @item show language
9703 @kindex show language
9704 Display the current working language. This is the
9705 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
9706 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
9707
9708 @item info frame
9709 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
9710 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
9711 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
9712 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
9713 information listed here.
9714
9715 @item info source
9716 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
9717 Display the source language of this source file.
9718 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
9719 information listed here.
9720 @end table
9721
9722 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
9723 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
9724 with a language explicitly:
9725
9726 @table @code
9727 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
9728 @kindex set extension-language
9729 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
9730 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
9731
9732 @item info extensions
9733 @kindex info extensions
9734 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
9735 @end table
9736
9737 @node Checks
9738 @section Type and Range Checking
9739
9740 @quotation
9741 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
9742 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
9743 section documents the intended facilities.
9744 @end quotation
9745 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
9746
9747 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
9748 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
9749 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
9750 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
9751 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
9752 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
9753 errors when your program is running.
9754
9755 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
9756 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program,
9757 it can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for
9758 evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example. As with the
9759 working language, @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check
9760 automatically based on your program's source language.
9761 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default
9762 settings of supported languages.
9763
9764 @menu
9765 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
9766 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
9767 @end menu
9768
9769 @cindex type checking
9770 @cindex checks, type
9771 @node Type Checking
9772 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
9773
9774 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
9775 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
9776 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
9777 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
9778
9779 @smallexample
9780 1 + 2 @result{} 3
9781 @exdent but
9782 @error{} 1 + 2.3
9783 @end smallexample
9784
9785 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
9786 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
9787
9788 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
9789 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
9790 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
9791 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
9792 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
9793 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
9794 also issues a warning.
9795
9796 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
9797 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
9798 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
9799 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
9800 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
9801 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
9802
9803 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
9804 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
9805 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
9806 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
9807 operators. @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for further
9808 details on specific languages.
9809
9810 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
9811
9812 @kindex set check type
9813 @kindex show check type
9814 @table @code
9815 @item set check type auto
9816 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
9817 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9818 each language.
9819
9820 @item set check type on
9821 @itemx set check type off
9822 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9823 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
9824 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
9825 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
9826 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
9827
9828 @item set check type warn
9829 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
9830 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
9831 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
9832 numbers and structures.
9833
9834 @item show type
9835 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
9836 is setting it automatically.
9837 @end table
9838
9839 @cindex range checking
9840 @cindex checks, range
9841 @node Range Checking
9842 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
9843
9844 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
9845 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
9846 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
9847 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
9848 not exceed the bounds of the array.
9849
9850 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
9851 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
9852 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
9853 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
9854
9855 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
9856 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
9857 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
9858 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
9859 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
9860 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
9861
9862 @smallexample
9863 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
9864 @end smallexample
9865
9866 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
9867 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
9868 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
9869
9870 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
9871
9872 @kindex set check range
9873 @kindex show check range
9874 @table @code
9875 @item set check range auto
9876 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
9877 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
9878 each language.
9879
9880 @item set check range on
9881 @itemx set check range off
9882 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
9883 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
9884 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
9885 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
9886
9887 @item set check range warn
9888 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
9889 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
9890 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
9891 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
9892 systems).
9893
9894 @item show range
9895 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
9896 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
9897 @end table
9898
9899 @node Supported Languages
9900 @section Supported Languages
9901
9902 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, Pascal,
9903 assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
9904 @c This is false ...
9905 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
9906 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
9907 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
9908 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
9909 language.
9910
9911 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
9912 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
9913 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
9914 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
9915 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
9916 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
9917 language reference or tutorial.
9918
9919 @menu
9920 * C:: C and C@t{++}
9921 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
9922 * Fortran:: Fortran
9923 * Pascal:: Pascal
9924 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
9925 * Ada:: Ada
9926 @end menu
9927
9928 @node C
9929 @subsection C and C@t{++}
9930
9931 @cindex C and C@t{++}
9932 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
9933
9934 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
9935 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
9936 together.
9937
9938 @cindex C@t{++}
9939 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
9940 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
9941 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
9942 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
9943 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
9944 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
9945 compiler (@code{aCC}).
9946
9947 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
9948 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
9949 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
9950 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
9951 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
9952 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}.
9953
9954 @menu
9955 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
9956 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
9957 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
9958 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
9959 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
9960 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
9961 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
9962 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
9963 @end menu
9964
9965 @node C Operators
9966 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
9967
9968 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
9969
9970 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
9971 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
9972 often defined on groups of types.
9973
9974 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
9975
9976 @itemize @bullet
9977
9978 @item
9979 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
9980 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
9981
9982 @item
9983 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
9984 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
9985
9986 @item
9987 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
9988
9989 @item
9990 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
9991
9992 @end itemize
9993
9994 @noindent
9995 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
9996 in order of increasing precedence:
9997
9998 @table @code
9999 @item ,
10000 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
10001 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
10002 expression being the last expression evaluated.
10003
10004 @item =
10005 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
10006 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
10007
10008 @item @var{op}=
10009 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
10010 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
10011 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
10012 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
10013 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
10014
10015 @item ?:
10016 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
10017 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
10018 integral type.
10019
10020 @item ||
10021 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10022
10023 @item &&
10024 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10025
10026 @item |
10027 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10028
10029 @item ^
10030 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
10031
10032 @item &
10033 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
10034
10035 @item ==@r{, }!=
10036 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
10037 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
10038
10039 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
10040 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
10041 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
10042 and non-zero for true.
10043
10044 @item <<@r{, }>>
10045 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
10046
10047 @item @@
10048 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10049
10050 @item +@r{, }-
10051 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
10052 pointer types.
10053
10054 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
10055 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
10056 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
10057 integral types.
10058
10059 @item ++@r{, }--
10060 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
10061 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
10062 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
10063 operation takes place.
10064
10065 @item *
10066 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
10067 @code{++}.
10068
10069 @item &
10070 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
10071
10072 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
10073 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
10074 to examine the address
10075 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
10076 stored.
10077
10078 @item -
10079 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
10080 precedence as @code{++}.
10081
10082 @item !
10083 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10084 @code{++}.
10085
10086 @item ~
10087 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
10088 @code{++}.
10089
10090
10091 @item .@r{, }->
10092 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
10093 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
10094 pointer based on the stored type information.
10095 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
10096
10097 @item .*@r{, }->*
10098 Dereferences of pointers to members.
10099
10100 @item []
10101 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
10102 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10103
10104 @item ()
10105 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
10106
10107 @item ::
10108 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
10109 and @code{class} types.
10110
10111 @item ::
10112 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
10113 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
10114 above.
10115 @end table
10116
10117 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
10118 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
10119 predefined meaning.
10120
10121 @node C Constants
10122 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
10123
10124 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
10125
10126 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
10127 following ways:
10128
10129 @itemize @bullet
10130 @item
10131 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
10132 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
10133 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
10134 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
10135 @code{long} value.
10136
10137 @item
10138 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
10139 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
10140 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
10141 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
10142 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
10143 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
10144 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
10145 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
10146 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
10147 constant.
10148
10149 @item
10150 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
10151 integral equivalents.
10152
10153 @item
10154 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
10155 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
10156 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
10157 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
10158 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
10159 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
10160 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
10161 @samp{\n} for newline.
10162
10163 @item
10164 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
10165 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
10166 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
10167 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
10168 characters.
10169
10170 @item
10171 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
10172 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
10173
10174 @item
10175 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
10176 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
10177 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
10178 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
10179 @end itemize
10180
10181 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
10182 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
10183
10184 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
10185 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
10186
10187 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
10188 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
10189 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
10190 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
10191 @quotation
10192 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
10193 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
10194 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
10195 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
10196 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
10197 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
10198 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
10199 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
10200 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
10201 C@t{++} code.
10202 @end quotation
10203
10204 @enumerate
10205
10206 @cindex member functions
10207 @item
10208 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
10209
10210 @smallexample
10211 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
10212 @end smallexample
10213
10214 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
10215 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
10216 @item
10217 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
10218 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
10219 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
10220 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
10221
10222 @cindex call overloaded functions
10223 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
10224 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
10225 @item
10226 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
10227 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
10228 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
10229 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
10230 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
10231 default arguments.
10232
10233 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
10234 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
10235 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
10236 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
10237 number of function arguments.
10238
10239 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
10240 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
10241 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
10242
10243 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
10244 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
10245 @smallexample
10246 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
10247 @end smallexample
10248
10249 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
10250 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
10251
10252 @cindex reference declarations
10253 @item
10254 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
10255 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
10256 dereferenced.
10257
10258 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
10259 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
10260 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
10261 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
10262 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
10263
10264 @item
10265 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
10266 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
10267 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
10268 necessary, for example in an expression like
10269 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
10270 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
10271 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
10272 @end enumerate
10273
10274 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
10275 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
10276 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
10277 invoking user-defined operators.
10278
10279 @node C Defaults
10280 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
10281
10282 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
10283
10284 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
10285 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
10286 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
10287 selects the working language.
10288
10289 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
10290 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
10291 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
10292 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
10293 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
10294 for further details.
10295
10296 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
10297 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
10298 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
10299
10300 @node C Checks
10301 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
10302
10303 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
10304
10305 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
10306 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
10307 considers two variables type equivalent if:
10308
10309 @itemize @bullet
10310 @item
10311 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
10312 enumerated tag.
10313
10314 @item
10315 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
10316 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
10317
10318 @ignore
10319 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
10320 @c FIXME--beers?
10321 @item
10322 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
10323 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
10324 compilers.)
10325 @end ignore
10326 @end itemize
10327
10328 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
10329 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
10330 that is not itself an array.
10331
10332 @node Debugging C
10333 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
10334
10335 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
10336 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
10337 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
10338 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
10339
10340 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
10341 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
10342 ,Expressions}.
10343
10344 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
10345 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
10346
10347 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
10348
10349 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
10350 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
10351
10352 @table @code
10353 @cindex break in overloaded functions
10354 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
10355 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
10356 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
10357 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
10358 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
10359
10360 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
10361 @item rbreak @var{regex}
10362 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
10363 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
10364 classes.
10365 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
10366
10367 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
10368 @item catch throw
10369 @itemx catch catch
10370 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
10371 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
10372
10373 @cindex inheritance
10374 @item ptype @var{typename}
10375 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
10376 @var{typename}.
10377 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
10378
10379 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
10380 @item set print demangle
10381 @itemx show print demangle
10382 @itemx set print asm-demangle
10383 @itemx show print asm-demangle
10384 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
10385 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
10386 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10387
10388 @item set print object
10389 @itemx show print object
10390 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
10391 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10392
10393 @item set print vtbl
10394 @itemx show print vtbl
10395 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
10396 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
10397 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10398 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10399
10400 @kindex set overload-resolution
10401 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
10402 @item set overload-resolution on
10403 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
10404 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
10405 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
10406 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
10407 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
10408 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
10409
10410 @item set overload-resolution off
10411 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
10412 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10413 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
10414 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
10415 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
10416 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
10417 argument types.
10418
10419 @kindex show overload-resolution
10420 @item show overload-resolution
10421 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
10422
10423 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
10424 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
10425 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
10426 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
10427 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
10428 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
10429 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
10430 @end table
10431
10432 @node Decimal Floating Point
10433 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
10434 @cindex decimal floating point format
10435
10436 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
10437 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
10438 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
10439 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
10440
10441 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
10442 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
10443 PowerPC. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the configured
10444 target.
10445
10446 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
10447 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
10448 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
10449
10450 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
10451 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
10452 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
10453
10454 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
10455 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers. See
10456 @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
10457
10458 @node Objective-C
10459 @subsection Objective-C
10460
10461 @cindex Objective-C
10462 This section provides information about some commands and command
10463 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
10464 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
10465 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
10466
10467 @menu
10468 * Method Names in Commands::
10469 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
10470 @end menu
10471
10472 @node Method Names in Commands
10473 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
10474
10475 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
10476 names as line specifications:
10477
10478 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
10479 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
10480 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
10481 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
10482 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
10483 @itemize
10484 @item @code{clear}
10485 @item @code{break}
10486 @item @code{info line}
10487 @item @code{jump}
10488 @item @code{list}
10489 @end itemize
10490
10491 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
10492
10493 @smallexample
10494 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
10495 @end smallexample
10496
10497 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
10498 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
10499 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
10500 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
10501 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
10502 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
10503 debugged, enter:
10504
10505 @smallexample
10506 break -[Fruit create]
10507 @end smallexample
10508
10509 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
10510 enter:
10511
10512 @smallexample
10513 list +[NSText initialize]
10514 @end smallexample
10515
10516 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
10517 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
10518 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
10519 is also possible to specify just a method name:
10520
10521 @smallexample
10522 break create
10523 @end smallexample
10524
10525 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
10526 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
10527 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
10528 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
10529 none apply.
10530
10531 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
10532 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
10533
10534 @smallexample
10535 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
10536 @end smallexample
10537
10538 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
10539 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
10540 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
10541 @kindex print-object
10542 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
10543
10544 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
10545
10546 @smallexample
10547 print -[@var{object} hash]
10548 @end smallexample
10549
10550 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
10551 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
10552 @noindent
10553 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
10554 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
10555 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
10556 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
10557 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
10558 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
10559
10560 @node Fortran
10561 @subsection Fortran
10562 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
10563
10564 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
10565 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
10566
10567 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
10568 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
10569 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
10570 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
10571 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
10572 underscore.
10573
10574 @menu
10575 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
10576 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
10577 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
10578 @end menu
10579
10580 @node Fortran Operators
10581 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
10582
10583 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
10584
10585 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10586 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
10587 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
10588
10589 @table @code
10590 @item **
10591 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
10592 of the second one.
10593
10594 @item :
10595 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
10596 represent a section of array.
10597
10598 @item %
10599 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
10600 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
10601 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
10602 union type.
10603 @end table
10604
10605 @node Fortran Defaults
10606 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
10607
10608 @cindex Fortran Defaults
10609
10610 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
10611 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
10612 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
10613 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
10614
10615 @node Special Fortran Commands
10616 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
10617
10618 @cindex Special Fortran commands
10619
10620 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
10621 such as displaying common blocks.
10622
10623 @table @code
10624 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
10625 @kindex info common
10626 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
10627 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
10628 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
10629 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
10630 printed.
10631 @end table
10632
10633 @node Pascal
10634 @subsection Pascal
10635
10636 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
10637 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
10638 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
10639 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
10640 syntax.
10641
10642 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
10643 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
10644 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
10645
10646 @node Modula-2
10647 @subsection Modula-2
10648
10649 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
10650
10651 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
10652 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
10653 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
10654 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
10655 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
10656 table.
10657
10658 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
10659 @menu
10660 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
10661 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
10662 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
10663 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
10664 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
10665 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
10666 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
10667 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
10668 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
10669 @end menu
10670
10671 @node M2 Operators
10672 @subsubsection Operators
10673 @cindex Modula-2 operators
10674
10675 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
10676 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
10677 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
10678 following definitions hold:
10679
10680 @itemize @bullet
10681
10682 @item
10683 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
10684 their subranges.
10685
10686 @item
10687 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
10688
10689 @item
10690 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
10691
10692 @item
10693 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
10694 @var{type}}.
10695
10696 @item
10697 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
10698
10699 @item
10700 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
10701
10702 @item
10703 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
10704 @end itemize
10705
10706 @noindent
10707 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
10708 increasing precedence:
10709
10710 @table @code
10711 @item ,
10712 Function argument or array index separator.
10713
10714 @item :=
10715 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
10716 @var{value}.
10717
10718 @item <@r{, }>
10719 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
10720 types.
10721
10722 @item <=@r{, }>=
10723 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
10724 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
10725 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
10726
10727 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
10728 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
10729 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
10730 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
10731 comment character.
10732
10733 @item IN
10734 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
10735 Same precedence as @code{<}.
10736
10737 @item OR
10738 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10739
10740 @item AND@r{, }&
10741 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
10742
10743 @item @@
10744 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
10745
10746 @item +@r{, }-
10747 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
10748 and difference on set types.
10749
10750 @item *
10751 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
10752 on set types.
10753
10754 @item /
10755 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
10756 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
10757
10758 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
10759 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
10760 precedence as @code{*}.
10761
10762 @item -
10763 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
10764
10765 @item ^
10766 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
10767
10768 @item NOT
10769 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
10770 @code{^}.
10771
10772 @item .
10773 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
10774 precedence as @code{^}.
10775
10776 @item []
10777 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
10778
10779 @item ()
10780 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
10781 as @code{^}.
10782
10783 @item ::@r{, }.
10784 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
10785 @end table
10786
10787 @quotation
10788 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
10789 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
10790 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
10791 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
10792 @end quotation
10793
10794
10795 @node Built-In Func/Proc
10796 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
10797 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
10798
10799 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
10800 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
10801
10802 @table @var
10803
10804 @item a
10805 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
10806
10807 @item c
10808 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
10809
10810 @item i
10811 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
10812
10813 @item m
10814 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
10815 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
10816 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
10817
10818 @item n
10819 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
10820
10821 @item r
10822 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
10823
10824 @item t
10825 represents a type.
10826
10827 @item v
10828 represents a variable.
10829
10830 @item x
10831 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
10832 explanation of the function for details.
10833 @end table
10834
10835 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
10836
10837 @table @code
10838 @item ABS(@var{n})
10839 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
10840
10841 @item CAP(@var{c})
10842 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
10843 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
10844
10845 @item CHR(@var{i})
10846 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10847
10848 @item DEC(@var{v})
10849 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10850
10851 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
10852 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10853 new value.
10854
10855 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10856 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
10857 set.
10858
10859 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
10860 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
10861
10862 @item HIGH(@var{a})
10863 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
10864
10865 @item INC(@var{v})
10866 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
10867
10868 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
10869 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
10870 new value.
10871
10872 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
10873 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
10874 there. Returns the new set.
10875
10876 @item MAX(@var{t})
10877 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
10878
10879 @item MIN(@var{t})
10880 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
10881
10882 @item ODD(@var{i})
10883 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
10884
10885 @item ORD(@var{x})
10886 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
10887 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
10888 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
10889 integral, character and enumerated types.
10890
10891 @item SIZE(@var{x})
10892 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10893
10894 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
10895 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
10896
10897 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
10898 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
10899
10900 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
10901 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
10902 @end table
10903
10904 @quotation
10905 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
10906 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
10907 an error.
10908 @end quotation
10909
10910 @cindex Modula-2 constants
10911 @node M2 Constants
10912 @subsubsection Constants
10913
10914 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
10915 ways:
10916
10917 @itemize @bullet
10918
10919 @item
10920 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
10921 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
10922 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
10923 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
10924
10925 @item
10926 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
10927 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
10928 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
10929 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
10930 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
10931 digits.
10932
10933 @item
10934 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
10935 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
10936 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
10937 followed by a @samp{C}.
10938
10939 @item
10940 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
10941 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
10942 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
10943 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
10944 sequences.
10945
10946 @item
10947 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
10948
10949 @item
10950 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
10951 @code{FALSE}.
10952
10953 @item
10954 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
10955
10956 @item
10957 Set constants are not yet supported.
10958 @end itemize
10959
10960 @node M2 Types
10961 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
10962 @cindex Modula-2 types
10963
10964 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
10965 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
10966 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
10967 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
10968 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
10969 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
10970
10971 The first example contains the following section of code:
10972
10973 @smallexample
10974 VAR
10975 s: SET OF CHAR ;
10976 r: [20..40] ;
10977 @end smallexample
10978
10979 @noindent
10980 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
10981 @code{r} and @code{s}.
10982
10983 @smallexample
10984 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10985 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
10986 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
10987 SET OF CHAR
10988 (@value{GDBP}) print r
10989 21
10990 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
10991 [20..40]
10992 @end smallexample
10993
10994 @noindent
10995 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
10996
10997 @smallexample
10998 VAR
10999 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
11000 @end smallexample
11001
11002 @noindent
11003 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
11004
11005 @smallexample
11006 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11007 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
11008 @end smallexample
11009
11010 @noindent
11011 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
11012 expressions using the debugger.
11013
11014 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
11015 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
11016
11017 @smallexample
11018 VAR
11019 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
11020 @end smallexample
11021
11022 @smallexample
11023 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11024 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
11025 @end smallexample
11026
11027 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
11028 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
11029 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
11030 above.
11031
11032 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
11033
11034 @smallexample
11035 TYPE
11036 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
11037 t = [blue..yellow] ;
11038 VAR
11039 s: t ;
11040 BEGIN
11041 s := blue ;
11042 @end smallexample
11043
11044 @noindent
11045 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
11046 and value of a variable.
11047
11048 @smallexample
11049 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11050 $1 = blue
11051 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
11052 type = [blue..yellow]
11053 @end smallexample
11054
11055 @noindent
11056 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
11057 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
11058 their @code{C} counterparts.
11059
11060 @smallexample
11061 VAR
11062 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11063 BEGIN
11064 s[1] := 1 ;
11065 @end smallexample
11066
11067 @smallexample
11068 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11069 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
11070 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11071 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11072 @end smallexample
11073
11074 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
11075 pointer types as shown in this example:
11076
11077 @smallexample
11078 VAR
11079 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
11080 BEGIN
11081 NEW(s) ;
11082 s^[1] := 1 ;
11083 @end smallexample
11084
11085 @noindent
11086 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
11087
11088 @smallexample
11089 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11090 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
11091 @end smallexample
11092
11093 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
11094 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
11095 types:
11096
11097 @smallexample
11098 TYPE
11099 foo = RECORD
11100 f1: CARDINAL ;
11101 f2: CHAR ;
11102 f3: myarray ;
11103 END ;
11104
11105 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
11106 myrange = [-2..2] ;
11107 VAR
11108 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
11109 @end smallexample
11110
11111 @noindent
11112 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
11113 below.
11114
11115 @smallexample
11116 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
11117 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
11118 f1 : CARDINAL;
11119 f2 : CHAR;
11120 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
11121 END
11122 @end smallexample
11123
11124 @node M2 Defaults
11125 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
11126 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
11127
11128 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
11129 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
11130 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
11131 selected the working language.
11132
11133 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
11134 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
11135 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
11136 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
11137
11138 @node Deviations
11139 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
11140 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
11141
11142 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
11143 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
11144
11145 @itemize @bullet
11146 @item
11147 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
11148 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
11149 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
11150 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
11151 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
11152 returned a pointer.)
11153
11154 @item
11155 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
11156 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
11157 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
11158 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
11159
11160 @item
11161 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
11162 argument.
11163
11164 @item
11165 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
11166 @end itemize
11167
11168 @node M2 Checks
11169 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
11170 @cindex Modula-2 checks
11171
11172 @quotation
11173 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
11174 range checking.
11175 @end quotation
11176 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
11177
11178 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
11179
11180 @itemize @bullet
11181 @item
11182 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
11183 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
11184
11185 @item
11186 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
11187 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
11188 @end itemize
11189
11190 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
11191 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
11192
11193 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
11194 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
11195
11196 @node M2 Scope
11197 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
11198 @cindex scope
11199 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
11200 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
11201 @ifinfo
11202 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
11203 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
11204 @end ifinfo
11205 @ifnotinfo
11206 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
11207 @end ifnotinfo
11208
11209 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
11210 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
11211 similar syntax:
11212
11213 @smallexample
11214
11215 @var{module} . @var{id}
11216 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
11217 @end smallexample
11218
11219 @noindent
11220 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
11221 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
11222 identifier within your program, except another module.
11223
11224 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
11225 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
11226 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
11227 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
11228
11229 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
11230 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
11231 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
11232 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
11233 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
11234 @var{module}.
11235
11236 @node GDB/M2
11237 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
11238
11239 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
11240 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
11241 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
11242 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
11243 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
11244 analogue in Modula-2.
11245
11246 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
11247 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
11248 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
11249 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
11250 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
11251 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
11252
11253 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
11254 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
11255 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
11256
11257 @node Ada
11258 @subsection Ada
11259 @cindex Ada
11260
11261 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
11262 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
11263 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
11264 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
11265 to be difficult.
11266
11267
11268 @cindex expressions in Ada
11269 @menu
11270 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
11271 and semantics supported by Ada mode
11272 in @value{GDBN}.
11273 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
11274 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
11275 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
11276 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
11277 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11278 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
11279 @end menu
11280
11281 @node Ada Mode Intro
11282 @subsubsection Introduction
11283 @cindex Ada mode, general
11284
11285 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
11286 syntax, with some extensions.
11287 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
11288
11289 @itemize @bullet
11290 @item
11291 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
11292 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
11293 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
11294 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
11295
11296 @item
11297 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
11298 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11299
11300 @item
11301 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
11302 @end itemize
11303
11304 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
11305 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
11306 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
11307 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
11308 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
11309
11310 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
11311 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
11312 was translated from an Ada source file.
11313
11314 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
11315 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
11316 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
11317 middle (to allow based literals).
11318
11319 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
11320 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
11321 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
11322 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
11323 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
11324 functions to procedures elsewhere.
11325
11326 @node Omissions from Ada
11327 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
11328 @cindex Ada, omissions from
11329
11330 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
11331
11332 @itemize @bullet
11333 @item
11334 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
11335
11336 @itemize @minus
11337 @item
11338 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
11339 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
11340
11341 @item
11342 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
11343
11344 @item
11345 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
11346
11347 @item
11348 @t{'Tag}.
11349
11350 @item
11351 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
11352 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
11353
11354 @item
11355 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
11356 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
11357
11358 @item
11359 @t{'Address}.
11360 @end itemize
11361
11362 @item
11363 The names in
11364 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
11365 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
11366 not currently available.
11367
11368 @item
11369 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
11370 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
11371 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
11372 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
11373 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
11374 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
11375 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
11376 indeterminate values.
11377
11378 @item
11379 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
11380 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
11381 are not implemented.
11382
11383 @item
11384 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
11385 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
11386 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
11387 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
11388 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
11389
11390 @smallexample
11391 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
11392 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
11393 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
11394 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
11395 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
11396 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
11397 @end smallexample
11398
11399 Changing a
11400 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
11401 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
11402 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
11403 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
11404 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
11405 declared to have a type such as:
11406
11407 @smallexample
11408 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
11409 Id : Integer;
11410 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
11411 end record;
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
11415 assignments:
11416
11417 @smallexample
11418 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
11419 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
11420 @end smallexample
11421
11422 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
11423 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
11424 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
11425 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
11426 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
11427 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
11428 redundant component associations, although which component values are
11429 assigned in such cases is not defined.
11430
11431 @item
11432 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
11433
11434 @item
11435 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
11436 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
11437 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
11438 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
11439 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
11440 the proper resolution.
11441
11442 @item
11443 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
11444
11445 @item
11446 Entry calls are not implemented.
11447
11448 @item
11449 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
11450 formats are not supported.
11451
11452 @item
11453 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
11454
11455 @item
11456 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
11457 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
11458 context.
11459 Should your program
11460 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
11461 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
11462 @end itemize
11463
11464 @node Additions to Ada
11465 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
11466 @cindex Ada, deviations from
11467
11468 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
11469 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
11470
11471 @itemize @bullet
11472 @item
11473 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
11474 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
11475 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
11476 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
11477 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
11478 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
11479 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
11480 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
11481
11482 @item
11483 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
11484 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
11485 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
11486
11487 @item
11488 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
11489 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
11490
11491 @item
11492 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
11493 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
11494 @end itemize
11495
11496 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
11497 additions specific to Ada:
11498
11499 @itemize @bullet
11500 @item
11501 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
11502 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
11503
11504 @smallexample
11505 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
11506 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
11507 @end smallexample
11508
11509 @item
11510 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
11511 the value of its right-hand operand.
11512 This allows, for example,
11513 complex conditional breaks:
11514
11515 @smallexample
11516 (@value{GDBP}) break f
11517 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
11518 @end smallexample
11519
11520 @item
11521 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
11522 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
11523 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
11524 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
11525 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
11526 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
11527 in strings. For example,
11528 @smallexample
11529 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
11530 @end smallexample
11531 @noindent
11532 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
11533 after each period.
11534
11535 @item
11536 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
11537 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
11538 to write
11539
11540 @smallexample
11541 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
11542 @end smallexample
11543
11544 @item
11545 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
11546 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
11547 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
11548 of 3 might print as
11549
11550 @smallexample
11551 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
11552 @end smallexample
11553
11554 @noindent
11555 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
11556 clause.
11557
11558 @item
11559 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
11560 multi-character subsequence of
11561 their names (an exact match gets preference).
11562 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
11563 in place of @t{a'length}.
11564
11565 @item
11566 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
11567 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
11568 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
11569 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
11570 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
11571 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
11572 For example,
11573 @smallexample
11574 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
11575 @end smallexample
11576
11577 @item
11578 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
11579 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
11580 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
11581 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
11582 object.
11583
11584 @end itemize
11585
11586 @node Stopping Before Main Program
11587 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
11588
11589 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
11590 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
11591 before reaching the main procedure.
11592 As defined in the Ada Reference
11593 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
11594 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
11595 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
11596 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
11597
11598 @node Ada Tasks
11599 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
11600 @cindex Ada, tasking
11601
11602 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
11603 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
11604
11605 @table @code
11606 @kindex info tasks
11607 @item info tasks
11608 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
11609
11610
11611 @smallexample
11612 @iftex
11613 @leftskip=0.5cm
11614 @end iftex
11615 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11616 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11617 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11618 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
11619 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
11620 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Running c
11621
11622 @end smallexample
11623
11624 @noindent
11625 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
11626 task currently being inspected.
11627
11628 @table @asis
11629 @item ID
11630 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
11631
11632 @item TID
11633 The Ada task ID.
11634
11635 @item P-ID
11636 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
11637
11638 @item Pri
11639 The base priority of the task.
11640
11641 @item State
11642 Current state of the task.
11643
11644 @table @code
11645 @item Unactivated
11646 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
11647 executing.
11648
11649 @item Running
11650 The task currently running.
11651
11652 @item Runnable
11653 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
11654 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
11655
11656 @item Terminated
11657 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
11658 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
11659 terminated themselves.
11660
11661 @item Child Activation Wait
11662 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
11663
11664 @item Accept Statement
11665 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
11666
11667 @item Waiting on entry call
11668 The task is waiting on an entry call.
11669
11670 @item Async Select Wait
11671 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
11672 select statement.
11673
11674 @item Delay Sleep
11675 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
11676 alternative open.
11677
11678 @item Child Termination Wait
11679 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
11680 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
11681 waiting on a terminate Phase.
11682
11683 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
11684 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
11685 finish terminating.
11686
11687 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
11688 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
11689 @end table
11690
11691 @item Name
11692 Name of the task in the program.
11693
11694 @end table
11695
11696 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
11697 @item info task @var{taskno}
11698 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
11699 the following example:
11700 @smallexample
11701 @iftex
11702 @leftskip=0.5cm
11703 @end iftex
11704 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11705 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11706 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11707 * 2 807c468 1 15 Running task_1
11708 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
11709 Ada Task: 0x807c468
11710 Name: task_1
11711 Thread: 0x807f378
11712 Parent: 1 (main_task)
11713 Base Priority: 15
11714 State: Runnable
11715 @end smallexample
11716
11717 @item task
11718 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
11719 @cindex current Ada task ID
11720 This command prints the ID of the current task.
11721
11722 @smallexample
11723 @iftex
11724 @leftskip=0.5cm
11725 @end iftex
11726 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11727 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11728 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11729 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11730 (@value{GDBP}) task
11731 [Current task is 2]
11732 @end smallexample
11733
11734 @item task @var{taskno}
11735 @cindex Ada task switching
11736 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
11737 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
11738 from the current task to the given task.
11739
11740 @smallexample
11741 @iftex
11742 @leftskip=0.5cm
11743 @end iftex
11744 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
11745 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
11746 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
11747 * 2 807c458 1 15 Running t
11748 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
11749 [Switching to task 1]
11750 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11751 (@value{GDBP}) bt
11752 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
11753 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
11754 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
11755 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
11756 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
11757 @end smallexample
11758
11759 @end table
11760
11761 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
11762 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
11763 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
11764
11765 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
11766 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
11767 the platform being used.
11768 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
11769 switching is not supported. On Tru64, however, task switching will work
11770 as usual.
11771
11772 On certain platforms, including Tru64, the debugger needs to perform some
11773 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
11774 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
11775 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
11776 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
11777 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
11778
11779 @node Ada Glitches
11780 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
11781 @cindex Ada, problems
11782
11783 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
11784 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
11785 @value{GDBN},
11786 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
11787 and the GNU Ada compiler.
11788
11789 @itemize @bullet
11790 @item
11791 Currently, the debugger
11792 has insufficient information to determine whether certain pointers represent
11793 pointers to objects or the objects themselves.
11794 Thus, the user may have to tack an extra @code{.all} after an expression
11795 to get it printed properly.
11796
11797 @item
11798 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
11799 storage are invisible to the debugger.
11800
11801 @item
11802 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
11803 argument lists are treated as positional).
11804
11805 @item
11806 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
11807
11808 @item
11809 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
11810 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
11811 the host machine.
11812
11813 @item
11814 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
11815 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
11816 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
11817 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
11818 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
11819 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
11820 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
11821 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
11822 you can usually resolve the confusion
11823 by qualifying the problematic names with package
11824 @code{Standard} explicitly.
11825 @end itemize
11826
11827 @node Unsupported Languages
11828 @section Unsupported Languages
11829
11830 @cindex unsupported languages
11831 @cindex minimal language
11832 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
11833 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
11834 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
11835 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
11836 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
11837 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
11838
11839 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
11840 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
11841 language.
11842
11843 @node Symbols
11844 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
11845
11846 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
11847 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
11848 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
11849 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
11850 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
11851 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
11852 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
11853
11854 @cindex symbol names
11855 @cindex names of symbols
11856 @cindex quoting names
11857 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
11858 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
11859 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
11860 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
11861 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
11862 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
11863 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
11864 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
11865
11866 @smallexample
11867 p 'foo.c'::x
11868 @end smallexample
11869
11870 @noindent
11871 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
11872
11873 @table @code
11874 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
11875 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
11876 @kindex set case-sensitive
11877 @item set case-sensitive on
11878 @itemx set case-sensitive off
11879 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
11880 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
11881 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
11882 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
11883 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
11884 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
11885 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
11886 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
11887 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
11888 case-insensitive matches.
11889
11890 @kindex show case-sensitive
11891 @item show case-sensitive
11892 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
11893 lookups.
11894
11895 @kindex info address
11896 @cindex address of a symbol
11897 @item info address @var{symbol}
11898 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
11899 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
11900 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
11901 is always stored.
11902
11903 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
11904 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
11905 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
11906
11907 @kindex info symbol
11908 @cindex symbol from address
11909 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
11910 @item info symbol @var{addr}
11911 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
11912 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
11913 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
11914
11915 @smallexample
11916 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
11917 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
11918 @end smallexample
11919
11920 @noindent
11921 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
11922 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
11923
11924 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
11925 library containing the symbol is also printed:
11926
11927 @smallexample
11928 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
11929 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
11930 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
11931 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
11932 @end smallexample
11933
11934 @kindex whatis
11935 @item whatis [@var{arg}]
11936 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression or
11937 a data type. With no argument, print the data type of @code{$}, the
11938 last value in the value history. If @var{arg} is an expression, it is
11939 not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
11940 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place. If
11941 @var{arg} is a type name, it may be the name of a type or typedef, or
11942 for C code it may have the form @samp{class @var{class-name}},
11943 @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union @var{union-tag}} or
11944 @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
11945 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11946
11947 @kindex ptype
11948 @item ptype [@var{arg}]
11949 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
11950 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
11951 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
11952
11953 For example, for this variable declaration:
11954
11955 @smallexample
11956 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
11957 @end smallexample
11958
11959 @noindent
11960 the two commands give this output:
11961
11962 @smallexample
11963 @group
11964 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
11965 type = struct complex
11966 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
11967 type = struct complex @{
11968 double real;
11969 double imag;
11970 @}
11971 @end group
11972 @end smallexample
11973
11974 @noindent
11975 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
11976 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
11977
11978 @cindex incomplete type
11979 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
11980 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
11981 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
11982 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
11983 given these declarations:
11984
11985 @smallexample
11986 struct foo;
11987 struct foo *fooptr;
11988 @end smallexample
11989
11990 @noindent
11991 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
11992
11993 @smallexample
11994 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
11995 $1 = <incomplete type>
11996 @end smallexample
11997
11998 @noindent
11999 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
12000 completely specified.
12001
12002 @kindex info types
12003 @item info types @var{regexp}
12004 @itemx info types
12005 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
12006 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
12007 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
12008 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
12009 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
12010 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
12011 name is @code{value}.
12012
12013 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
12014 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
12015 lists all source files where a type is defined.
12016
12017 @kindex info scope
12018 @cindex local variables
12019 @item info scope @var{location}
12020 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
12021 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
12022 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
12023 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
12024 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
12025
12026 @smallexample
12027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
12028 Scope for command_line_handler:
12029 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
12030 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
12031 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
12032 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
12033 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
12034 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
12035 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
12036 @end smallexample
12037
12038 @noindent
12039 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
12040 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
12041 collect}.
12042
12043 @kindex info source
12044 @item info source
12045 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
12046 the function containing the current point of execution:
12047 @itemize @bullet
12048 @item
12049 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
12050 @item
12051 the directory it was compiled in,
12052 @item
12053 its length, in lines,
12054 @item
12055 which programming language it is written in,
12056 @item
12057 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
12058 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
12059 @item
12060 whether the debugging information includes information about
12061 preprocessor macros.
12062 @end itemize
12063
12064
12065 @kindex info sources
12066 @item info sources
12067 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
12068 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
12069 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
12070
12071 @kindex info functions
12072 @item info functions
12073 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
12074
12075 @item info functions @var{regexp}
12076 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
12077 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
12078 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
12079 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
12080 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
12081 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
12082 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
12083
12084 @kindex info variables
12085 @item info variables
12086 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
12087 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
12088
12089 @item info variables @var{regexp}
12090 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
12091 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
12092 @var{regexp}.
12093
12094 @kindex info classes
12095 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
12096 @item info classes
12097 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
12098 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
12099 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12100 expression.
12101
12102 @kindex info selectors
12103 @item info selectors
12104 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
12105 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
12106 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
12107 expression.
12108
12109 @ignore
12110 This was never implemented.
12111 @kindex info methods
12112 @item info methods
12113 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
12114 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
12115 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
12116 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
12117 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
12118 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
12119 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
12120 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
12121 @end ignore
12122
12123 @cindex reloading symbols
12124 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
12125 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
12126 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
12127 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
12128 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
12129
12130 @table @code
12131 @kindex set symbol-reloading
12132 @item set symbol-reloading on
12133 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
12134 object file with a particular name is seen again.
12135
12136 @item set symbol-reloading off
12137 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
12138 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
12139 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
12140 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
12141 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
12142 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
12143 name.
12144
12145 @kindex show symbol-reloading
12146 @item show symbol-reloading
12147 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
12148 @end table
12149
12150 @cindex opaque data types
12151 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
12152 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
12153 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
12154 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
12155 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
12156 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
12157 another source file. The default is on.
12158
12159 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
12160 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
12161
12162 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
12163 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
12164 is printed as follows:
12165 @smallexample
12166 @{<no data fields>@}
12167 @end smallexample
12168
12169 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
12170 @item show opaque-type-resolution
12171 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
12172
12173 @kindex set print symbol-loading
12174 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
12175 @item set print symbol-loading
12176 @itemx set print symbol-loading on
12177 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
12178 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to enable or
12179 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12180 By default, these messages will be printed, and normally this is what
12181 you want. Disabling these messages is useful when debugging applications
12182 with lots of shared libraries where the quantity of output can be more
12183 annoying than useful.
12184
12185 @kindex show print symbol-loading
12186 @item show print symbol-loading
12187 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} loads symbols.
12188
12189 @kindex maint print symbols
12190 @cindex symbol dump
12191 @kindex maint print psymbols
12192 @cindex partial symbol dump
12193 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
12194 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
12195 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
12196 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
12197 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
12198 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
12199 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
12200 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
12201 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
12202 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
12203 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
12204 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
12205 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
12206 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
12207 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
12208 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
12209 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
12210
12211 @kindex maint info symtabs
12212 @kindex maint info psymtabs
12213 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
12214 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12215 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12216 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
12217 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12218 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
12219
12220 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
12221 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
12222 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
12223 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
12224 structure in more detail. For example:
12225
12226 @smallexample
12227 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
12228 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12229 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12230 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12231 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
12232 readin no
12233 fullname (null)
12234 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
12235 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
12236 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
12237 dependencies (none)
12238 @}
12239 @}
12240 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12241 (@value{GDBP})
12242 @end smallexample
12243 @noindent
12244 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
12245 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
12246 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
12247 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
12248 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
12249
12250 @smallexample
12251 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
12252 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
12253 line 1574.
12254 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
12255 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
12256 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
12257 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
12258 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
12259 dirname (null)
12260 fullname (null)
12261 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
12262 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
12263 debugformat DWARF 2
12264 @}
12265 @}
12266 (@value{GDBP})
12267 @end smallexample
12268 @end table
12269
12270
12271 @node Altering
12272 @chapter Altering Execution
12273
12274 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
12275 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
12276 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
12277 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
12278 program.
12279
12280 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
12281 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
12282 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
12283
12284 @menu
12285 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
12286 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
12287 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
12288 * Returning:: Returning from a function
12289 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
12290 * Patching:: Patching your program
12291 @end menu
12292
12293 @node Assignment
12294 @section Assignment to Variables
12295
12296 @cindex assignment
12297 @cindex setting variables
12298 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
12299 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
12300
12301 @smallexample
12302 print x=4
12303 @end smallexample
12304
12305 @noindent
12306 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
12307 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
12308 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
12309 information on operators in supported languages.
12310
12311 @kindex set variable
12312 @cindex variables, setting
12313 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
12314 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
12315 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
12316 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
12317 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
12318
12319 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
12320 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
12321 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
12322 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
12323 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
12324 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
12325 command @code{set width}:
12326
12327 @smallexample
12328 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
12329 type = double
12330 (@value{GDBP}) p width
12331 $4 = 13
12332 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
12333 Invalid syntax in expression.
12334 @end smallexample
12335
12336 @noindent
12337 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
12338 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
12339
12340 @smallexample
12341 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
12342 @end smallexample
12343
12344 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
12345 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
12346 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
12347 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
12348 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
12349 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
12350
12351 @smallexample
12352 @group
12353 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
12354 type = double
12355 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12356 $1 = 1
12357 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
12358 (@value{GDBP}) p g
12359 $2 = 1
12360 (@value{GDBP}) r
12361 The program being debugged has been started already.
12362 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
12363 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
12364 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
12365 Invalid bfd target.
12366 (@value{GDBP}) show g
12367 The current BFD target is "=4".
12368 @end group
12369 @end smallexample
12370
12371 @noindent
12372 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
12373 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
12374 @code{g}, use
12375
12376 @smallexample
12377 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
12378 @end smallexample
12379
12380 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
12381 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
12382 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
12383 same length or shorter.
12384 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
12385 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
12386
12387 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
12388 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
12389 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
12390 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
12391 and representation in memory), and
12392
12393 @smallexample
12394 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
12395 @end smallexample
12396
12397 @noindent
12398 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
12399
12400 @node Jumping
12401 @section Continuing at a Different Address
12402
12403 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
12404 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
12405 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
12406
12407 @table @code
12408 @kindex jump
12409 @item jump @var{linespec}
12410 @itemx jump @var{location}
12411 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
12412 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
12413 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
12414 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
12415 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
12416 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
12417
12418 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
12419 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
12420 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
12421 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
12422 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
12423 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
12424 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
12425 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
12426 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
12427 @end table
12428
12429 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
12430 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
12431 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
12432 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
12433 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
12434 example,
12435
12436 @smallexample
12437 set $pc = 0x485
12438 @end smallexample
12439
12440 @noindent
12441 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
12442 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
12443 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
12444
12445 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
12446 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
12447 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
12448 detail.
12449
12450 @c @group
12451 @node Signaling
12452 @section Giving your Program a Signal
12453 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
12454
12455 @table @code
12456 @kindex signal
12457 @item signal @var{signal}
12458 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
12459 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
12460 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
12461 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
12462
12463 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
12464 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
12465 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
12466 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
12467 signal.
12468
12469 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
12470 after executing the command.
12471 @end table
12472 @c @end group
12473
12474 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
12475 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
12476 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
12477 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
12478 passes the signal directly to your program.
12479
12480
12481 @node Returning
12482 @section Returning from a Function
12483
12484 @table @code
12485 @cindex returning from a function
12486 @kindex return
12487 @item return
12488 @itemx return @var{expression}
12489 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
12490 command. If you give an
12491 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
12492 value.
12493 @end table
12494
12495 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
12496 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
12497 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
12498 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
12499
12500 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
12501 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
12502 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
12503 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
12504 of functions.
12505
12506 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
12507 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
12508 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
12509 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
12510 selected stack frame returns naturally.
12511
12512 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
12513 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
12514 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
12515 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
12516 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
12517 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
12518 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
12519 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
12520 assignment into the right register(s).
12521
12522 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
12523 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
12524 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
12525 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
12526 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
12527 into a @code{long long int}:
12528
12529 @smallexample
12530 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
12531 29 return 31;
12532 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12533 Make func return now? (y or n) y
12534 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
12535 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
12536 (@value{GDBP})
12537 @end smallexample
12538
12539 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
12540 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
12541 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
12542 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
12543 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
12544 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
12545 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
12546 an appropriate cast explicitly:
12547
12548 @smallexample
12549 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
12550 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
12551 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
12552 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
12553 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
12554 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
12555 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
12556 (@value{GDBP})
12557 @end smallexample
12558
12559 @node Calling
12560 @section Calling Program Functions
12561
12562 @table @code
12563 @cindex calling functions
12564 @cindex inferior functions, calling
12565 @item print @var{expr}
12566 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
12567 @var{expr} may include calls to functions in the program being
12568 debugged.
12569
12570 @kindex call
12571 @item call @var{expr}
12572 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
12573 returned values.
12574
12575 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
12576 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
12577 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
12578 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
12579 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
12580 value history.
12581 @end table
12582
12583 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
12584 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
12585 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
12586 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
12587
12588 @table @code
12589 @item set unwindonsignal
12590 @kindex set unwindonsignal
12591 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
12592 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
12593 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
12594 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
12595 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
12596 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
12597 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
12598 received.
12599
12600 @item show unwindonsignal
12601 @kindex show unwindonsignal
12602 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
12603 @value{GDBN}.
12604 @end table
12605
12606 @cindex weak alias functions
12607 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
12608 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
12609 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
12610 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
12611 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
12612 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
12613 function instead.
12614
12615 @node Patching
12616 @section Patching Programs
12617
12618 @cindex patching binaries
12619 @cindex writing into executables
12620 @cindex writing into corefiles
12621
12622 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
12623 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
12624 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
12625 patching your program's binary.
12626
12627 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
12628 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
12629 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
12630 repairs.
12631
12632 @table @code
12633 @kindex set write
12634 @item set write on
12635 @itemx set write off
12636 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
12637 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
12638 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
12639
12640 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
12641 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
12642 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
12643
12644 @item show write
12645 @kindex show write
12646 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
12647 as well as reading.
12648 @end table
12649
12650 @node GDB Files
12651 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
12652
12653 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
12654 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
12655 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
12656 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
12657
12658 @menu
12659 * Files:: Commands to specify files
12660 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
12661 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
12662 @end menu
12663
12664 @node Files
12665 @section Commands to Specify Files
12666
12667 @cindex symbol table
12668 @cindex core dump file
12669
12670 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
12671 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
12672 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
12673 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
12674
12675 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
12676 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
12677 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
12678 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
12679 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
12680 new files are useful.
12681
12682 @table @code
12683 @cindex executable file
12684 @kindex file
12685 @item file @var{filename}
12686 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
12687 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
12688 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
12689 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
12690 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
12691 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
12692 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
12693 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
12694
12695 @cindex unlinked object files
12696 @cindex patching object files
12697 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
12698 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
12699 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
12700 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
12701 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
12702 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
12703 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
12704 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
12705
12706 @item file
12707 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
12708 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
12709
12710 @kindex exec-file
12711 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12712 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
12713 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
12714 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
12715 discard information on the executable file.
12716
12717 @kindex symbol-file
12718 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
12719 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
12720 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
12721 table and program to run from the same file.
12722
12723 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
12724 program's symbol table.
12725
12726 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
12727 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
12728 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
12729 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
12730 @value{GDBN}.
12731
12732 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
12733 executing it once.
12734
12735 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
12736 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
12737 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
12738 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
12739 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
12740 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
12741 optimized code.
12742
12743 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
12744 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
12745 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
12746 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
12747 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
12748
12749 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
12750 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
12751 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
12752 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
12753 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
12754 Warnings and Messages}.)
12755
12756 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
12757 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
12758 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
12759 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
12760 in stabs format.
12761
12762 @kindex readnow
12763 @cindex reading symbols immediately
12764 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
12765 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12766 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12767 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
12768 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
12769 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
12770 entire symbol table available.
12771
12772 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
12773 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
12774 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
12775 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
12776 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
12777 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
12778 @c files.
12779
12780 @kindex core-file
12781 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
12782 @itemx core
12783 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
12784 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
12785 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
12786 executable file itself for other parts.
12787
12788 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
12789 to be used.
12790
12791 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
12792 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
12793 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
12794 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
12795 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
12796
12797 @kindex add-symbol-file
12798 @cindex dynamic linking
12799 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
12800 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
12801 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
12802 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
12803 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
12804 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
12805 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
12806 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
12807 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
12808 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
12809 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
12810 @var{address} as an expression.
12811
12812 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
12813 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
12814 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
12815 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
12816 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
12817
12818 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
12819 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
12820 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
12821 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
12822 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
12823 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
12824 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
12825 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
12826 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
12827
12828 @itemize @bullet
12829 @item
12830 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
12831 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
12832 @item
12833 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
12834 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
12835 @item
12836 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
12837 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
12838 @end itemize
12839
12840 @noindent
12841 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
12842 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
12843 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
12844 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
12845 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
12846 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
12847 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
12848 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
12849 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
12850 way.
12851
12852 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
12853
12854 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
12855 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
12856 @cindex load symbols from memory
12857 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
12858 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
12859 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
12860 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
12861 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
12862 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
12863 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
12864 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
12865 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
12866
12867 @kindex add-shared-symbol-files
12868 @kindex assf
12869 @item add-shared-symbol-files @var{library-file}
12870 @itemx assf @var{library-file}
12871 The @code{add-shared-symbol-files} command can currently be used only
12872 in the Cygwin build of @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows OS, where it is an
12873 alias for the @code{dll-symbols} command (@pxref{Cygwin Native}).
12874 @value{GDBN} automatically looks for shared libraries, however if
12875 @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can invoke
12876 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}. It takes one argument: the shared
12877 library's file name. @code{assf} is a shorthand alias for
12878 @code{add-shared-symbol-files}.
12879
12880 @kindex section
12881 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
12882 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
12883 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
12884 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
12885 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
12886 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
12887 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
12888 their addresses.
12889
12890 @kindex info files
12891 @kindex info target
12892 @item info files
12893 @itemx info target
12894 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
12895 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
12896 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
12897 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
12898 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
12899 current ones.
12900
12901 @kindex maint info sections
12902 @item maint info sections
12903 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
12904 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
12905 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
12906 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
12907 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
12908 may be arbitrarily combined):
12909
12910 @table @code
12911 @item ALLOBJ
12912 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
12913 @item @var{sections}
12914 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
12915 @item @var{section-flags}
12916 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
12917 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
12918 @table @code
12919 @item ALLOC
12920 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
12921 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
12922 @item LOAD
12923 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
12924 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
12925 @item RELOC
12926 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
12927 @item READONLY
12928 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
12929 @item CODE
12930 Section contains executable code only.
12931 @item DATA
12932 Section contains data only (no executable code).
12933 @item ROM
12934 Section will reside in ROM.
12935 @item CONSTRUCTOR
12936 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
12937 @item HAS_CONTENTS
12938 Section is not empty.
12939 @item NEVER_LOAD
12940 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
12941 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
12942 A notification to the linker that the section contains
12943 COFF shared library information.
12944 @item IS_COMMON
12945 Section contains common symbols.
12946 @end table
12947 @end table
12948 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
12949 @cindex read-only sections
12950 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
12951 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
12952 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
12953 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
12954 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
12955 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
12956 enhancement to debugging performance.
12957
12958 The default is off.
12959
12960 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
12961 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
12962 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
12963 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
12964
12965 @item show trust-readonly-sections
12966 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
12967 @end table
12968
12969 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
12970 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
12971 name and remembers it that way.
12972
12973 @cindex shared libraries
12974 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
12975 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
12976 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
12977
12978 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
12979 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
12980
12981 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
12982 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
12983 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
12984 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
12985 debugging a core file).
12986
12987 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
12988 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
12989
12990 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
12991 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
12992 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
12993
12994 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
12995 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
12996 particularly large or there are many of them.
12997
12998 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
12999 commands:
13000
13001 @table @code
13002 @kindex set auto-solib-add
13003 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
13004 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
13005 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
13006 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
13007 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
13008 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
13009 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
13010
13011 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
13012 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
13013 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
13014 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
13015 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
13016 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
13017 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
13018 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
13019 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
13020
13021 @kindex show auto-solib-add
13022 @item show auto-solib-add
13023 Display the current autoloading mode.
13024 @end table
13025
13026 @cindex load shared library
13027 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
13028 command:
13029
13030 @table @code
13031 @kindex info sharedlibrary
13032 @kindex info share
13033 @item info share
13034 @itemx info sharedlibrary
13035 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
13036
13037 @kindex sharedlibrary
13038 @kindex share
13039 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
13040 @itemx share @var{regex}
13041 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
13042 Unix regular expression.
13043 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
13044 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
13045 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
13046 loaded.
13047
13048 @item nosharedlibrary
13049 @kindex nosharedlibrary
13050 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
13051 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
13052 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
13053 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
13054 discarded.
13055 @end table
13056
13057 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
13058 when any of shared library events happen. Use the @code{set
13059 stop-on-solib-events} command for this:
13060
13061 @table @code
13062 @item set stop-on-solib-events
13063 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
13064 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
13065 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
13066 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
13067 shared library.
13068
13069 @item show stop-on-solib-events
13070 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
13071 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
13072 library events happen.
13073 @end table
13074
13075 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
13076 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
13077 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
13078 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
13079 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
13080 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
13081 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
13082 not.
13083
13084 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
13085 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
13086 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
13087 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
13088 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
13089
13090 @table @code
13091 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
13092 @cindex system root, alternate
13093 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
13094 @kindex set sysroot
13095 @item set sysroot @var{path}
13096 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
13097 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
13098 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
13099 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
13100 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
13101 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
13102 under @var{path}.
13103
13104 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{remote:}, @value{GDBN} will
13105 retrieve the target libraries from the remote system. This is only
13106 supported when using a remote target that supports the @code{remote get}
13107 command (@pxref{File Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}).
13108 The part of @var{path} following the initial @file{remote:}
13109 (if present) is used as system root prefix on the remote file system.
13110 @footnote{If you want to specify a local system root using a directory
13111 that happens to be named @file{remote:}, you need to use some equivalent
13112 variant of the name like @file{./remote:}.}
13113
13114 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
13115 sysroot}.
13116
13117 @cindex default system root
13118 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
13119 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
13120 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
13121 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
13122 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
13123 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
13124 location.
13125
13126 @kindex show sysroot
13127 @item show sysroot
13128 Display the current shared library prefix.
13129
13130 @kindex set solib-search-path
13131 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
13132 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
13133 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
13134 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
13135 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
13136 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
13137 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
13138 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
13139 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
13140 of shared library symbols.
13141
13142 @kindex show solib-search-path
13143 @item show solib-search-path
13144 Display the current shared library search path.
13145 @end table
13146
13147
13148 @node Separate Debug Files
13149 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
13150 @cindex separate debugging information files
13151 @cindex debugging information in separate files
13152 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
13153 @cindex debugging information directory, global
13154 @cindex global debugging information directory
13155 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
13156 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
13157
13158 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
13159 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
13160 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
13161 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
13162 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
13163 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
13164 install only when they need to debug a problem.
13165
13166 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
13167 file:
13168
13169 @itemize @bullet
13170 @item
13171 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
13172 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
13173 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
13174 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
13175 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
13176 debug link specifies a CRC32 checksum for the debug file, which
13177 @value{GDBN} uses to validate that the executable and the debug file
13178 came from the same build.
13179
13180 @item
13181 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
13182 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
13183 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
13184 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
13185 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
13186 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
13187 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
13188 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
13189 below.
13190 @end itemize
13191
13192 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
13193 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
13194
13195 @itemize @bullet
13196 @item
13197 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
13198 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
13199 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under the global debug
13200 directory, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
13201 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
13202
13203 @item
13204 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
13205 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of the global debug directory for a file
13206 named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
13207 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
13208 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
13209 hex characters, not 10.)
13210 @end itemize
13211
13212 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
13213 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
13214 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
13215 @code{abcdef1234}. If the global debug directory is
13216 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
13217 debug information files, in the indicated order:
13218
13219 @itemize @minus
13220 @item
13221 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
13222 @item
13223 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
13224 @item
13225 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
13226 @item
13227 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
13228 @end itemize
13229
13230 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
13231 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
13232
13233 @table @code
13234
13235 @kindex set debug-file-directory
13236 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
13237 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13238 information files to @var{directory}.
13239
13240 @kindex show debug-file-directory
13241 @item show debug-file-directory
13242 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
13243 information files.
13244
13245 @end table
13246
13247 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
13248 @cindex debug link sections
13249 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
13250 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
13251
13252 @itemize
13253 @item
13254 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
13255 a zero byte,
13256 @item
13257 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
13258 boundary within the section, and
13259 @item
13260 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
13261 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
13262 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
13263 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
13264 @end itemize
13265
13266 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
13267 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
13268 described above.
13269
13270 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
13271 @cindex build ID sections
13272 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
13273 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
13274 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
13275 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
13276 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
13277 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
13278 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
13279 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
13280 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
13281
13282 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
13283 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
13284 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
13285 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
13286 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
13287 in an ordinary executable.
13288
13289 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
13290 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
13291 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
13292 following commands:
13293
13294 @smallexample
13295 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
13296 @kbd{strip -g foo}
13297 @end smallexample
13298
13299 @noindent
13300 These commands remove the debugging
13301 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
13302 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
13303 two files:
13304
13305 @itemize @bullet
13306 @item
13307 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
13308 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
13309
13310 @smallexample
13311 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
13312 @end smallexample
13313
13314 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
13315 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
13316 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
13317 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
13318
13319 @item
13320 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
13321 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
13322 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
13323 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
13324 @end itemize
13325
13326 @noindent
13327
13328 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's for the debug
13329 link (different polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the
13330 simplest way to describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}
13331 sections is to give the complete code for a function that computes it:
13332
13333 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
13334 @smallexample
13335 unsigned long
13336 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
13337 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
13338 @{
13339 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
13340 @{
13341 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
13342 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
13343 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
13344 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
13345 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
13346 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
13347 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
13348 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
13349 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
13350 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
13351 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
13352 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
13353 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
13354 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
13355 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
13356 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
13357 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
13358 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
13359 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
13360 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
13361 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
13362 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
13363 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
13364 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
13365 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
13366 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
13367 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
13368 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
13369 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
13370 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
13371 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
13372 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
13373 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
13374 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
13375 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
13376 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
13377 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
13378 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
13379 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
13380 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
13381 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
13382 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
13383 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
13384 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
13385 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
13386 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
13387 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
13388 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
13389 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
13390 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
13391 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
13392 0x2d02ef8d
13393 @};
13394 unsigned char *end;
13395
13396 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13397 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
13398 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
13399 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
13400 @}
13401 @end smallexample
13402
13403 @noindent
13404 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
13405
13406
13407 @node Symbol Errors
13408 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
13409
13410 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
13411 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
13412 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
13413 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
13414 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
13415 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
13416 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
13417 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
13418 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
13419 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13420 Messages}).
13421
13422 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
13423
13424 @table @code
13425 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
13426
13427 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
13428 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
13429 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
13430 in its outer scope blocks.
13431
13432 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
13433 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
13434 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
13435 function.
13436
13437 @item block at @var{address} out of order
13438
13439 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
13440 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
13441 do so.
13442
13443 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
13444 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
13445 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
13446 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
13447 Messages}.)
13448
13449 @item bad block start address patched
13450
13451 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
13452 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
13453 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
13454
13455 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
13456 starting on the previous source line.
13457
13458 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
13459
13460 @cindex foo
13461 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
13462 larger than the size of the string table.
13463
13464 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
13465 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
13466 with this name.
13467
13468 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
13469
13470 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
13471 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
13472 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
13473
13474 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
13475 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
13476 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
13477 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
13478 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
13479 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
13480
13481 @item stub type has NULL name
13482
13483 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
13484
13485 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
13486 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
13487 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
13488 it.
13489
13490 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
13491
13492 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
13493
13494 @end table
13495
13496 @node Targets
13497 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
13498
13499 @cindex debugging target
13500 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
13501
13502 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
13503 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
13504 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
13505 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
13506 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
13507 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
13508 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
13509 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
13510
13511 @cindex target architecture
13512 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
13513 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
13514 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
13515 command.
13516
13517 @table @code
13518 @kindex set architecture
13519 @kindex show architecture
13520 @item set architecture @var{arch}
13521 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
13522 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
13523 supported architectures.
13524
13525 @item show architecture
13526 Show the current target architecture.
13527
13528 @item set processor
13529 @itemx processor
13530 @kindex set processor
13531 @kindex show processor
13532 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
13533 and @code{show architecture}.
13534 @end table
13535
13536 @menu
13537 * Active Targets:: Active targets
13538 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
13539 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
13540 @end menu
13541
13542 @node Active Targets
13543 @section Active Targets
13544
13545 @cindex stacking targets
13546 @cindex active targets
13547 @cindex multiple targets
13548
13549 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
13550 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
13551 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
13552 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
13553 a core file.
13554
13555 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
13556 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
13557 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
13558 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
13559 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
13560 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
13561 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
13562 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
13563 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
13564
13565 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
13566 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
13567 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
13568 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
13569 process target is active.
13570
13571 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
13572 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify
13573 Files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
13574 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
13575 Process}).
13576
13577 @node Target Commands
13578 @section Commands for Managing Targets
13579
13580 @table @code
13581 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
13582 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
13583 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
13584 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
13585 protocol of the target machine.
13586
13587 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
13588 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
13589 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
13590
13591 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
13592 after executing the command.
13593
13594 @kindex help target
13595 @item help target
13596 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
13597 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
13598 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
13599
13600 @item help target @var{name}
13601 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
13602 select it.
13603
13604 @kindex set gnutarget
13605 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
13606 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
13607 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
13608 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
13609 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
13610 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
13611
13612 @quotation
13613 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
13614 you must know the actual BFD name.
13615 @end quotation
13616
13617 @noindent
13618 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
13619
13620 @kindex show gnutarget
13621 @item show gnutarget
13622 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
13623 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
13624 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
13625 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
13626 @end table
13627
13628 @cindex common targets
13629 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
13630 configuration):
13631
13632 @table @code
13633 @kindex target
13634 @item target exec @var{program}
13635 @cindex executable file target
13636 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
13637 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
13638
13639 @item target core @var{filename}
13640 @cindex core dump file target
13641 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
13642 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
13643
13644 @item target remote @var{medium}
13645 @cindex remote target
13646 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
13647 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
13648 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
13649
13650 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
13651 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
13652
13653 @smallexample
13654 target remote /dev/ttya
13655 @end smallexample
13656
13657 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
13658 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
13659 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
13660 clobbered by the download.
13661
13662 @item target sim
13663 @cindex built-in simulator target
13664 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
13665 In general,
13666 @smallexample
13667 target sim
13668 load
13669 run
13670 @end smallexample
13671 @noindent
13672 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
13673 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
13674 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
13675 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
13676 Processors}.
13677
13678 @end table
13679
13680 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
13681
13682 @table @code
13683
13684 @item target nrom @var{dev}
13685 @cindex NetROM ROM emulator target
13686 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
13687
13688 @end table
13689
13690 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
13691 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
13692
13693 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
13694 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
13695 various aspects of this process.
13696
13697 @table @code
13698
13699 @item set hash
13700 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13701 @cindex hash mark while downloading
13702 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
13703 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
13704 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
13705 monitor.
13706
13707 @item show hash
13708 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
13709 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
13710
13711 @item set debug monitor
13712 @kindex set debug monitor
13713 @cindex display remote monitor communications
13714 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
13715 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13716
13717 @item show debug monitor
13718 @kindex show debug monitor
13719 Show the current status of displaying communications between
13720 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
13721 @end table
13722
13723 @table @code
13724
13725 @kindex load @var{filename}
13726 @item load @var{filename}
13727 @anchor{load}
13728 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
13729 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
13730 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
13731 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
13732 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
13733 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
13734
13735 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
13736 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
13737 target is @dots{}}''
13738
13739 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
13740 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
13741 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
13742 specifies a fixed address.
13743 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
13744
13745 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
13746 load programs into flash memory.
13747
13748 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
13749 @end table
13750
13751 @node Byte Order
13752 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
13753
13754 @cindex choosing target byte order
13755 @cindex target byte order
13756
13757 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
13758 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
13759 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
13760 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
13761 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
13762 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
13763
13764 @table @code
13765 @kindex set endian
13766 @item set endian big
13767 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
13768
13769 @item set endian little
13770 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
13771
13772 @item set endian auto
13773 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
13774 executable.
13775
13776 @item show endian
13777 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
13778
13779 @end table
13780
13781 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
13782 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
13783 target system.
13784
13785
13786 @node Remote Debugging
13787 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
13788 @cindex remote debugging
13789
13790 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
13791 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
13792 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
13793 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
13794 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
13795
13796 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
13797 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
13798 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
13799 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
13800 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
13801 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
13802
13803 Other remote targets may be available in your
13804 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
13805
13806 @menu
13807 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
13808 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
13809 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
13810 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
13811 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
13812 @end menu
13813
13814 @node Connecting
13815 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
13816
13817 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
13818 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
13819 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
13820 program as the first argument.
13821
13822 @cindex @code{target remote}
13823 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
13824 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
13825 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
13826 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
13827 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
13828 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
13829
13830 @table @code
13831
13832 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
13833 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
13834 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
13835 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
13836
13837 @smallexample
13838 target remote /dev/ttyb
13839 @end smallexample
13840
13841 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
13842 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
13843 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remotebaud}) before the
13844 @code{target} command.
13845
13846 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
13847 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13848 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
13849 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
13850 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
13851 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
13852 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
13853 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
13854 target.
13855
13856 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
13857 @code{manyfarms}:
13858
13859 @smallexample
13860 target remote manyfarms:2828
13861 @end smallexample
13862
13863 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
13864 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
13865 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
13866 port 1234 on your local machine:
13867
13868 @smallexample
13869 target remote :1234
13870 @end smallexample
13871 @noindent
13872
13873 Note that the colon is still required here.
13874
13875 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
13876 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
13877 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
13878 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
13879
13880 @smallexample
13881 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
13882 @end smallexample
13883
13884 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
13885 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
13886 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
13887 cause havoc with your debugging session.
13888
13889 @item target remote | @var{command}
13890 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
13891 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
13892 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
13893 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
13894 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
13895 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
13896 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
13897 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
13898
13899 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
13900 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
13901 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
13902
13903 @end table
13904
13905 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
13906 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
13907 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
13908 need to use @kbd{run}.
13909
13910 @cindex interrupting remote programs
13911 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
13912 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
13913 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
13914 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
13915 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
13916 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
13917
13918 @smallexample
13919 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
13920 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
13921 @end smallexample
13922
13923 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
13924 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
13925 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
13926 goes back to waiting.
13927
13928 @table @code
13929 @kindex detach (remote)
13930 @item detach
13931 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
13932 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
13933 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
13934 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
13935 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
13936
13937 @kindex disconnect
13938 @item disconnect
13939 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
13940 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
13941 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
13942 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
13943 another target.
13944
13945 @cindex send command to remote monitor
13946 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
13947 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
13948 @kindex monitor
13949 @item monitor @var{cmd}
13950 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
13951 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
13952 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
13953 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
13954 and implement.
13955 @end table
13956
13957 @node File Transfer
13958 @section Sending files to a remote system
13959 @cindex remote target, file transfer
13960 @cindex file transfer
13961 @cindex sending files to remote systems
13962
13963 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
13964 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
13965 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
13966 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
13967 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
13968 the only way to upload or download files.
13969
13970 Not all remote targets support these commands.
13971
13972 @table @code
13973 @kindex remote put
13974 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
13975 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
13976 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
13977
13978 @kindex remote get
13979 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
13980 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
13981 on the host system.
13982
13983 @kindex remote delete
13984 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
13985 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
13986
13987 @end table
13988
13989 @node Server
13990 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
13991
13992 @kindex gdbserver
13993 @cindex remote connection without stubs
13994 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
13995 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
13996 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
13997
13998 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
13999 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
14000 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
14001 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
14002 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
14003 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
14004 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
14005 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
14006 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
14007 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
14008 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
14009 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
14010 choice for debugging.
14011
14012 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
14013 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
14014 protocol.
14015
14016 @quotation
14017 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
14018 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
14019 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
14020 target system with the same privileges as the user running
14021 @code{gdbserver}.
14022 @end quotation
14023
14024 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
14025 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
14026
14027 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
14028 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
14029 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
14030 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
14031 system does all the symbol handling.
14032
14033 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
14034 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
14035 syntax is:
14036
14037 @smallexample
14038 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
14039 @end smallexample
14040
14041 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
14042 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
14043 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
14044 @file{/dev/com1}:
14045
14046 @smallexample
14047 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
14048 @end smallexample
14049
14050 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
14051 with it.
14052
14053 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
14054
14055 @smallexample
14056 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
14057 @end smallexample
14058
14059 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
14060 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
14061 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
14062 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
14063 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
14064 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
14065 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
14066 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
14067 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
14068 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
14069 @code{target remote} command.
14070
14071 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
14072
14073 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
14074 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
14075
14076 @smallexample
14077 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
14078 @end smallexample
14079
14080 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
14081 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
14082
14083 @pindex pidof
14084 @cindex attach to a program by name
14085 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
14086 @code{pidof} utility:
14087
14088 @smallexample
14089 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
14090 @end smallexample
14091
14092 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
14093 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
14094 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
14095
14096 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
14097 @cindex gdbserver, multiple processes
14098 @cindex multiple processes with gdbserver
14099
14100 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
14101 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
14102 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
14103 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
14104
14105 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
14106 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
14107 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
14108 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
14109 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
14110 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
14111 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
14112 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
14113 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
14114
14115 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
14116 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
14117 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
14118 the program you want to debug.
14119
14120 @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit in multi-process mode.
14121 You can terminate it by using @code{monitor exit}
14122 (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
14123
14124 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
14125
14126 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
14127 status information about the debugging process. The
14128 @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
14129 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
14130 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
14131
14132 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
14133 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
14134 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
14135 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
14136
14137 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
14138 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
14139 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
14140 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
14141
14142 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
14143 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
14144 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
14145 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
14146
14147 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
14148 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
14149 environment:
14150
14151 @smallexample
14152 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
14153 @end smallexample
14154
14155 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
14156
14157 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
14158
14159 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
14160 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
14161 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
14162 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
14163
14164 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
14165 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
14166 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
14167 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
14168 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
14169 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
14170 programs.
14171
14172 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14173 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
14174 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
14175 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
14176 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
14177 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
14178 already on the target.
14179
14180 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
14181 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
14182 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
14183
14184 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
14185 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
14186 Here are the available commands.
14187
14188 @table @code
14189 @item monitor help
14190 List the available monitor commands.
14191
14192 @item monitor set debug 0
14193 @itemx monitor set debug 1
14194 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
14195
14196 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
14197 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
14198 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
14199 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
14200
14201 @item monitor exit
14202 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
14203 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
14204 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
14205 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
14206 of a multi-process mode debug session.
14207
14208 @end table
14209
14210 @node Remote Configuration
14211 @section Remote Configuration
14212
14213 @kindex set remote
14214 @kindex show remote
14215 This section documents the configuration options available when
14216 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
14217 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
14218 system-call-allowed}.
14219
14220 @table @code
14221 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
14222 @cindex address size for remote targets
14223 @cindex bits in remote address
14224 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
14225 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
14226 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
14227 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
14228
14229 @item show remoteaddresssize
14230 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
14231
14232 @item set remotebaud @var{n}
14233 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
14234 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
14235 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
14236 remote targets.
14237
14238 @item show remotebaud
14239 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
14240
14241 @item set remotebreak
14242 @cindex interrupt remote programs
14243 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
14244 @anchor{set remotebreak}
14245 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
14246 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
14247 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
14248 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
14249 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
14250
14251 @item show remotebreak
14252 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
14253 interrupt the remote program.
14254
14255 @item set remoteflow on
14256 @itemx set remoteflow off
14257 @kindex set remoteflow
14258 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
14259 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
14260
14261 @item show remoteflow
14262 @kindex show remoteflow
14263 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
14264
14265 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
14266 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
14267 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
14268 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
14269 @code{ascii}.
14270
14271 @item show remotelogbase
14272 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
14273 protocol.
14274
14275 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
14276 @cindex record serial communications on file
14277 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
14278 default is not to record at all.
14279
14280 @item show remotelogfile.
14281 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
14282 serial communications.
14283
14284 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
14285 @cindex timeout for serial communications
14286 @cindex remote timeout
14287 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
14288 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
14289
14290 @item show remotetimeout
14291 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
14292 responses.
14293
14294 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14295 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
14296 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
14297 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
14298 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
14299 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
14300 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
14301 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
14302
14303 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
14304 @itemx show remote exec-file
14305 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
14306 @cindex executable file, for remote target
14307 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
14308 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
14309 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
14310 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
14311
14312 @kindex set tcp
14313 @kindex show tcp
14314 @item set tcp auto-retry on
14315 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
14316 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
14317 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
14318 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
14319 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
14320 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
14321 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
14322 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
14323
14324 @item set tcp auto-retry off
14325 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
14326
14327 @item show tcp auto-retry
14328 Show the current auto-retry setting.
14329
14330 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
14331 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
14332 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
14333 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
14334 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
14335 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
14336 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
14337 value.
14338
14339 @item show tcp connect-timeout
14340 Show the current connection timeout setting.
14341 @end table
14342
14343 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
14344 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
14345 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
14346 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
14347 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
14348 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
14349 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
14350 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
14351 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
14352
14353 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
14354 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
14355 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
14356 @value{GDBN} developers.
14357
14358 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
14359 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
14360 are:
14361
14362 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
14363 @item Command Name
14364 @tab Remote Packet
14365 @tab Related Features
14366
14367 @item @code{fetch-register}
14368 @tab @code{p}
14369 @tab @code{info registers}
14370
14371 @item @code{set-register}
14372 @tab @code{P}
14373 @tab @code{set}
14374
14375 @item @code{binary-download}
14376 @tab @code{X}
14377 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
14378
14379 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
14380 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
14381 @tab @code{info auxv}
14382
14383 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
14384 @tab @code{qSymbol}
14385 @tab Detecting multiple threads
14386
14387 @item @code{attach}
14388 @tab @code{vAttach}
14389 @tab @code{attach}
14390
14391 @item @code{verbose-resume}
14392 @tab @code{vCont}
14393 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
14394
14395 @item @code{run}
14396 @tab @code{vRun}
14397 @tab @code{run}
14398
14399 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
14400 @tab @code{Z0}
14401 @tab @code{break}
14402
14403 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
14404 @tab @code{Z1}
14405 @tab @code{hbreak}
14406
14407 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
14408 @tab @code{Z2}
14409 @tab @code{watch}
14410
14411 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
14412 @tab @code{Z3}
14413 @tab @code{rwatch}
14414
14415 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
14416 @tab @code{Z4}
14417 @tab @code{awatch}
14418
14419 @item @code{target-features}
14420 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
14421 @tab @code{set architecture}
14422
14423 @item @code{library-info}
14424 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
14425 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
14426
14427 @item @code{memory-map}
14428 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
14429 @tab @code{info mem}
14430
14431 @item @code{read-spu-object}
14432 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
14433 @tab @code{info spu}
14434
14435 @item @code{write-spu-object}
14436 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
14437 @tab @code{info spu}
14438
14439 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
14440 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
14441 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
14442
14443 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
14444 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
14445 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
14446
14447 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
14448 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
14449 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
14450
14451 @item @code{search-memory}
14452 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
14453 @tab @code{find}
14454
14455 @item @code{supported-packets}
14456 @tab @code{qSupported}
14457 @tab Remote communications parameters
14458
14459 @item @code{pass-signals}
14460 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
14461 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
14462
14463 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
14464 @tab @code{vFile:close}
14465 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14466
14467 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
14468 @tab @code{vFile:open}
14469 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14470
14471 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
14472 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
14473 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14474
14475 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
14476 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
14477 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
14478
14479 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
14480 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
14481 @tab @code{remote delete}
14482
14483 @item @code{noack-packet}
14484 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
14485 @tab Packet acknowledgment
14486
14487 @item @code{osdata}
14488 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
14489 @tab @code{info os}
14490
14491 @item @code{query-attached}
14492 @tab @code{qAttached}
14493 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
14494 @end multitable
14495
14496 @node Remote Stub
14497 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
14498
14499 @cindex debugging stub, example
14500 @cindex remote stub, example
14501 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
14502 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
14503 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
14504 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
14505 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
14506 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
14507 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
14508 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
14509
14510 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
14511 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
14512 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
14513 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
14514 program, you need:
14515
14516 @enumerate
14517 @item
14518 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
14519 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
14520 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
14521
14522 @item
14523 A C subroutine library to support your program's
14524 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
14525
14526 @item
14527 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
14528 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
14529 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
14530 documentation.
14531 @end enumerate
14532
14533 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
14534 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
14535 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
14536
14537 @table @emph
14538 @item On the host,
14539 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
14540 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
14541 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
14542
14543 @item On the target,
14544 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
14545 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
14546 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
14547
14548 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
14549 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
14550 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
14551 @end table
14552
14553 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
14554 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
14555 @sc{sparc} boards.
14556
14557 @cindex remote serial stub list
14558 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
14559
14560 @table @code
14561
14562 @item i386-stub.c
14563 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
14564 @cindex Intel
14565 @cindex i386
14566 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
14567
14568 @item m68k-stub.c
14569 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
14570 @cindex Motorola 680x0
14571 @cindex m680x0
14572 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
14573
14574 @item sh-stub.c
14575 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
14576 @cindex Renesas
14577 @cindex SH
14578 For Renesas SH architectures.
14579
14580 @item sparc-stub.c
14581 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
14582 @cindex Sparc
14583 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
14584
14585 @item sparcl-stub.c
14586 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
14587 @cindex Fujitsu
14588 @cindex SparcLite
14589 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
14590
14591 @end table
14592
14593 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
14594 recently added stubs.
14595
14596 @menu
14597 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
14598 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
14599 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
14600 @end menu
14601
14602 @node Stub Contents
14603 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
14604
14605 @cindex remote serial stub
14606 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
14607 subroutines:
14608
14609 @table @code
14610 @item set_debug_traps
14611 @findex set_debug_traps
14612 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
14613 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
14614 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
14615 beginning of your program.
14616
14617 @item handle_exception
14618 @findex handle_exception
14619 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
14620 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
14621 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
14622 run when a trap is triggered.
14623
14624 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
14625 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
14626 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
14627 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
14628 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
14629 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
14630 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
14631 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
14632 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
14633 machine.
14634
14635 @item breakpoint
14636 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
14637 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
14638 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
14639 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
14640 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
14641 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
14642 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
14643 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
14644 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
14645 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
14646 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
14647
14648 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
14649 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
14650 start of your debugging session.
14651 @end table
14652
14653 @node Bootstrapping
14654 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
14655
14656 @cindex remote stub, support routines
14657 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
14658 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
14659 debugging target machine.
14660
14661 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
14662 serial port.
14663
14664 @table @code
14665 @item int getDebugChar()
14666 @findex getDebugChar
14667 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
14668 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
14669 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14670
14671 @item void putDebugChar(int)
14672 @findex putDebugChar
14673 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
14674 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
14675 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
14676 @end table
14677
14678 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
14679 @cindex interrupting remote targets
14680 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
14681 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
14682 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
14683 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
14684 remote system to stop.
14685
14686 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
14687 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
14688 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
14689 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
14690
14691 Other routines you need to supply are:
14692
14693 @table @code
14694 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
14695 @findex exceptionHandler
14696 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
14697 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
14698 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
14699 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
14700 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
14701 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
14702 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
14703 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
14704 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
14705 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
14706 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
14707 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
14708 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
14709
14710 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
14711 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
14712 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
14713 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
14714 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
14715
14716 @item void flush_i_cache()
14717 @findex flush_i_cache
14718 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
14719 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
14720 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
14721
14722 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
14723 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
14724 @end table
14725
14726 @noindent
14727 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
14728
14729 @table @code
14730 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
14731 @findex memset
14732 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
14733 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
14734 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
14735 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
14736 @end table
14737
14738 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
14739 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
14740 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
14741 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
14742
14743
14744 @node Debug Session
14745 @subsection Putting it All Together
14746
14747 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
14748 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
14749 steps.
14750
14751 @enumerate
14752 @item
14753 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
14754 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
14755 @display
14756 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
14757 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
14758 @end display
14759
14760 @item
14761 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
14762
14763 @smallexample
14764 set_debug_traps();
14765 breakpoint();
14766 @end smallexample
14767
14768 @item
14769 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
14770 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
14771
14772 @smallexample
14773 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
14774 @end smallexample
14775
14776 @noindent
14777 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
14778 function in your program, that function is called when
14779 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
14780 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
14781 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
14782
14783 @item
14784 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
14785 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
14786
14787 @item
14788 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
14789 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
14790
14791 @item
14792 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
14793 @c document that. FIXME.
14794 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
14795 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
14796
14797 @item
14798 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
14799 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
14800
14801 @end enumerate
14802
14803 @node Configurations
14804 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
14805
14806 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
14807 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
14808 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
14809
14810 There are three major categories of configurations: native
14811 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
14812 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
14813 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
14814 are quite different from each other.
14815
14816 @menu
14817 * Native::
14818 * Embedded OS::
14819 * Embedded Processors::
14820 * Architectures::
14821 @end menu
14822
14823 @node Native
14824 @section Native
14825
14826 This section describes details specific to particular native
14827 configurations.
14828
14829 @menu
14830 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
14831 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
14832 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
14833 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
14834 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
14835 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
14836 * Neutrino:: Features specific to QNX Neutrino
14837 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
14838 @end menu
14839
14840 @node HP-UX
14841 @subsection HP-UX
14842
14843 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
14844 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
14845 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
14846
14847
14848 @node BSD libkvm Interface
14849 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
14850
14851 @cindex libkvm
14852 @cindex kernel memory image
14853 @cindex kernel crash dump
14854
14855 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
14856 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
14857 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
14858 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
14859 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
14860 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
14861 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
14862 @code{kvm} target:
14863
14864 @smallexample
14865 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
14866 @end smallexample
14867
14868 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
14869 argument:
14870
14871 @smallexample
14872 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
14873 @end smallexample
14874
14875 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
14876 available:
14877
14878 @table @code
14879 @kindex kvm
14880 @item kvm pcb
14881 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
14882
14883 @item kvm proc
14884 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
14885 modern FreeBSD systems.
14886 @end table
14887
14888 @node SVR4 Process Information
14889 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
14890 @cindex /proc
14891 @cindex examine process image
14892 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
14893
14894 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
14895 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
14896 process using file-system subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured
14897 for an operating system with this facility, the command @code{info
14898 proc} is available to report information about the process running
14899 your program, or about any process running on your system. @code{info
14900 proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the @code{procfs} code.
14901 This includes, as of this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, OSF/1 (Digital
14902 Unix), Solaris, Irix, and Unixware, but not HP-UX, for example.
14903
14904 @table @code
14905 @kindex info proc
14906 @cindex process ID
14907 @item info proc
14908 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
14909 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
14910 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
14911 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
14912 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
14913 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
14914 executable file's absolute file name.
14915
14916 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
14917 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
14918 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
14919 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
14920 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
14921 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
14922
14923 @item info proc mappings
14924 @cindex memory address space mappings
14925 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
14926 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
14927 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
14928 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
14929 memory access rights to that range.
14930
14931 @item info proc stat
14932 @itemx info proc status
14933 @cindex process detailed status information
14934 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
14935 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
14936 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
14937 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
14938 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
14939 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
14940 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
14941
14942 @item info proc all
14943 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
14944 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
14945
14946 @ignore
14947 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
14948 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
14949 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
14950 @kindex info proc times
14951 @item info proc times
14952 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
14953 its children.
14954
14955 @kindex info proc id
14956 @item info proc id
14957 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
14958 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
14959 @end ignore
14960
14961 @item set procfs-trace
14962 @kindex set procfs-trace
14963 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
14964 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
14965
14966 @item show procfs-trace
14967 @kindex show procfs-trace
14968 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
14969
14970 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
14971 @kindex set procfs-file
14972 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
14973 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
14974 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
14975 standard output.
14976
14977 @item show procfs-file
14978 @kindex show procfs-file
14979 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
14980
14981 @item proc-trace-entry
14982 @itemx proc-trace-exit
14983 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
14984 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
14985 @kindex proc-trace-entry
14986 @kindex proc-trace-exit
14987 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
14988 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
14989 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
14990 from the @code{syscall} interface.
14991
14992 @item info pidlist
14993 @kindex info pidlist
14994 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
14995 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
14996 processes and all the threads within each process.
14997
14998 @item info meminfo
14999 @kindex info meminfo
15000 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
15001 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
15002 @end table
15003
15004 @node DJGPP Native
15005 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
15006 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
15007 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
15008 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
15009
15010 @cindex DPMI
15011 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
15012 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
15013 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
15014 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
15015
15016 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
15017 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
15018 subsection describes those commands.
15019
15020 @table @code
15021 @kindex info dos
15022 @item info dos
15023 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
15024 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15025
15026 @kindex sysinfo
15027 @cindex MS-DOS system info
15028 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
15029 @item info dos sysinfo
15030 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
15031 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
15032 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
15033
15034 @cindex GDT
15035 @cindex LDT
15036 @cindex IDT
15037 @cindex segment descriptor tables
15038 @cindex descriptor tables display
15039 @item info dos gdt
15040 @itemx info dos ldt
15041 @itemx info dos idt
15042 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
15043 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
15044 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
15045 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
15046 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
15047 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
15048 rights.
15049
15050 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
15051 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
15052 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
15053 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
15054 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
15055
15056 @cindex garbled pointers
15057 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
15058 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
15059 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
15060 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
15061 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
15062 debugged program's data segment:
15063
15064 @smallexample
15065 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
15066 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
15067 @end smallexample
15068
15069 @noindent
15070 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
15071 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
15072
15073 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
15074 @item info dos pde
15075 @itemx info dos pte
15076 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
15077 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
15078 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
15079 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
15080 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
15081 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
15082 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
15083 that is currently in use.
15084
15085 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
15086 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
15087 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
15088 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
15089 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
15090 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
15091 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
15092
15093 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
15094 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
15095 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
15096 controller.
15097
15098 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
15099
15100 @cindex physical address from linear address
15101 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
15102 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
15103 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
15104 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
15105 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
15106 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
15107 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
15108
15109 @smallexample
15110 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
15111 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
15112 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
15113 @end smallexample
15114
15115 @noindent
15116 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
15117 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
15118 attributes of that page.
15119
15120 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
15121 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
15122 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
15123 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
15124 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
15125 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
15126
15127 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
15128 transfer buffer:
15129
15130 @smallexample
15131 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
15132 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
15133 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
15134 @end smallexample
15135
15136 @noindent
15137 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
15138 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
15139 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
15140 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
15141 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
15142
15143 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
15144 @end table
15145
15146 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
15147 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
15148 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
15149 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
15150
15151 @table @code
15152 @kindex set com1base
15153 @kindex set com1irq
15154 @kindex set com2base
15155 @kindex set com2irq
15156 @kindex set com3base
15157 @kindex set com3irq
15158 @kindex set com4base
15159 @kindex set com4irq
15160 @item set com1base @var{addr}
15161 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
15162 port.
15163
15164 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
15165 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
15166 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
15167
15168 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
15169 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
15170 other 3 COM ports.
15171
15172 @kindex show com1base
15173 @kindex show com1irq
15174 @kindex show com2base
15175 @kindex show com2irq
15176 @kindex show com3base
15177 @kindex show com3irq
15178 @kindex show com4base
15179 @kindex show com4irq
15180 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
15181 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
15182 lines used by the COM ports.
15183
15184 @item info serial
15185 @kindex info serial
15186 @cindex DOS serial port status
15187 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
15188 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
15189 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
15190 counts of various errors encountered so far.
15191 @end table
15192
15193
15194 @node Cygwin Native
15195 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
15196 @cindex MS Windows debugging
15197 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
15198 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
15199
15200 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
15201 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
15202 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this section.
15203 Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is described in
15204 @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
15205
15206 @table @code
15207 @kindex info w32
15208 @item info w32
15209 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
15210 information about the target system and important OS structures.
15211
15212 @item info w32 selector
15213 This command displays information returned by
15214 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
15215 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
15216 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
15217 Without argument, this command displays information
15218 about the six segment registers.
15219
15220 @kindex info dll
15221 @item info dll
15222 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
15223
15224 @kindex dll-symbols
15225 @item dll-symbols
15226 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
15227 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
15228
15229 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
15230 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
15231 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
15232 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
15233 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
15234 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
15235 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
15236 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
15237 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
15238 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
15239 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
15240
15241 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
15242 @item show cygwin-exceptions
15243 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
15244 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
15245
15246 @kindex set new-console
15247 @item set new-console @var{mode}
15248 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
15249 be started in a new console on next start.
15250 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
15251 be started in the same console as the debugger.
15252
15253 @kindex show new-console
15254 @item show new-console
15255 Displays whether a new console is used
15256 when the debuggee is started.
15257
15258 @kindex set new-group
15259 @item set new-group @var{mode}
15260 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
15261 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
15262 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
15263 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
15264
15265 @kindex show new-group
15266 @item show new-group
15267 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
15268
15269 @kindex set debugevents
15270 @item set debugevents
15271 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
15272 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
15273 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
15274 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
15275 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
15276
15277 @kindex set debugexec
15278 @item set debugexec
15279 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
15280 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
15281
15282 @kindex set debugexceptions
15283 @item set debugexceptions
15284 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
15285 debuggee seen by the debugger.
15286
15287 @kindex set debugmemory
15288 @item set debugmemory
15289 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
15290 and writes by the debugger.
15291
15292 @kindex set shell
15293 @item set shell
15294 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
15295 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
15296
15297 @kindex show shell
15298 @item show shell
15299 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
15300
15301 @end table
15302
15303 @menu
15304 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
15305 @end menu
15306
15307 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
15308 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
15309 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
15310 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
15311
15312 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
15313 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
15314 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
15315 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
15316 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
15317 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
15318 ``minimal symbols''.
15319
15320 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
15321 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
15322 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
15323 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
15324 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
15325 see the shared library information in @ref{Files}, or the
15326 @code{dll-symbols} command in @ref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
15327 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
15328 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
15329 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
15330
15331 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
15332
15333 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
15334 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
15335 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
15336 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
15337 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
15338 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
15339 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
15340 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
15341 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
15342
15343 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
15344 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
15345 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
15346 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
15347 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
15348 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
15349
15350 @smallexample
15351 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
15352 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
15353
15354 Non-debugging symbols:
15355 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
15356 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
15357 @end smallexample
15358
15359 @smallexample
15360 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
15361 All functions matching regular expression "!":
15362
15363 Non-debugging symbols:
15364 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
15365 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
15366 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
15367 [etc...]
15368 @end smallexample
15369
15370 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
15371
15372 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
15373 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
15374 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
15375 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
15376 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
15377 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
15378 a function within a DLL without a running program.
15379
15380 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
15381 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
15382 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
15383 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
15384 problem:
15385
15386 @smallexample
15387 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
15388 $1 = 268572168
15389 @end smallexample
15390
15391 @smallexample
15392 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
15393 0x10021610: "\230y\""
15394 @end smallexample
15395
15396 And two possible solutions:
15397
15398 @smallexample
15399 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
15400 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15401 @end smallexample
15402
15403 @smallexample
15404 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
15405 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
15406 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
15407 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
15408 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
15409 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
15410 @end smallexample
15411
15412 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
15413 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
15414 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
15415 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
15416 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
15417
15418 @smallexample
15419 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
15420 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
15421 @end smallexample
15422
15423 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
15424 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
15425 safe.
15426
15427 @node Hurd Native
15428 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
15429 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
15430
15431 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
15432 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
15433
15434 @table @code
15435 @item set signals
15436 @itemx set sigs
15437 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
15438 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15439 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
15440 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
15441 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
15442 @code{signals}.
15443
15444 @item show signals
15445 @itemx show sigs
15446 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
15447 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
15448 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
15449
15450 @item set signal-thread
15451 @itemx set sigthread
15452 @kindex set signal-thread
15453 @kindex set sigthread
15454 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
15455 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
15456 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
15457 signal-thread}.
15458
15459 @item show signal-thread
15460 @itemx show sigthread
15461 @kindex show signal-thread
15462 @kindex show sigthread
15463 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
15464 delivered a signal.
15465
15466 @item set stopped
15467 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15468 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
15469 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
15470 continued by delivering a signal to it.
15471
15472 @item show stopped
15473 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
15474 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
15475 stopped.
15476
15477 @item set exceptions
15478 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15479 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
15480 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
15481 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
15482 trapping on.
15483
15484 @item show exceptions
15485 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
15486 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
15487
15488 @item set task pause
15489 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
15490 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15491 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15492 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
15493 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
15494 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
15495 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
15496 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
15497 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
15498
15499 @item show task pause
15500 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
15501 Show the current state of task suspension.
15502
15503 @item set task detach-suspend-count
15504 @cindex task suspend count
15505 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15506 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
15507 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
15508
15509 @item show task detach-suspend-count
15510 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
15511
15512 @item set task exception-port
15513 @itemx set task excp
15514 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15515 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
15516 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
15517 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
15518
15519 @item set noninvasive
15520 @cindex noninvasive task options
15521 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
15522 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
15523 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
15524 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
15525
15526 @item info send-rights
15527 @itemx info receive-rights
15528 @itemx info port-rights
15529 @itemx info port-sets
15530 @itemx info dead-names
15531 @itemx info ports
15532 @itemx info psets
15533 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15534 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15535 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15536 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15537 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15538 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
15539 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
15540 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
15541 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
15542
15543 @item set thread pause
15544 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
15545 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15546 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
15547 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
15548 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
15549 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
15550 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
15551 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
15552 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
15553 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
15554 only the current thread.
15555
15556 @item show thread pause
15557 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
15558 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
15559
15560 @item set thread run
15561 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15562
15563 @item show thread run
15564 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
15565
15566 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
15567 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15568 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15569 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
15570 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
15571 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
15572 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
15573
15574 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
15575 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
15576 detaching.
15577
15578 @item set thread exception-port
15579 @itemx set thread excp
15580 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
15581 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
15582 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
15583
15584 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
15585 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
15586 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
15587 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
15588
15589 @item set thread default
15590 @itemx show thread default
15591 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
15592 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
15593 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
15594 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
15595 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
15596 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
15597 the non-default commands.
15598 @end table
15599
15600
15601 @node Neutrino
15602 @subsection QNX Neutrino
15603 @cindex QNX Neutrino
15604
15605 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the QNX
15606 Neutrino target:
15607
15608 @table @code
15609 @item set debug nto-debug
15610 @kindex set debug nto-debug
15611 When set to on, enables debugging messages specific to the QNX
15612 Neutrino support.
15613
15614 @item show debug nto-debug
15615 @kindex show debug nto-debug
15616 Show the current state of QNX Neutrino messages.
15617 @end table
15618
15619 @node Darwin
15620 @subsection Darwin
15621 @cindex Darwin
15622
15623 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
15624
15625 @table @code
15626 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
15627 @kindex set debug darwin
15628 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
15629 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
15630
15631 @item show debug darwin
15632 @kindex show debug darwin
15633 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
15634
15635 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
15636 @kindex set debug mach-o
15637 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
15638 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
15639 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
15640 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
15641 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
15642 usage.
15643
15644 @item show debug mach-o
15645 @kindex show debug mach-o
15646 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
15647
15648 @item set mach-exceptions on
15649 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
15650 @kindex set mach-exceptions
15651 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
15652 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
15653 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
15654 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
15655
15656 @item show mach-exceptions
15657 @kindex show mach-exceptions
15658 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
15659 @end table
15660
15661
15662 @node Embedded OS
15663 @section Embedded Operating Systems
15664
15665 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
15666 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
15667 architectures.
15668
15669 @menu
15670 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15671 @end menu
15672
15673 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
15674 various real-time operating systems.
15675
15676 @node VxWorks
15677 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
15678
15679 @cindex VxWorks
15680
15681 @table @code
15682
15683 @kindex target vxworks
15684 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
15685 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
15686 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
15687
15688 @end table
15689
15690 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
15691 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
15692
15693 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
15694 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
15695 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
15696 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
15697 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
15698 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
15699 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
15700
15701 @table @code
15702 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
15703 @kindex vxworks-timeout
15704 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
15705 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
15706 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
15707 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
15708 of a thin network line.
15709 @end table
15710
15711 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
15712 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
15713 procedures.
15714
15715 @findex INCLUDE_RDB
15716 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
15717 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
15718 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
15719 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
15720 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
15721 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
15722 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
15723 manual.
15724 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
15725
15726 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
15727 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
15728 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
15729 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
15730
15731 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
15732
15733 @smallexample
15734 (vxgdb)
15735 @end smallexample
15736
15737 @menu
15738 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
15739 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
15740 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
15741 @end menu
15742
15743 @node VxWorks Connection
15744 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
15745
15746 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
15747 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
15748
15749 @smallexample
15750 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
15751 @end smallexample
15752
15753 @need 750
15754 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
15755
15756 @smallexample
15757 Attaching remote machine across net...
15758 Connected to tt.
15759 @end smallexample
15760
15761 @need 1000
15762 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
15763 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
15764 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
15765 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}); if it fails
15766 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
15767
15768 @smallexample
15769 prog.o: No such file or directory.
15770 @end smallexample
15771
15772 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
15773 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
15774 command again.
15775
15776 @node VxWorks Download
15777 @subsubsection VxWorks Download
15778
15779 @cindex download to VxWorks
15780 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
15781 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
15782 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
15783 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
15784 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
15785 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
15786 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
15787 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
15788 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
15789 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
15790 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
15791 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
15792 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
15793 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
15794 program, type this on VxWorks:
15795
15796 @smallexample
15797 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
15798 @end smallexample
15799
15800 @noindent
15801 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
15802
15803 @smallexample
15804 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
15805 (vxgdb) load prog.o
15806 @end smallexample
15807
15808 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
15809
15810 @smallexample
15811 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
15812 @end smallexample
15813
15814 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
15815 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
15816 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
15817 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
15818 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
15819 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
15820 table.)
15821
15822 @node VxWorks Attach
15823 @subsubsection Running Tasks
15824
15825 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
15826 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
15827 follows:
15828
15829 @smallexample
15830 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
15831 @end smallexample
15832
15833 @noindent
15834 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
15835 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
15836 the time of attachment.
15837
15838 @node Embedded Processors
15839 @section Embedded Processors
15840
15841 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
15842 configurations.
15843
15844 @cindex send command to simulator
15845 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
15846 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
15847
15848 @table @code
15849 @item sim @var{command}
15850 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
15851 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
15852 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
15853 acceptable commands.
15854 @end table
15855
15856
15857 @menu
15858 * ARM:: ARM RDI
15859 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
15860 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
15861 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
15862 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
15863 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
15864 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
15865 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
15866 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
15867 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
15868 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
15869 * CRIS:: CRIS
15870 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
15871 @end menu
15872
15873 @node ARM
15874 @subsection ARM
15875 @cindex ARM RDI
15876
15877 @table @code
15878 @kindex target rdi
15879 @item target rdi @var{dev}
15880 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
15881 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
15882 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
15883
15884 @kindex target rdp
15885 @item target rdp @var{dev}
15886 ARM Demon monitor.
15887
15888 @end table
15889
15890 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
15891
15892 @table @code
15893 @item set arm disassembler
15894 @kindex set arm
15895 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
15896 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
15897
15898 @item show arm disassembler
15899 @kindex show arm
15900 Show the current disassembly style.
15901
15902 @item set arm apcs32
15903 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
15904 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
15905
15906 @item show arm apcs32
15907 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
15908
15909 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
15910 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
15911 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
15912
15913 @table @code
15914 @item auto
15915 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
15916 @item softfpa
15917 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
15918 processors.
15919 @item fpa
15920 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
15921 @item softvfp
15922 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
15923 @item vfp
15924 VFP co-processor.
15925 @end table
15926
15927 @item show arm fpu
15928 Show the current type of the FPU.
15929
15930 @item set arm abi
15931 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
15932
15933 @item show arm abi
15934 Show the currently used ABI.
15935
15936 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15937 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
15938 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
15939 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
15940 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
15941 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
15942 register).
15943
15944 @item show arm fallback-mode
15945 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
15946
15947 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
15948 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
15949 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
15950 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
15951 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
15952
15953 @item show arm force-mode
15954 Show the current forced instruction mode.
15955
15956 @item set debug arm
15957 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
15958 target support subsystem.
15959
15960 @item show debug arm
15961 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
15962 @end table
15963
15964 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
15965 using the RDI interface:
15966
15967 @table @code
15968 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
15969 @kindex rdilogfile
15970 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
15971 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
15972 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
15973 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
15974 @file{rdi.log}.
15975
15976 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
15977 @kindex rdilogenable
15978 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
15979 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
15980 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
15981 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
15982 are logged to a file.
15983
15984 @item set rdiromatzero
15985 @kindex set rdiromatzero
15986 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
15987 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
15988 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
15989 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
15990 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
15991
15992 @item show rdiromatzero
15993 @kindex show rdiromatzero
15994 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
15995
15996 @item set rdiheartbeat
15997 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
15998 @cindex RDI heartbeat
15999 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
16000 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
16001 well as the Angel monitor.
16002
16003 @item show rdiheartbeat
16004 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
16005 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
16006 @end table
16007
16008
16009 @node M32R/D
16010 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
16011
16012 @table @code
16013 @kindex target m32r
16014 @item target m32r @var{dev}
16015 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
16016
16017 @kindex target m32rsdi
16018 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
16019 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
16020 @end table
16021
16022 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
16023
16024 @table @code
16025 @item set download-path @var{path}
16026 @kindex set download-path
16027 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
16028 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16029
16030 @item show download-path
16031 @kindex show download-path
16032 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
16033
16034 @item set board-address @var{addr}
16035 @kindex set board-address
16036 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
16037 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
16038
16039 @item show board-address
16040 @kindex show board-address
16041 Show the current IP address of the target board.
16042
16043 @item set server-address @var{addr}
16044 @kindex set server-address
16045 @cindex download server address (M32R)
16046 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
16047 host machine.
16048
16049 @item show server-address
16050 @kindex show server-address
16051 Display the IP address of the download server.
16052
16053 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16054 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
16055 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
16056 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
16057 executable file is uploaded.
16058
16059 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
16060 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
16061 Test the @code{upload} command.
16062 @end table
16063
16064 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
16065
16066 @table @code
16067 @item sdireset
16068 @kindex sdireset
16069 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
16070 This command resets the SDI connection.
16071
16072 @item sdistatus
16073 @kindex sdistatus
16074 This command shows the SDI connection status.
16075
16076 @item debug_chaos
16077 @kindex debug_chaos
16078 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
16079 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
16080
16081 @item use_debug_dma
16082 @kindex use_debug_dma
16083 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
16084
16085 @item use_mon_code
16086 @kindex use_mon_code
16087 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
16088
16089 @item use_ib_break
16090 @kindex use_ib_break
16091 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
16092
16093 @item use_dbt_break
16094 @kindex use_dbt_break
16095 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
16096 @end table
16097
16098 @node M68K
16099 @subsection M68k
16100
16101 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
16102 target command for the following ROM monitor.
16103
16104 @table @code
16105
16106 @kindex target dbug
16107 @item target dbug @var{dev}
16108 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
16109
16110 @end table
16111
16112 @node MIPS Embedded
16113 @subsection MIPS Embedded
16114
16115 @cindex MIPS boards
16116 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
16117 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
16118 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
16119
16120 @need 1000
16121 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
16122
16123 @table @code
16124 @item target mips @var{port}
16125 @kindex target mips @var{port}
16126 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
16127 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
16128 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
16129 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
16130 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
16131 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
16132
16133 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
16134 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
16135 debugger:
16136
16137 @smallexample
16138 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
16139 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
16140 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
16141 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
16142 (@value{GDBP}) run
16143 @end smallexample
16144
16145 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
16146 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
16147 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
16148 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
16149 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
16150
16151 @item target pmon @var{port}
16152 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
16153 PMON ROM monitor.
16154
16155 @item target ddb @var{port}
16156 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
16157 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
16158
16159 @item target lsi @var{port}
16160 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
16161 LSI variant of PMON.
16162
16163 @kindex target r3900
16164 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
16165 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
16166
16167 @kindex target array
16168 @item target array @var{dev}
16169 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
16170
16171 @end table
16172
16173
16174 @noindent
16175 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
16176
16177 @table @code
16178 @item set mipsfpu double
16179 @itemx set mipsfpu single
16180 @itemx set mipsfpu none
16181 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
16182 @itemx show mipsfpu
16183 @kindex set mipsfpu
16184 @kindex show mipsfpu
16185 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
16186 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
16187 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
16188 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
16189 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
16190 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
16191 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
16192 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
16193 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
16194 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
16195 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
16196 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
16197 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
16198
16199 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
16200 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
16201 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
16202
16203 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
16204 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
16205
16206 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
16207 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
16208 @itemx show timeout
16209 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
16210 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
16211 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
16212 @kindex set timeout
16213 @kindex show timeout
16214 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
16215 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
16216 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
16217 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
16218 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
16219 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
16220 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
16221 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
16222 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
16223 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
16224
16225 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
16226 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
16227 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
16228 to run before stopping.
16229
16230 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
16231 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16232 @cindex synchronize with remote MIPS target
16233 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
16234 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
16235 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
16236
16237 @item show syn-garbage-limit
16238 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, MIPS remote}
16239 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
16240 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
16241
16242 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
16243 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16244 @cindex remote monitor prompt
16245 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
16246 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
16247 @table @asis
16248 @item pmon target
16249 @samp{PMON}
16250 @item ddb target
16251 @samp{NEC010}
16252 @item lsi target
16253 @samp{PMON>}
16254 @end table
16255
16256 @item show monitor-prompt
16257 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, MIPS remote}
16258 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
16259 remote monitor.
16260
16261 @item set monitor-warnings
16262 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16263 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
16264 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
16265 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
16266 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
16267
16268 @item show monitor-warnings
16269 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, MIPS remote}
16270 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
16271
16272 @item pmon @var{command}
16273 @kindex pmon@r{, MIPS remote}
16274 @cindex send PMON command
16275 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
16276 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
16277 @end table
16278
16279 @node OpenRISC 1000
16280 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
16281 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
16282
16283 @cindex or1k boards
16284 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
16285 about platform and commands.
16286
16287 @table @code
16288
16289 @kindex target jtag
16290 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
16291
16292 Connects to remote JTAG server.
16293 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
16294 connected via parallel port to the board.
16295
16296 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
16297
16298 @kindex or1ksim
16299 @item or1ksim @var{command}
16300 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
16301 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
16302
16303 @kindex info or1k spr
16304 @item info or1k spr
16305 Displays spr groups.
16306
16307 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
16308 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
16309 Displays register names in selected group.
16310
16311 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
16312 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
16313 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
16314 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
16315 Shows information about specified spr register.
16316
16317 @kindex spr
16318 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
16319 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
16320 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
16321 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
16322 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
16323 @end table
16324
16325 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
16326 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
16327 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
16328 triggers can be set using:
16329 @table @code
16330 @item $LEA/$LDATA
16331 Load effective address/data
16332 @item $SEA/$SDATA
16333 Store effective address/data
16334 @item $AEA/$ADATA
16335 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
16336 @item $FETCH
16337 Fetch data
16338 @end table
16339
16340 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
16341 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
16342
16343 @code{htrace} commands:
16344 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
16345 @table @code
16346 @kindex hwatch
16347 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
16348 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effective Address(es)
16349 or Data. For example:
16350
16351 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16352
16353 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
16354
16355 @kindex htrace
16356 @item htrace info
16357 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
16358
16359 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
16360 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
16361
16362 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
16363 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
16364
16365 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
16366 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
16367
16368 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
16369 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
16370 triggered.
16371
16372 @item htrace enable
16373 @itemx htrace disable
16374 Enables/disables the HW trace.
16375
16376 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
16377 Clears currently recorded trace data.
16378
16379 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
16380 will be written there.
16381
16382 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
16383 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
16384
16385 @item htrace mode continuous
16386 Set continuous trace mode.
16387
16388 @item htrace mode suspend
16389 Set suspend trace mode.
16390
16391 @end table
16392
16393 @node PowerPC Embedded
16394 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
16395
16396 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
16397
16398 @table @code
16399 @kindex set powerpc
16400 @item set powerpc soft-float
16401 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
16402 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
16403 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
16404 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16405
16406 @item set powerpc vector-abi
16407 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
16408 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
16409 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
16410 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
16411 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
16412 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
16413 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
16414
16415 @kindex target dink32
16416 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
16417 DINK32 ROM monitor.
16418
16419 @kindex target ppcbug
16420 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
16421 @kindex target ppcbug1
16422 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
16423 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
16424
16425 @kindex target sds
16426 @item target sds @var{dev}
16427 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
16428 @end table
16429
16430 @cindex SDS protocol
16431 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
16432 by @value{GDBN}:
16433
16434 @table @code
16435 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
16436 @kindex set sdstimeout
16437 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
16438 default is 2 seconds.
16439
16440 @item show sdstimeout
16441 @kindex show sdstimeout
16442 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
16443
16444 @item sds @var{command}
16445 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
16446 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
16447 @end table
16448
16449
16450 @node PA
16451 @subsection HP PA Embedded
16452
16453 @table @code
16454
16455 @kindex target op50n
16456 @item target op50n @var{dev}
16457 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
16458
16459 @kindex target w89k
16460 @item target w89k @var{dev}
16461 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
16462
16463 @end table
16464
16465 @node Sparclet
16466 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
16467
16468 @cindex Sparclet
16469
16470 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
16471 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
16472 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
16473 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
16474 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
16475
16476 @table @code
16477 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
16478 @kindex remotetimeout
16479 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
16480 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
16481 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
16482 @end table
16483
16484 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
16485 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
16486 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
16487 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
16488 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
16489
16490 @smallexample
16491 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
16495
16496 @smallexample
16497 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
16498 @end smallexample
16499
16500 @cindex running, on Sparclet
16501 Once you have set
16502 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
16503 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
16504 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
16505
16506 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
16507
16508 @smallexample
16509 (gdbslet)
16510 @end smallexample
16511
16512 @menu
16513 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
16514 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
16515 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
16516 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
16517 @end menu
16518
16519 @node Sparclet File
16520 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
16521
16522 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
16523
16524 @smallexample
16525 (gdbslet) file prog
16526 @end smallexample
16527
16528 @need 1000
16529 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
16530 @value{GDBN} locates
16531 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
16532 path.
16533 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
16534 files will be searched as well.
16535 @value{GDBN} locates
16536 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
16537 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
16538 If it fails
16539 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
16540
16541 @smallexample
16542 prog: No such file or directory.
16543 @end smallexample
16544
16545 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
16546 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
16547 @code{target} command again.
16548
16549 @node Sparclet Connection
16550 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
16551
16552 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
16553 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
16554
16555 @smallexample
16556 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
16557 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
16558 main () at ../prog.c:3
16559 @end smallexample
16560
16561 @need 750
16562 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
16563
16564 @smallexample
16565 Connected to ttya.
16566 @end smallexample
16567
16568 @node Sparclet Download
16569 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
16570
16571 @cindex download to Sparclet
16572 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
16573 you can use the @value{GDBN}
16574 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
16575 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
16576 command.
16577 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
16578 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
16579 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
16580 of each of the file's sections.
16581 For instance, if the program
16582 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
16583 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
16584
16585 @smallexample
16586 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
16587 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
16591 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
16592 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
16593
16594 @node Sparclet Execution
16595 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
16596
16597 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
16598 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
16599 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
16600 manual for the list of commands.
16601
16602 @smallexample
16603 (gdbslet) b main
16604 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
16605 (gdbslet) run
16606 Starting program: prog
16607 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
16608 3 char *symarg = 0;
16609 (gdbslet) step
16610 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
16611 (gdbslet)
16612 @end smallexample
16613
16614 @node Sparclite
16615 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
16616
16617 @table @code
16618
16619 @kindex target sparclite
16620 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
16621 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
16622 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
16623 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
16624 remote protocol.
16625
16626 @end table
16627
16628 @node Z8000
16629 @subsection Zilog Z8000
16630
16631 @cindex Z8000
16632 @cindex simulator, Z8000
16633 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
16634
16635 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
16636 a Z8000 simulator.
16637
16638 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
16639 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
16640 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
16641 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
16642
16643 @table @code
16644 @item target sim @var{args}
16645 @kindex sim
16646 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
16647 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
16648 options, specify them via @var{args}.
16649 @end table
16650
16651 @noindent
16652 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
16653 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
16654 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
16655 to run your program, and so on.
16656
16657 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
16658 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
16659 additional items of information as specially named registers:
16660
16661 @table @code
16662
16663 @item cycles
16664 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
16665
16666 @item insts
16667 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
16668
16669 @item time
16670 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
16671
16672 @end table
16673
16674 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
16675 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
16676 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
16677 simulated clock ticks.
16678
16679 @node AVR
16680 @subsection Atmel AVR
16681 @cindex AVR
16682
16683 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
16684 following AVR-specific commands:
16685
16686 @table @code
16687 @item info io_registers
16688 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
16689 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
16690 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
16691 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
16692 @end table
16693
16694 @node CRIS
16695 @subsection CRIS
16696 @cindex CRIS
16697
16698 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
16699 following CRIS-specific commands:
16700
16701 @table @code
16702 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
16703 @cindex CRIS version
16704 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
16705 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
16706 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
16707
16708 @item show cris-version
16709 Show the current CRIS version.
16710
16711 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
16712 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
16713 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
16714 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
16715 @code{R59}.
16716
16717 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
16718 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
16719
16720 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
16721 @cindex CRIS mode
16722 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
16723 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
16724 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
16725
16726 @item show cris-mode
16727 Show the current CRIS mode.
16728 @end table
16729
16730 @node Super-H
16731 @subsection Renesas Super-H
16732 @cindex Super-H
16733
16734 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
16735 commands:
16736
16737 @table @code
16738 @item regs
16739 @kindex regs@r{, Super-H}
16740 Show the values of all Super-H registers.
16741
16742 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
16743 @kindex set sh calling-convention
16744 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
16745 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
16746 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
16747 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
16748 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
16749 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
16750 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
16751 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
16752 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
16753 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
16754
16755 @item show sh calling-convention
16756 @kindex show sh calling-convention
16757 Show the current calling convention setting.
16758
16759 @end table
16760
16761
16762 @node Architectures
16763 @section Architectures
16764
16765 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
16766 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
16767
16768 @menu
16769 * i386::
16770 * A29K::
16771 * Alpha::
16772 * MIPS::
16773 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
16774 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16775 * PowerPC::
16776 @end menu
16777
16778 @node i386
16779 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
16780
16781 @table @code
16782 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
16783 @kindex set struct-convention
16784 @cindex struct return convention
16785 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
16786 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
16787 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
16788 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
16789 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
16790 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
16791 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
16792 be returned in a register.
16793
16794 @item show struct-convention
16795 @kindex show struct-convention
16796 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
16797 from functions.
16798 @end table
16799
16800 @node A29K
16801 @subsection A29K
16802
16803 @table @code
16804
16805 @kindex set rstack_high_address
16806 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
16807 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
16808 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
16809 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
16810 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
16811 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
16812 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
16813 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
16814 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
16815 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
16816 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
16817 hexadecimal.
16818
16819 @kindex show rstack_high_address
16820 @item show rstack_high_address
16821 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
16822 processors.
16823
16824 @end table
16825
16826 @node Alpha
16827 @subsection Alpha
16828
16829 See the following section.
16830
16831 @node MIPS
16832 @subsection MIPS
16833
16834 @cindex stack on Alpha
16835 @cindex stack on MIPS
16836 @cindex Alpha stack
16837 @cindex MIPS stack
16838 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
16839 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
16840 find the beginning of a function.
16841
16842 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
16843 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
16844 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
16845 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
16846 commands:
16847
16848 @table @code
16849 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
16850 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
16851 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
16852 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
16853 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
16854 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
16855 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
16856 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
16857
16858 @item show heuristic-fence-post
16859 Display the current limit.
16860 @end table
16861
16862 @noindent
16863 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
16864 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
16865
16866 Several MIPS-specific commands are available when debugging MIPS
16867 programs:
16868
16869 @table @code
16870 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
16871 @kindex set mips abi
16872 @cindex set ABI for MIPS
16873 Tell @value{GDBN} which MIPS ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
16874 values of @var{arg} are:
16875
16876 @table @samp
16877 @item auto
16878 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
16879 default).
16880 @item o32
16881 @item o64
16882 @item n32
16883 @item n64
16884 @item eabi32
16885 @item eabi64
16886 @item auto
16887 @end table
16888
16889 @item show mips abi
16890 @kindex show mips abi
16891 Show the MIPS ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
16892
16893 @item set mipsfpu
16894 @itemx show mipsfpu
16895 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
16896
16897 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
16898 @kindex set mips mask-address
16899 @cindex MIPS addresses, masking
16900 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
16901 MIPS addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
16902 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
16903 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
16904
16905 @item show mips mask-address
16906 @kindex show mips mask-address
16907 Show whether the upper 32 bits of MIPS addresses are masked off or
16908 not.
16909
16910 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16911 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16912 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit MIPS targets that
16913 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old MIPS 64 target
16914 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
16915 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
16916
16917 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16918 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
16919 Show the current setting of compatibility with older MIPS 64 targets.
16920
16921 @item set debug mips
16922 @kindex set debug mips
16923 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the MIPS-specific
16924 target code in @value{GDBN}.
16925
16926 @item show debug mips
16927 @kindex show debug mips
16928 Show the current setting of MIPS debugging messages.
16929 @end table
16930
16931
16932 @node HPPA
16933 @subsection HPPA
16934 @cindex HPPA support
16935
16936 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
16937 following special commands:
16938
16939 @table @code
16940 @item set debug hppa
16941 @kindex set debug hppa
16942 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
16943 messages are to be displayed.
16944
16945 @item show debug hppa
16946 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
16947
16948 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
16949 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
16950 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
16951 given @var{address}.
16952
16953 @end table
16954
16955
16956 @node SPU
16957 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
16958 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
16959 @cindex SPU
16960
16961 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
16962 it provides the following special commands:
16963
16964 @table @code
16965 @item info spu event
16966 @kindex info spu
16967 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
16968 and pending event status.
16969
16970 @item info spu signal
16971 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
16972 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
16973 notification channels.
16974
16975 @item info spu mailbox
16976 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
16977 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
16978 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
16979
16980 @item info spu dma
16981 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16982 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16983 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16984
16985 @item info spu proxydma
16986 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
16987 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
16988 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
16989
16990 @end table
16991
16992 @node PowerPC
16993 @subsection PowerPC
16994 @cindex PowerPC architecture
16995
16996 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
16997 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
16998 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
16999 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
17000 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
17001
17002 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
17003 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
17004 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
17005
17006 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
17007 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
17008
17009
17010 @node Controlling GDB
17011 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
17012
17013 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
17014 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
17015 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
17016 described here.
17017
17018 @menu
17019 * Prompt:: Prompt
17020 * Editing:: Command editing
17021 * Command History:: Command history
17022 * Screen Size:: Screen size
17023 * Numbers:: Numbers
17024 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
17025 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
17026 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
17027 @end menu
17028
17029 @node Prompt
17030 @section Prompt
17031
17032 @cindex prompt
17033
17034 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
17035 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
17036 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
17037 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
17038 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
17039 which one you are talking to.
17040
17041 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
17042 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
17043 or a prompt that does not.
17044
17045 @table @code
17046 @kindex set prompt
17047 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
17048 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
17049
17050 @kindex show prompt
17051 @item show prompt
17052 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
17053 @end table
17054
17055 @node Editing
17056 @section Command Editing
17057 @cindex readline
17058 @cindex command line editing
17059
17060 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
17061 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
17062 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
17063 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
17064 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
17065 debugging sessions.
17066
17067 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
17068 command @code{set}.
17069
17070 @table @code
17071 @kindex set editing
17072 @cindex editing
17073 @item set editing
17074 @itemx set editing on
17075 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
17076
17077 @item set editing off
17078 Disable command line editing.
17079
17080 @kindex show editing
17081 @item show editing
17082 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
17083 @end table
17084
17085 @xref{Command Line Editing}, for more details about the Readline
17086 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
17087 encouraged to read that chapter.
17088
17089 @node Command History
17090 @section Command History
17091 @cindex command history
17092
17093 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
17094 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
17095 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
17096 history facility.
17097
17098 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
17099 package, to provide the history facility. @xref{Using History
17100 Interactively}, for the detailed description of the History library.
17101
17102 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
17103 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
17104 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
17105 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
17106 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
17107 pressed on a line by itself.
17108
17109 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
17110 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
17111 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
17112 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
17113
17114 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
17115 history.
17116
17117 @table @code
17118 @cindex history substitution
17119 @cindex history file
17120 @kindex set history filename
17121 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
17122 @item set history filename @var{fname}
17123 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
17124 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
17125 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
17126 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
17127 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
17128 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
17129 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
17130 is not set.
17131
17132 @cindex save command history
17133 @kindex set history save
17134 @item set history save
17135 @itemx set history save on
17136 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
17137 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
17138
17139 @item set history save off
17140 Stop recording command history in a file.
17141
17142 @cindex history size
17143 @kindex set history size
17144 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
17145 @item set history size @var{size}
17146 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
17147 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
17148 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
17149 @end table
17150
17151 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
17152 @xref{Event Designators}, for more details.
17153
17154 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
17155 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
17156 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
17157 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
17158 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
17159 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
17160 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
17161 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
17162
17163 The commands to control history expansion are:
17164
17165 @table @code
17166 @item set history expansion on
17167 @itemx set history expansion
17168 @kindex set history expansion
17169 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
17170
17171 @item set history expansion off
17172 Disable history expansion.
17173
17174 @c @group
17175 @kindex show history
17176 @item show history
17177 @itemx show history filename
17178 @itemx show history save
17179 @itemx show history size
17180 @itemx show history expansion
17181 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
17182 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
17183 @c @end group
17184 @end table
17185
17186 @table @code
17187 @kindex show commands
17188 @cindex show last commands
17189 @cindex display command history
17190 @item show commands
17191 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
17192
17193 @item show commands @var{n}
17194 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
17195
17196 @item show commands +
17197 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
17198 @end table
17199
17200 @node Screen Size
17201 @section Screen Size
17202 @cindex size of screen
17203 @cindex pauses in output
17204
17205 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
17206 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
17207 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
17208 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
17209 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
17210 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
17211 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
17212 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
17213
17214 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
17215 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
17216 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
17217 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
17218 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
17219 width} commands:
17220
17221 @table @code
17222 @kindex set height
17223 @kindex set width
17224 @kindex show width
17225 @kindex show height
17226 @item set height @var{lpp}
17227 @itemx show height
17228 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
17229 @itemx show width
17230 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
17231 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
17232 commands display the current settings.
17233
17234 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
17235 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
17236 file or to an editor buffer.
17237
17238 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
17239 from wrapping its output.
17240
17241 @item set pagination on
17242 @itemx set pagination off
17243 @kindex set pagination
17244 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
17245 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height 0}.
17246
17247 @item show pagination
17248 @kindex show pagination
17249 Show the current pagination mode.
17250 @end table
17251
17252 @node Numbers
17253 @section Numbers
17254 @cindex number representation
17255 @cindex entering numbers
17256
17257 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
17258 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
17259 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
17260 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
17261 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
17262 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
17263 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
17264 both input and output with the commands described below.
17265
17266 @table @code
17267 @kindex set input-radix
17268 @item set input-radix @var{base}
17269 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
17270 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17271 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
17272 example, any of
17273
17274 @smallexample
17275 set input-radix 012
17276 set input-radix 10.
17277 set input-radix 0xa
17278 @end smallexample
17279
17280 @noindent
17281 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
17282 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
17283 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
17284 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
17285 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
17286 change the radix.
17287
17288 @kindex set output-radix
17289 @item set output-radix @var{base}
17290 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
17291 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
17292 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
17293
17294 @kindex show input-radix
17295 @item show input-radix
17296 Display the current default base for numeric input.
17297
17298 @kindex show output-radix
17299 @item show output-radix
17300 Display the current default base for numeric display.
17301
17302 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
17303 @itemx show radix
17304 @kindex set radix
17305 @kindex show radix
17306 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
17307 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
17308 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
17309 default value of 10.
17310
17311 @end table
17312
17313 @node ABI
17314 @section Configuring the Current ABI
17315
17316 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
17317 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
17318 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
17319 current ABI.
17320
17321 @cindex OS ABI
17322 @kindex set osabi
17323 @kindex show osabi
17324
17325 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
17326 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
17327 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
17328 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
17329 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
17330 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
17331 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
17332 platform provides.
17333
17334 @table @code
17335 @item show osabi
17336 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
17337
17338 @item set osabi
17339 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
17340
17341 @item set osabi @var{abi}
17342 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
17343 @end table
17344
17345 @cindex float promotion
17346
17347 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
17348 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
17349 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
17350 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
17351 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
17352 @code{double} and then passed.
17353
17354 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
17355 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
17356 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
17357
17358 @table @code
17359 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
17360 @item set coerce-float-to-double
17361 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
17362 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
17363 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
17364
17365 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
17366 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
17367 functions.
17368
17369 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
17370 @item show coerce-float-to-double
17371 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
17372 @end table
17373
17374 @kindex set cp-abi
17375 @kindex show cp-abi
17376 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
17377 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
17378 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
17379 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
17380 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
17381 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
17382 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
17383 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
17384 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
17385 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
17386 ``auto''.
17387
17388 @table @code
17389 @item show cp-abi
17390 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
17391
17392 @item set cp-abi
17393 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
17394
17395 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
17396 @itemx set cp-abi auto
17397 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
17398 @end table
17399
17400 @node Messages/Warnings
17401 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
17402
17403 @cindex verbose operation
17404 @cindex optional warnings
17405 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
17406 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
17407 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
17408 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
17409
17410 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
17411 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
17412 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
17413
17414 @table @code
17415 @kindex set verbose
17416 @item set verbose on
17417 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17418
17419 @item set verbose off
17420 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
17421
17422 @kindex show verbose
17423 @item show verbose
17424 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
17425 @end table
17426
17427 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
17428 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
17429 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
17430 Symbol Files}).
17431
17432 @table @code
17433
17434 @kindex set complaints
17435 @item set complaints @var{limit}
17436 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
17437 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
17438 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
17439 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
17440
17441 @kindex show complaints
17442 @item show complaints
17443 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
17444
17445 @end table
17446
17447 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
17448 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
17449 you try to run a program which is already running:
17450
17451 @smallexample
17452 (@value{GDBP}) run
17453 The program being debugged has been started already.
17454 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
17455 @end smallexample
17456
17457 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
17458 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
17459
17460 @table @code
17461
17462 @kindex set confirm
17463 @cindex flinching
17464 @cindex confirmation
17465 @cindex stupid questions
17466 @item set confirm off
17467 Disables confirmation requests.
17468
17469 @item set confirm on
17470 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
17471
17472 @kindex show confirm
17473 @item show confirm
17474 Displays state of confirmation requests.
17475
17476 @end table
17477
17478 @cindex command tracing
17479 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
17480 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
17481 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
17482 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
17483
17484 @table @code
17485 @kindex set trace-commands
17486 @cindex command scripts, debugging
17487 @item set trace-commands on
17488 Enable command tracing.
17489 @item set trace-commands off
17490 Disable command tracing.
17491 @item show trace-commands
17492 Display the current state of command tracing.
17493 @end table
17494
17495 @node Debugging Output
17496 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
17497 @cindex optional debugging messages
17498
17499 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
17500 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
17501 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
17502 section documents those commands.
17503
17504 @table @code
17505 @kindex set exec-done-display
17506 @item set exec-done-display
17507 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
17508 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
17509 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
17510 @kindex show exec-done-display
17511 @item show exec-done-display
17512 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
17513 notification.
17514 @kindex set debug
17515 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
17516 @cindex architecture debugging info
17517 @item set debug arch
17518 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
17519 @kindex show debug
17520 @item show debug arch
17521 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
17522 @item set debug aix-thread
17523 @cindex AIX threads
17524 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
17525 module.
17526 @item show debug aix-thread
17527 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
17528 @item set debug dwarf2-die
17529 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
17530 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
17531 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
17532 A value of zero turns off the display.
17533 @item show debug dwarf2-die
17534 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
17535 @item set debug displaced
17536 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
17537 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
17538 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
17539 @item show debug displaced
17540 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
17541 related to displaced stepping.
17542 @item set debug event
17543 @cindex event debugging info
17544 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
17545 default is off.
17546 @item show debug event
17547 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
17548 info.
17549 @item set debug expression
17550 @cindex expression debugging info
17551 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
17552 expression parsing. The default is off.
17553 @item show debug expression
17554 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
17555 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
17556 @item set debug frame
17557 @cindex frame debugging info
17558 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
17559 default is off.
17560 @item show debug frame
17561 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
17562 info.
17563 @item set debug infrun
17564 @cindex inferior debugging info
17565 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
17566 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
17567 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
17568 @item show debug infrun
17569 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
17570 @item set debug lin-lwp
17571 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
17572 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17573 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
17574 @item show debug lin-lwp
17575 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
17576 @item set debug lin-lwp-async
17577 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP async debug messages
17578 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
17579 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP async debug support.
17580 @item show debug lin-lwp-async
17581 Show the current state of Linux LWP async debugging messages.
17582 @item set debug observer
17583 @cindex observer debugging info
17584 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
17585 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
17586 @item show debug observer
17587 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
17588 @item set debug overload
17589 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
17590 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
17591 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
17592 is off.
17593 @item show debug overload
17594 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
17595 debugging info.
17596 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
17597 @cindex serial connections, debugging
17598 @cindex debug remote protocol
17599 @cindex remote protocol debugging
17600 @cindex display remote packets
17601 @item set debug remote
17602 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
17603 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
17604 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
17605 @item show debug remote
17606 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
17607 @item set debug serial
17608 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
17609 default is off.
17610 @item show debug serial
17611 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
17612 info.
17613 @item set debug solib-frv
17614 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
17615 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
17616 @item show debug solib-frv
17617 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
17618 messages.
17619 @item set debug target
17620 @cindex target debugging info
17621 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
17622 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
17623 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
17624 value of large memory transfers. Changes to this flag do not take effect
17625 until the next time you connect to a target or use the @code{run} command.
17626 @item show debug target
17627 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
17628 info.
17629 @item set debug timestamp
17630 @cindex timestampping debugging info
17631 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
17632 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
17633 message.
17634 @item show debug timestamp
17635 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
17636 debugging info.
17637 @item set debugvarobj
17638 @cindex variable object debugging info
17639 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
17640 info. The default is off.
17641 @item show debugvarobj
17642 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
17643 debugging info.
17644 @item set debug xml
17645 @cindex XML parser debugging
17646 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
17647 @item show debug xml
17648 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
17649 @end table
17650
17651 @node Extending GDB
17652 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
17653 @cindex extending GDB
17654
17655 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for extension. The first is based
17656 on composition of @value{GDBN} commands, and the second is based on the
17657 Python scripting language.
17658
17659 @menu
17660 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of Commands
17661 * Python:: Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
17662 @end menu
17663
17664 @node Sequences
17665 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
17666
17667 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
17668 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
17669 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
17670 files.
17671
17672 @menu
17673 * Define:: How to define your own commands
17674 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
17675 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
17676 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
17677 @end menu
17678
17679 @node Define
17680 @subsection User-defined Commands
17681
17682 @cindex user-defined command
17683 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
17684 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
17685 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
17686 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
17687 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
17688 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
17689
17690 @smallexample
17691 define adder
17692 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17693 end
17694 @end smallexample
17695
17696 @noindent
17697 To execute the command use:
17698
17699 @smallexample
17700 adder 1 2 3
17701 @end smallexample
17702
17703 @noindent
17704 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
17705 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
17706 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
17707 functions calls.
17708
17709 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
17710 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
17711 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
17712 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
17713
17714 @smallexample
17715 define adder
17716 if $argc == 2
17717 print $arg0 + $arg1
17718 end
17719 if $argc == 3
17720 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
17721 end
17722 end
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 @table @code
17726
17727 @kindex define
17728 @item define @var{commandname}
17729 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
17730 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
17731 @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
17732 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
17733 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
17734 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
17735
17736 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
17737 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
17738 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17739
17740 @kindex document
17741 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
17742 @item document @var{commandname}
17743 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
17744 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
17745 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
17746 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
17747 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
17748 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
17749
17750 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
17751 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
17752 does not change the documentation.
17753
17754 @kindex dont-repeat
17755 @cindex don't repeat command
17756 @item dont-repeat
17757 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
17758 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
17759 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
17760
17761 @kindex help user-defined
17762 @item help user-defined
17763 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
17764 (if any) for each.
17765
17766 @kindex show user
17767 @item show user
17768 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
17769 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
17770 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
17771 definitions for all user-defined commands.
17772
17773 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
17774 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
17775 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
17776 @item show max-user-call-depth
17777 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
17778 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
17779 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
17780 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
17781 @end table
17782
17783 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
17784 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
17785
17786 When user-defined commands are executed, the
17787 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
17788 stops execution of the user-defined command.
17789
17790 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
17791 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
17792 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
17793 messages when used in a user-defined command.
17794
17795 @node Hooks
17796 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
17797 @cindex command hooks
17798 @cindex hooks, for commands
17799 @cindex hooks, pre-command
17800
17801 @kindex hook
17802 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
17803 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
17804 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
17805 before that command.
17806
17807 @cindex hooks, post-command
17808 @kindex hookpost
17809 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
17810 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
17811 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
17812 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
17813 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
17814
17815 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
17816 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
17817
17818 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
17819 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
17820
17821 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
17822 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
17823 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
17824 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
17825 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
17826
17827 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
17828 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
17829 you could define:
17830
17831 @smallexample
17832 define hook-stop
17833 handle SIGALRM nopass
17834 end
17835
17836 define hook-run
17837 handle SIGALRM pass
17838 end
17839
17840 define hook-continue
17841 handle SIGALRM pass
17842 end
17843 @end smallexample
17844
17845 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
17846 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
17847 you could define:
17848
17849 @smallexample
17850 define hook-echo
17851 echo <<<---
17852 end
17853
17854 define hookpost-echo
17855 echo --->>>\n
17856 end
17857
17858 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
17859 <<<---Hello World--->>>
17860 (@value{GDBP})
17861
17862 @end smallexample
17863
17864 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
17865 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
17866 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
17867 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
17868 @c or not?
17869 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
17870 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
17871 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
17872
17873 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
17874 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
17875 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
17876
17877 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
17878 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
17879
17880 @node Command Files
17881 @subsection Command Files
17882
17883 @cindex command files
17884 @cindex scripting commands
17885 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
17886 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
17887 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
17888 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
17889 terminal.
17890
17891 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
17892 command:
17893
17894 @table @code
17895 @kindex source
17896 @cindex execute commands from a file
17897 @item source [@code{-v}] @var{filename}
17898 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
17899 @end table
17900
17901 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
17902 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
17903 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
17904 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
17905 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
17906
17907 @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename} in the current directory and then
17908 on the search path (specified with the @samp{directory} command).
17909
17910 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
17911 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
17912 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
17913
17914 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
17915 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
17916 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
17917 when called from command files.
17918
17919 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
17920 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
17921 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
17922 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
17923 the next command.
17924
17925 @smallexample
17926 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
17927 @end smallexample
17928
17929 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
17930 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
17931 would be directed to @file{log}.
17932
17933 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
17934 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
17935 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
17936 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
17937 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
17938 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
17939 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
17940 conditionally, etc.
17941
17942 @table @code
17943 @kindex if
17944 @kindex else
17945 @item if
17946 @itemx else
17947 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
17948 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
17949 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
17950 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
17951 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
17952 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
17953 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
17954
17955 @kindex while
17956 @item while
17957 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
17958 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
17959 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
17960 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
17961 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
17962 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
17963
17964 @kindex loop_break
17965 @item loop_break
17966 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
17967 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
17968 line.
17969
17970 @kindex loop_continue
17971 @item loop_continue
17972 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
17973 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
17974 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
17975 the controlling expression.
17976
17977 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
17978 @item end
17979 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
17980 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
17981 @end table
17982
17983
17984 @node Output
17985 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
17986
17987 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
17988 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
17989 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
17990 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
17991 want.
17992
17993 @table @code
17994 @kindex echo
17995 @item echo @var{text}
17996 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
17997 @c because it is not in ANSI.
17998 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
17999 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
18000 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
18001 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
18002 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
18003 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
18004 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
18005 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
18006 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
18007
18008 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
18009 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
18010
18011 @smallexample
18012 echo This is some text\n\
18013 which is continued\n\
18014 onto several lines.\n
18015 @end smallexample
18016
18017 produces the same output as
18018
18019 @smallexample
18020 echo This is some text\n
18021 echo which is continued\n
18022 echo onto several lines.\n
18023 @end smallexample
18024
18025 @kindex output
18026 @item output @var{expression}
18027 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
18028 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
18029 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
18030 on expressions.
18031
18032 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
18033 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
18034 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
18035 Formats}, for more information.
18036
18037 @kindex printf
18038 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
18039 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
18040 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
18041 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
18042 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
18043 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
18044 executing the code below:
18045
18046 @smallexample
18047 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
18048 @end smallexample
18049
18050 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
18051 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
18052 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
18053 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
18054 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
18055 printed.
18056
18057 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
18058
18059 @smallexample
18060 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
18061 @end smallexample
18062
18063 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
18064 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
18065 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
18066
18067 @itemize @bullet
18068 @item
18069 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
18070
18071 @item
18072 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
18073 width.
18074
18075 @item
18076 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
18077 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
18078
18079 @item
18080 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
18081 supported.
18082
18083 @item
18084 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
18085
18086 @item
18087 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
18088 @end itemize
18089
18090 @noindent
18091 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
18092 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
18093 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
18094 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
18095
18096 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
18097 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
18098 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
18099 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
18100 supported.
18101
18102 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
18103 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
18104 together with a floating point specifier.
18105 letters:
18106
18107 @itemize @bullet
18108 @item
18109 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
18110
18111 @item
18112 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
18113
18114 @item
18115 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
18116 @end itemize
18117
18118 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
18119 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
18120 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
18121
18122 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
18123 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
18124
18125 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
18126 @smallexample
18127 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
18128 @end smallexample
18129
18130 @end table
18131
18132 @node Python
18133 @section Scripting @value{GDBN} using Python
18134 @cindex python scripting
18135 @cindex scripting with python
18136
18137 You can script @value{GDBN} using the @uref{http://www.python.org/,
18138 Python programming language}. This feature is available only if
18139 @value{GDBN} was configured using @option{--with-python}.
18140
18141 @menu
18142 * Python Commands:: Accessing Python from @value{GDBN}.
18143 * Python API:: Accessing @value{GDBN} from Python.
18144 @end menu
18145
18146 @node Python Commands
18147 @subsection Python Commands
18148 @cindex python commands
18149 @cindex commands to access python
18150
18151 @value{GDBN} provides one command for accessing the Python interpreter,
18152 and one related setting:
18153
18154 @table @code
18155 @kindex python
18156 @item python @r{[}@var{code}@r{]}
18157 The @code{python} command can be used to evaluate Python code.
18158
18159 If given an argument, the @code{python} command will evaluate the
18160 argument as a Python command. For example:
18161
18162 @smallexample
18163 (@value{GDBP}) python print 23
18164 23
18165 @end smallexample
18166
18167 If you do not provide an argument to @code{python}, it will act as a
18168 multi-line command, like @code{define}. In this case, the Python
18169 script is made up of subsequent command lines, given after the
18170 @code{python} command. This command list is terminated using a line
18171 containing @code{end}. For example:
18172
18173 @smallexample
18174 (@value{GDBP}) python
18175 Type python script
18176 End with a line saying just "end".
18177 >print 23
18178 >end
18179 23
18180 @end smallexample
18181
18182 @kindex maint set python print-stack
18183 @item maint set python print-stack
18184 By default, @value{GDBN} will print a stack trace when an error occurs
18185 in a Python script. This can be controlled using @code{maint set
18186 python print-stack}: if @code{on}, the default, then Python stack
18187 printing is enabled; if @code{off}, then Python stack printing is
18188 disabled.
18189 @end table
18190
18191 @node Python API
18192 @subsection Python API
18193 @cindex python api
18194 @cindex programming in python
18195
18196 @cindex python stdout
18197 @cindex python pagination
18198 At startup, @value{GDBN} overrides Python's @code{sys.stdout} and
18199 @code{sys.stderr} to print using @value{GDBN}'s output-paging streams.
18200 A Python program which outputs to one of these streams may have its
18201 output interrupted by the user (@pxref{Screen Size}). In this
18202 situation, a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt} exception is thrown.
18203
18204 @menu
18205 * Basic Python:: Basic Python Functions.
18206 * Exception Handling::
18207 * Values From Inferior::
18208 * Commands In Python:: Implementing new commands in Python.
18209 @end menu
18210
18211 @node Basic Python
18212 @subsubsection Basic Python
18213
18214 @cindex python functions
18215 @cindex python module
18216 @cindex gdb module
18217 @value{GDBN} introduces a new Python module, named @code{gdb}. All
18218 methods and classes added by @value{GDBN} are placed in this module.
18219 @value{GDBN} automatically @code{import}s the @code{gdb} module for
18220 use in all scripts evaluated by the @code{python} command.
18221
18222 @findex gdb.execute
18223 @defun execute command [from_tty]
18224 Evaluate @var{command}, a string, as a @value{GDBN} CLI command.
18225 If a GDB exception happens while @var{command} runs, it is
18226 translated as described in @ref{Exception Handling,,Exception Handling}.
18227 If no exceptions occur, this function returns @code{None}.
18228
18229 @var{from_tty} specifies whether @value{GDBN} ought to consider this
18230 command as having originated from the user invoking it interactively.
18231 It must be a boolean value. If omitted, it defaults to @code{False}.
18232 @end defun
18233
18234 @findex gdb.get_parameter
18235 @defun get_parameter parameter
18236 Return the value of a @value{GDBN} parameter. @var{parameter} is a
18237 string naming the parameter to look up; @var{parameter} may contain
18238 spaces if the parameter has a multi-part name. For example,
18239 @samp{print object} is a valid parameter name.
18240
18241 If the named parameter does not exist, this function throws a
18242 @code{RuntimeError}. Otherwise, the parameter's value is converted to
18243 a Python value of the appropriate type, and returned.
18244 @end defun
18245
18246 @findex gdb.history
18247 @defun history number
18248 Return a value from @value{GDBN}'s value history (@pxref{Value
18249 History}). @var{number} indicates which history element to return.
18250 If @var{number} is negative, then @value{GDBN} will take its absolute value
18251 and count backward from the last element (i.e., the most recent element) to
18252 find the value to return. If @var{number} is zero, then @value{GDBN} will
18253 return the most recent element. If the element specified by @var{number}
18254 doesn't exist in the value history, a @code{RuntimeError} exception will be
18255 raised.
18256
18257 If no exception is raised, the return value is always an instance of
18258 @code{gdb.Value} (@pxref{Values From Inferior}).
18259 @end defun
18260
18261 @findex gdb.write
18262 @defun write string
18263 Print a string to @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream.
18264 Writing to @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically
18265 call this function.
18266 @end defun
18267
18268 @findex gdb.flush
18269 @defun flush
18270 Flush @value{GDBN}'s paginated standard output stream. Flushing
18271 @code{sys.stdout} or @code{sys.stderr} will automatically call this
18272 function.
18273 @end defun
18274
18275 @node Exception Handling
18276 @subsubsection Exception Handling
18277 @cindex python exceptions
18278 @cindex exceptions, python
18279
18280 When executing the @code{python} command, Python exceptions
18281 uncaught within the Python code are translated to calls to
18282 @value{GDBN} error-reporting mechanism. If the command that called
18283 @code{python} does not handle the error, @value{GDBN} will
18284 terminate it and print an error message containing the Python
18285 exception name, the associated value, and the Python call stack
18286 backtrace at the point where the exception was raised. Example:
18287
18288 @smallexample
18289 (@value{GDBP}) python print foo
18290 Traceback (most recent call last):
18291 File "<string>", line 1, in <module>
18292 NameError: name 'foo' is not defined
18293 @end smallexample
18294
18295 @value{GDBN} errors that happen in @value{GDBN} commands invoked by Python
18296 code are converted to Python @code{RuntimeError} exceptions. User
18297 interrupt (via @kbd{C-c} or by typing @kbd{q} at a pagination
18298 prompt) is translated to a Python @code{KeyboardInterrupt}
18299 exception. If you catch these exceptions in your Python code, your
18300 exception handler will see @code{RuntimeError} or
18301 @code{KeyboardInterrupt} as the exception type, the @value{GDBN} error
18302 message as its value, and the Python call stack backtrace at the
18303 Python statement closest to where the @value{GDBN} error occured as the
18304 traceback.
18305
18306 @node Values From Inferior
18307 @subsubsection Values From Inferior
18308 @cindex values from inferior, with Python
18309 @cindex python, working with values from inferior
18310
18311 @cindex @code{gdb.Value}
18312 @value{GDBN} provides values it obtains from the inferior program in
18313 an object of type @code{gdb.Value}. @value{GDBN} uses this object
18314 for its internal bookkeeping of the inferior's values, and for
18315 fetching values when necessary.
18316
18317 Inferior values that are simple scalars can be used directly in
18318 Python expressions that are valid for the value's data type. Here's
18319 an example for an integer or floating-point value @code{some_val}:
18320
18321 @smallexample
18322 bar = some_val + 2
18323 @end smallexample
18324
18325 @noindent
18326 As result of this, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object
18327 whose values are of the same type as those of @code{some_val}.
18328
18329 Inferior values that are structures or instances of some class can
18330 be accessed using the Python @dfn{dictionary syntax}. For example, if
18331 @code{some_val} is a @code{gdb.Value} instance holding a structure, you
18332 can access its @code{foo} element with:
18333
18334 @smallexample
18335 bar = some_val['foo']
18336 @end smallexample
18337
18338 Again, @code{bar} will also be a @code{gdb.Value} object.
18339
18340 For pointer data types, @code{gdb.Value} provides a method for
18341 dereferencing the pointer to obtain the object it points to.
18342
18343 @defmethod Value dereference
18344 This method returns a new @code{gdb.Value} object whose contents is
18345 the object pointed to by the pointer. For example, if @code{foo} is
18346 a C pointer to an @code{int}, declared in your C program as
18347
18348 @smallexample
18349 int *foo;
18350 @end smallexample
18351
18352 @noindent
18353 then you can use the corresponding @code{gdb.Value} to access what
18354 @code{foo} points to like this:
18355
18356 @smallexample
18357 bar = foo.dereference ()
18358 @end smallexample
18359
18360 The result @code{bar} will be a @code{gdb.Value} object holding the
18361 value pointed to by @code{foo}.
18362 @end defmethod
18363
18364 @defmethod Value string @r{[}encoding @r{[}errors@r{]}@r{]}
18365 If this @code{gdb.Value} represents a string, then this method
18366 converts the contents to a Python string. Otherwise, this method will
18367 throw an exception.
18368
18369 Strings are recognized in a language-specific way; whether a given
18370 @code{gdb.Value} represents a string is determined by the current
18371 language.
18372
18373 For C-like languages, a value is a string if it is a pointer to or an
18374 array of characters or ints. The string is assumed to be terminated
18375 by a zero of the appropriate width.
18376
18377 If the optional @var{encoding} argument is given, it must be a string
18378 naming the encoding of the string in the @code{gdb.Value}, such as
18379 @code{"ascii"}, @code{"iso-8859-6"} or @code{"utf-8"}. It accepts
18380 the same encodings as the corresponding argument to Python's
18381 @code{string.decode} method, and the Python codec machinery will be used
18382 to convert the string. If @var{encoding} is not given, or if
18383 @var{encoding} is the empty string, then either the @code{target-charset}
18384 (@pxref{Character Sets}) will be used, or a language-specific encoding
18385 will be used, if the current language is able to supply one.
18386
18387 The optional @var{errors} argument is the same as the corresponding
18388 argument to Python's @code{string.decode} method.
18389 @end defmethod
18390
18391 @node Commands In Python
18392 @subsubsection Commands In Python
18393
18394 @cindex commands in python
18395 @cindex python commands
18396 You can implement new @value{GDBN} CLI commands in Python. A CLI
18397 command is implemented using an instance of the @code{gdb.Command}
18398 class, most commonly using a subclass.
18399
18400 @defmethod Command __init__ name @var{command-class} @r{[}@var{completer-class} @var{prefix}@r{]}
18401 The object initializer for @code{Command} registers the new command
18402 with @value{GDBN}. This initializer is normally invoked from the
18403 subclass' own @code{__init__} method.
18404
18405 @var{name} is the name of the command. If @var{name} consists of
18406 multiple words, then the initial words are looked for as prefix
18407 commands. In this case, if one of the prefix commands does not exist,
18408 an exception is raised.
18409
18410 There is no support for multi-line commands.
18411
18412 @var{command-class} should be one of the @samp{COMMAND_} constants
18413 defined below. This argument tells @value{GDBN} how to categorize the
18414 new command in the help system.
18415
18416 @var{completer-class} is an optional argument. If given, it should be
18417 one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined below. This argument
18418 tells @value{GDBN} how to perform completion for this command. If not
18419 given, @value{GDBN} will attempt to complete using the object's
18420 @code{complete} method (see below); if no such method is found, an
18421 error will occur when completion is attempted.
18422
18423 @var{prefix} is an optional argument. If @code{True}, then the new
18424 command is a prefix command; sub-commands of this command may be
18425 registered.
18426
18427 The help text for the new command is taken from the Python
18428 documentation string for the command's class, if there is one. If no
18429 documentation string is provided, the default value ``This command is
18430 not documented.'' is used.
18431 @end defmethod
18432
18433 @cindex don't repeat Python command
18434 @defmethod Command dont_repeat
18435 By default, a @value{GDBN} command is repeated when the user enters a
18436 blank line at the command prompt. A command can suppress this
18437 behavior by invoking the @code{dont_repeat} method. This is similar
18438 to the user command @code{dont-repeat}, see @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
18439 @end defmethod
18440
18441 @defmethod Command invoke argument from_tty
18442 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when this command is invoked.
18443
18444 @var{argument} is a string. It is the argument to the command, after
18445 leading and trailing whitespace has been stripped.
18446
18447 @var{from_tty} is a boolean argument. When true, this means that the
18448 command was entered by the user at the terminal; when false it means
18449 that the command came from elsewhere.
18450
18451 If this method throws an exception, it is turned into a @value{GDBN}
18452 @code{error} call. Otherwise, the return value is ignored.
18453 @end defmethod
18454
18455 @cindex completion of Python commands
18456 @defmethod Command complete text word
18457 This method is called by @value{GDBN} when the user attempts
18458 completion on this command. All forms of completion are handled by
18459 this method, that is, the @key{TAB} and @key{M-?} key bindings
18460 (@pxref{Completion}), and the @code{complete} command (@pxref{Help,
18461 complete}).
18462
18463 The arguments @var{text} and @var{word} are both strings. @var{text}
18464 holds the complete command line up to the cursor's location.
18465 @var{word} holds the last word of the command line; this is computed
18466 using a word-breaking heuristic.
18467
18468 The @code{complete} method can return several values:
18469 @itemize @bullet
18470 @item
18471 If the return value is a sequence, the contents of the sequence are
18472 used as the completions. It is up to @code{complete} to ensure that the
18473 contents actually do complete the word. A zero-length sequence is
18474 allowed, it means that there were no completions available. Only
18475 string elements of the sequence are used; other elements in the
18476 sequence are ignored.
18477
18478 @item
18479 If the return value is one of the @samp{COMPLETE_} constants defined
18480 below, then the corresponding @value{GDBN}-internal completion
18481 function is invoked, and its result is used.
18482
18483 @item
18484 All other results are treated as though there were no available
18485 completions.
18486 @end itemize
18487 @end defmethod
18488
18489 When a new command is registered, it must be declared as a member of
18490 some general class of commands. This is used to classify top-level
18491 commands in the on-line help system; note that prefix commands are not
18492 listed under their own category but rather that of their top-level
18493 command. The available classifications are represented by constants
18494 defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18495
18496 @table @code
18497 @findex COMMAND_NONE
18498 @findex gdb.COMMAND_NONE
18499 @item COMMAND_NONE
18500 The command does not belong to any particular class. A command in
18501 this category will not be displayed in any of the help categories.
18502
18503 @findex COMMAND_RUNNING
18504 @findex gdb.COMMAND_RUNNING
18505 @item COMMAND_RUNNING
18506 The command is related to running the inferior. For example,
18507 @code{start}, @code{step}, and @code{continue} are in this category.
18508 Type @kbd{help running} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18509 commands in this category.
18510
18511 @findex COMMAND_DATA
18512 @findex gdb.COMMAND_DATA
18513 @item COMMAND_DATA
18514 The command is related to data or variables. For example,
18515 @code{call}, @code{find}, and @code{print} are in this category. Type
18516 @kbd{help data} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands
18517 in this category.
18518
18519 @findex COMMAND_STACK
18520 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STACK
18521 @item COMMAND_STACK
18522 The command has to do with manipulation of the stack. For example,
18523 @code{backtrace}, @code{frame}, and @code{return} are in this
18524 category. Type @kbd{help stack} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a
18525 list of commands in this category.
18526
18527 @findex COMMAND_FILES
18528 @findex gdb.COMMAND_FILES
18529 @item COMMAND_FILES
18530 This class is used for file-related commands. For example,
18531 @code{file}, @code{list} and @code{section} are in this category.
18532 Type @kbd{help files} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18533 commands in this category.
18534
18535 @findex COMMAND_SUPPORT
18536 @findex gdb.COMMAND_SUPPORT
18537 @item COMMAND_SUPPORT
18538 This should be used for ``support facilities'', generally meaning
18539 things that are useful to the user when interacting with @value{GDBN},
18540 but not related to the state of the inferior. For example,
18541 @code{help}, @code{make}, and @code{shell} are in this category. Type
18542 @kbd{help support} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18543 commands in this category.
18544
18545 @findex COMMAND_STATUS
18546 @findex gdb.COMMAND_STATUS
18547 @item COMMAND_STATUS
18548 The command is an @samp{info}-related command, that is, related to the
18549 state of @value{GDBN} itself. For example, @code{info}, @code{macro},
18550 and @code{show} are in this category. Type @kbd{help status} at the
18551 @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this category.
18552
18553 @findex COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18554 @findex gdb.COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18555 @item COMMAND_BREAKPOINTS
18556 The command has to do with breakpoints. For example, @code{break},
18557 @code{clear}, and @code{delete} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18558 breakpoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in
18559 this category.
18560
18561 @findex COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18562 @findex gdb.COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18563 @item COMMAND_TRACEPOINTS
18564 The command has to do with tracepoints. For example, @code{trace},
18565 @code{actions}, and @code{tfind} are in this category. Type
18566 @kbd{help tracepoints} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18567 commands in this category.
18568
18569 @findex COMMAND_OBSCURE
18570 @findex gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE
18571 @item COMMAND_OBSCURE
18572 The command is only used in unusual circumstances, or is not of
18573 general interest to users. For example, @code{checkpoint},
18574 @code{fork}, and @code{stop} are in this category. Type @kbd{help
18575 obscure} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of commands in this
18576 category.
18577
18578 @findex COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18579 @findex gdb.COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18580 @item COMMAND_MAINTENANCE
18581 The command is only useful to @value{GDBN} maintainers. The
18582 @code{maintenance} and @code{flushregs} commands are in this category.
18583 Type @kbd{help internals} at the @value{GDBN} prompt to see a list of
18584 commands in this category.
18585 @end table
18586
18587 A new command can use a predefined completion function, either by
18588 specifying it via an argument at initialization, or by returning it
18589 from the @code{complete} method. These predefined completion
18590 constants are all defined in the @code{gdb} module:
18591
18592 @table @code
18593 @findex COMPLETE_NONE
18594 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_NONE
18595 @item COMPLETE_NONE
18596 This constant means that no completion should be done.
18597
18598 @findex COMPLETE_FILENAME
18599 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_FILENAME
18600 @item COMPLETE_FILENAME
18601 This constant means that filename completion should be performed.
18602
18603 @findex COMPLETE_LOCATION
18604 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_LOCATION
18605 @item COMPLETE_LOCATION
18606 This constant means that location completion should be done.
18607 @xref{Specify Location}.
18608
18609 @findex COMPLETE_COMMAND
18610 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_COMMAND
18611 @item COMPLETE_COMMAND
18612 This constant means that completion should examine @value{GDBN}
18613 command names.
18614
18615 @findex COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18616 @findex gdb.COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18617 @item COMPLETE_SYMBOL
18618 This constant means that completion should be done using symbol names
18619 as the source.
18620 @end table
18621
18622 The following code snippet shows how a trivial CLI command can be
18623 implemented in Python:
18624
18625 @smallexample
18626 class HelloWorld (gdb.Command):
18627 """Greet the whole world."""
18628
18629 def __init__ (self):
18630 super (HelloWorld, self).__init__ ("hello-world", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)
18631
18632 def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):
18633 print "Hello, World!"
18634
18635 HelloWorld ()
18636 @end smallexample
18637
18638 The last line instantiates the class, and is necessary to trigger the
18639 registration of the command with @value{GDBN}. Depending on how the
18640 Python code is read into @value{GDBN}, you may need to import the
18641 @code{gdb} module explicitly.
18642
18643 @node Interpreters
18644 @chapter Command Interpreters
18645 @cindex command interpreters
18646
18647 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
18648 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
18649 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
18650
18651 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
18652 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
18653 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
18654 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
18655
18656 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
18657 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
18658 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
18659 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
18660
18661 @table @code
18662 @item console
18663 @cindex console interpreter
18664 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
18665 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
18666 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
18667
18668 @item mi
18669 @cindex mi interpreter
18670 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
18671 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
18672 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
18673 Interface}.
18674
18675 @item mi2
18676 @cindex mi2 interpreter
18677 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
18678
18679 @item mi1
18680 @cindex mi1 interpreter
18681 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
18682
18683 @end table
18684
18685 @cindex invoke another interpreter
18686 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
18687 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
18688 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
18689 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
18690 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
18691 the IDE inoperable!
18692
18693 @kindex interpreter-exec
18694 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
18695 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
18696 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
18697 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
18698
18699 @smallexample
18700 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
18701 @end smallexample
18702
18703 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
18704 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
18705
18706 @node TUI
18707 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
18708 @cindex TUI
18709 @cindex Text User Interface
18710
18711 @menu
18712 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
18713 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
18714 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
18715 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
18716 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
18717 @end menu
18718
18719 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
18720 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
18721 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
18722 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
18723 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
18724 is available.
18725
18726 @pindex @value{GDBTUI}
18727 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
18728 either @samp{@value{GDBTUI}} or @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
18729 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
18730 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
18731 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
18732
18733 @node TUI Overview
18734 @section TUI Overview
18735
18736 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
18737
18738 @table @emph
18739 @item command
18740 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
18741 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
18742 managed using readline.
18743
18744 @item source
18745 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
18746 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
18747
18748 @item assembly
18749 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
18750
18751 @item register
18752 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
18753 when their values change.
18754 @end table
18755
18756 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
18757 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
18758 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
18759 indicates the breakpoint type:
18760
18761 @table @code
18762 @item B
18763 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18764
18765 @item b
18766 Breakpoint which was never hit.
18767
18768 @item H
18769 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
18770
18771 @item h
18772 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
18773 @end table
18774
18775 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
18776
18777 @table @code
18778 @item +
18779 Breakpoint is enabled.
18780
18781 @item -
18782 Breakpoint is disabled.
18783 @end table
18784
18785 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
18786 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
18787 changes.
18788
18789 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
18790 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
18791 layouts:
18792
18793 @itemize @bullet
18794 @item
18795 source only,
18796
18797 @item
18798 assembly only,
18799
18800 @item
18801 source and assembly,
18802
18803 @item
18804 source and registers, or
18805
18806 @item
18807 assembly and registers.
18808 @end itemize
18809
18810 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
18811
18812 @table @emph
18813 @item target
18814 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
18815 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
18816
18817 @item process
18818 Gives the current process or thread number.
18819 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
18820
18821 @item function
18822 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
18823 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
18824 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
18825 the string @code{??} is displayed.
18826
18827 @item line
18828 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
18829 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
18830
18831 @item pc
18832 Indicates the current program counter address.
18833 @end table
18834
18835 @node TUI Keys
18836 @section TUI Key Bindings
18837 @cindex TUI key bindings
18838
18839 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
18840 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}). The following key bindings
18841 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
18842
18843 @table @kbd
18844 @kindex C-x C-a
18845 @item C-x C-a
18846 @kindex C-x a
18847 @itemx C-x a
18848 @kindex C-x A
18849 @itemx C-x A
18850 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
18851 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
18852 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
18853 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
18854 The screen is then refreshed.
18855
18856 @kindex C-x 1
18857 @item C-x 1
18858 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
18859 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
18860 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
18861
18862 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
18863
18864 @kindex C-x 2
18865 @item C-x 2
18866 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
18867 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
18868 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
18869 previous layout and the new one.
18870
18871 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
18872
18873 @kindex C-x o
18874 @item C-x o
18875 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
18876 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
18877 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
18878
18879 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
18880
18881 @kindex C-x s
18882 @item C-x s
18883 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
18884 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
18885 @end table
18886
18887 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
18888
18889 @table @asis
18890 @kindex PgUp
18891 @item @key{PgUp}
18892 Scroll the active window one page up.
18893
18894 @kindex PgDn
18895 @item @key{PgDn}
18896 Scroll the active window one page down.
18897
18898 @kindex Up
18899 @item @key{Up}
18900 Scroll the active window one line up.
18901
18902 @kindex Down
18903 @item @key{Down}
18904 Scroll the active window one line down.
18905
18906 @kindex Left
18907 @item @key{Left}
18908 Scroll the active window one column left.
18909
18910 @kindex Right
18911 @item @key{Right}
18912 Scroll the active window one column right.
18913
18914 @kindex C-L
18915 @item @kbd{C-L}
18916 Refresh the screen.
18917 @end table
18918
18919 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
18920 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
18921 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
18922 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
18923 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
18924
18925 @node TUI Single Key Mode
18926 @section TUI Single Key Mode
18927 @cindex TUI single key mode
18928
18929 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
18930 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
18931 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
18932
18933 @table @kbd
18934 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18935 @item c
18936 continue
18937
18938 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18939 @item d
18940 down
18941
18942 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18943 @item f
18944 finish
18945
18946 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18947 @item n
18948 next
18949
18950 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18951 @item q
18952 exit the SingleKey mode.
18953
18954 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18955 @item r
18956 run
18957
18958 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18959 @item s
18960 step
18961
18962 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18963 @item u
18964 up
18965
18966 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18967 @item v
18968 info locals
18969
18970 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
18971 @item w
18972 where
18973 @end table
18974
18975 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
18976 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
18977 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
18978 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
18979 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
18980 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
18981
18982
18983 @node TUI Commands
18984 @section TUI-specific Commands
18985 @cindex TUI commands
18986
18987 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
18988 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
18989 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
18990 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
18991
18992 @table @code
18993 @item info win
18994 @kindex info win
18995 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
18996
18997 @item layout next
18998 @kindex layout
18999 Display the next layout.
19000
19001 @item layout prev
19002 Display the previous layout.
19003
19004 @item layout src
19005 Display the source window only.
19006
19007 @item layout asm
19008 Display the assembly window only.
19009
19010 @item layout split
19011 Display the source and assembly window.
19012
19013 @item layout regs
19014 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
19015
19016 @item focus next
19017 @kindex focus
19018 Make the next window active for scrolling.
19019
19020 @item focus prev
19021 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
19022
19023 @item focus src
19024 Make the source window active for scrolling.
19025
19026 @item focus asm
19027 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
19028
19029 @item focus regs
19030 Make the register window active for scrolling.
19031
19032 @item focus cmd
19033 Make the command window active for scrolling.
19034
19035 @item refresh
19036 @kindex refresh
19037 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
19038
19039 @item tui reg float
19040 @kindex tui reg
19041 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
19042
19043 @item tui reg general
19044 Show the general registers in the register window.
19045
19046 @item tui reg next
19047 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
19048 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
19049 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
19050 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
19051
19052 @item tui reg system
19053 Show the system registers in the register window.
19054
19055 @item update
19056 @kindex update
19057 Update the source window and the current execution point.
19058
19059 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
19060 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
19061 @kindex winheight
19062 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
19063 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
19064 decrease it.
19065
19066 @item tabset @var{nchars}
19067 @kindex tabset
19068 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters.
19069 @end table
19070
19071 @node TUI Configuration
19072 @section TUI Configuration Variables
19073 @cindex TUI configuration variables
19074
19075 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
19076
19077 @table @code
19078 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
19079 @kindex set tui border-kind
19080 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
19081 The possible values are the following:
19082 @table @code
19083 @item space
19084 Use a space character to draw the border.
19085
19086 @item ascii
19087 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
19088
19089 @item acs
19090 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
19091 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
19092 @end table
19093
19094 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
19095 @kindex set tui border-mode
19096 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
19097 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
19098 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
19099 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
19100 @table @code
19101 @item normal
19102 Use normal attributes to display the border.
19103
19104 @item standout
19105 Use standout mode.
19106
19107 @item reverse
19108 Use reverse video mode.
19109
19110 @item half
19111 Use half bright mode.
19112
19113 @item half-standout
19114 Use half bright and standout mode.
19115
19116 @item bold
19117 Use extra bright or bold mode.
19118
19119 @item bold-standout
19120 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
19121 @end table
19122 @end table
19123
19124 @node Emacs
19125 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
19126
19127 @cindex Emacs
19128 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
19129 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
19130 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
19131 @value{GDBN}.
19132
19133 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
19134 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
19135 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
19136 created Emacs buffer.
19137 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
19138
19139 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
19140 things:
19141
19142 @itemize @bullet
19143 @item
19144 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
19145 the GUD buffer.
19146
19147 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
19148 and output done by the program you are debugging.
19149
19150 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
19151 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
19152 in this way.
19153
19154 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
19155 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
19156 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
19157 stop.
19158
19159 @item
19160 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
19161
19162 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
19163 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
19164 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
19165 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
19166 and the source.
19167
19168 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
19169 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
19170 @end itemize
19171
19172 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
19173 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
19174 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
19175 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
19176
19177 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
19178 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
19179 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
19180 sets your current working directory to to the directory associated
19181 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
19182 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
19183 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
19184 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
19185 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
19186
19187 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
19188 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
19189 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
19190 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
19191
19192 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
19193 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
19194 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
19195 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
19196 one you want.
19197
19198 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
19199 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
19200
19201 @table @kbd
19202 @item C-h m
19203 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
19204
19205 @item C-c C-s
19206 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
19207 update the display window to show the current file and location.
19208
19209 @item C-c C-n
19210 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
19211 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
19212 to show the current file and location.
19213
19214 @item C-c C-i
19215 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
19216 display window accordingly.
19217
19218 @item C-c C-f
19219 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
19220 @code{finish} command.
19221
19222 @item C-c C-r
19223 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
19224 command.
19225
19226 @item C-c <
19227 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
19228 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
19229 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
19230
19231 @item C-c >
19232 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
19233 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
19234 @end table
19235
19236 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
19237 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
19238
19239 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
19240 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
19241 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
19242 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
19243 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
19244 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
19245 speedbar displays watch expressions.
19246
19247 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
19248 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
19249 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
19250 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
19251 frame.
19252
19253 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
19254 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
19255 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
19256 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
19257 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
19258 to correspond properly with the code.
19259
19260 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
19261 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
19262 Emacs Manual}).
19263
19264 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
19265 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
19266 @ignore
19267 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
19268 @kindex Epoch
19269 @kindex inspect
19270
19271 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
19272 called the @code{epoch}
19273 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
19274 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
19275 each value is printed in its own window.
19276 @end ignore
19277
19278
19279 @node GDB/MI
19280 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
19281
19282 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
19283
19284 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
19285 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
19286 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
19287 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
19288 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
19289 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
19290
19291 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
19292 in the form of a reference manual.
19293
19294 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
19295 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
19296 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
19297
19298 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
19299
19300 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
19301 This chapter uses the following notation:
19302
19303 @itemize @bullet
19304 @item
19305 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
19306
19307 @item
19308 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
19309 it may or may not be given.
19310
19311 @item
19312 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19313 may repeat zero or more times.
19314
19315 @item
19316 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
19317 may repeat one or more times.
19318
19319 @item
19320 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
19321 @end itemize
19322
19323 @ignore
19324 @heading Dependencies
19325 @end ignore
19326
19327 @menu
19328 * GDB/MI General Design::
19329 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
19330 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
19331 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
19332 * GDB/MI Output Records::
19333 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
19334 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
19335 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
19336 * GDB/MI Program Context::
19337 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
19338 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
19339 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
19340 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
19341 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
19342 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
19343 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
19344 * GDB/MI File Commands::
19345 @ignore
19346 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
19347 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
19348 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
19349 @end ignore
19350 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
19351 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
19352 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
19353 @end menu
19354
19355 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19356 @node GDB/MI General Design
19357 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
19358 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
19359
19360 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
19361 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
19362 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
19363 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
19364 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
19365 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
19366 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
19367 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
19368 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
19369 a command and reported as part of that command response.
19370
19371 The important examples of notifications are:
19372 @itemize @bullet
19373
19374 @item
19375 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
19376 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
19377 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
19378 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
19379 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
19380 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
19381 command itself was successfully executed.
19382
19383 @item
19384 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
19385 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
19386 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
19387 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
19388 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
19389 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
19390
19391 @item
19392 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
19393 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
19394 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
19395 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
19396 orthogonal frontend design.
19397
19398 @end itemize
19399
19400 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
19401 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
19402 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
19403 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
19404 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
19405 the user interface.
19406
19407 @subsection Context management
19408
19409 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
19410 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
19411 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
19412 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
19413 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
19414 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
19415 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
19416 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
19417 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
19418
19419 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
19420 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
19421 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
19422 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
19423 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
19424 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
19425 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
19426 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
19427 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
19428 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
19429 for thread and frame to operate on.
19430
19431 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
19432 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
19433 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
19434 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
19435 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
19436 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
19437 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
19438 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
19439 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
19440 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
19441
19442 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
19443 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
19444 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
19445 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
19446 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
19447 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
19448 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
19449 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
19450 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
19451 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
19452 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
19453 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
19454 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
19455 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
19456 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
19457 @samp{--frame} options.
19458
19459 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
19460
19461 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
19462 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
19463 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
19464 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
19465 @code{-gdb-set target-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
19466 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
19467 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
19468 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
19469 @code{-list-target-features} command.
19470
19471 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
19472 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
19473 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
19474 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
19475 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
19476 are running.
19477
19478 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
19479 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
19480 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
19481 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
19482 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
19483 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
19484 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
19485 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
19486 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
19487 @samp{--thread} option).
19488
19489 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
19490 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
19491 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
19492 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
19493
19494 @subsection Thread groups
19495 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
19496 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
19497 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
19498 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
19499 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
19500
19501 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
19502 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
19503 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
19504 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
19505 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
19506 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
19507 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
19508 into processes.
19509
19510 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
19511 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
19512 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
19513 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
19514 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
19515 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
19516 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
19517 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
19518 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
19519 the members of specific thread group.
19520
19521 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
19522 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
19523 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
19524 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
19525 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
19526 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
19527 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
19528 after attaching to that thread group.
19529
19530 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19531 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
19532 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
19533
19534 @menu
19535 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
19536 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
19537 @end menu
19538
19539 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
19540 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
19541
19542 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
19543 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
19544 @table @code
19545 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
19546 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
19547
19548 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
19549 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
19550 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
19551
19552 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
19553 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
19554 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
19555
19556 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19557 "any sequence of digits"
19558
19559 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
19560 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
19561
19562 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
19563 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
19564
19565 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
19566 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
19567
19568 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
19569 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
19570 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
19571
19572 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
19573 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
19574
19575 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19576 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19577 @end table
19578
19579 @noindent
19580 Notes:
19581
19582 @itemize @bullet
19583 @item
19584 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
19585 output is described below.
19586
19587 @item
19588 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
19589 finishes.
19590
19591 @item
19592 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
19593 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
19594 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
19595 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
19596 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
19597 @end itemize
19598
19599 Pragmatics:
19600
19601 @itemize @bullet
19602 @item
19603 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
19604
19605 @item
19606 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
19607 @end itemize
19608
19609 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
19610 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
19611
19612 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
19613 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
19614 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
19615 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
19616 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
19617 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
19618
19619 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
19620 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
19621 @var{token}.
19622
19623 @table @code
19624 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
19625 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
19626
19627 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
19628 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19629
19630 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
19631 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
19632
19633 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
19634 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
19635
19636 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
19637 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
19638
19639 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
19640 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
19641
19642 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
19643 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
19644
19645 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
19646 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
19647
19648 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
19649 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
19650
19651 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
19652 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
19653 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
19654
19655 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
19656 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
19657
19658 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
19659 @code{ @var{string} }
19660
19661 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
19662 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
19663
19664 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
19665 @code{@var{c-string}}
19666
19667 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
19668 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
19669
19670 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
19671 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
19672 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
19673
19674 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
19675 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
19676
19677 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
19678 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
19679
19680 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
19681 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
19682
19683 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
19684 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
19685
19686 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
19687 @code{CR | CR-LF}
19688
19689 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
19690 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
19691 @end table
19692
19693 @noindent
19694 Notes:
19695
19696 @itemize @bullet
19697 @item
19698 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
19699
19700 @item
19701 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
19702 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
19703 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
19704 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
19705 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
19706 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
19707 prior command.
19708
19709 @item
19710 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19711 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
19712 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
19713 prefixed by @samp{+}.
19714
19715 @item
19716 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19717 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
19718 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
19719 @samp{*}.
19720
19721 @item
19722 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19723 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
19724 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
19725 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
19726
19727 @item
19728 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19729 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
19730 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
19731 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
19732
19733 @item
19734 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19735 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
19736 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
19737
19738 @item
19739 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19740 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
19741 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
19742 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
19743
19744 @item
19745 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
19746 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
19747 @var{values}.
19748
19749
19750 @end itemize
19751
19752 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
19753 details about the various output records.
19754
19755 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19756 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
19757 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
19758
19759 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
19760 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
19761
19762 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
19763 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
19764 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
19765 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
19766 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
19767 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
19768
19769 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
19770 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
19771 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
19772
19773 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19774 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
19775 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
19776 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
19777
19778 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
19779 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
19780
19781 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
19782 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
19783 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
19784 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
19785 might change.
19786
19787 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
19788 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
19789 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
19790 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
19791
19792 @itemize @bullet
19793 @item
19794 New MI commands may be added.
19795
19796 @item
19797 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
19798
19799 @item
19800 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
19801 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
19802
19803 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
19804 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
19805
19806 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
19807 @c resolve inconsistencies.
19808 @end itemize
19809
19810 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
19811 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
19812 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
19813 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
19814 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
19815
19816 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
19817 @c version?
19818
19819 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
19820 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
19821 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
19822 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
19823 @cindex mailing lists
19824
19825 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
19826 @node GDB/MI Output Records
19827 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
19828
19829 @menu
19830 * GDB/MI Result Records::
19831 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
19832 * GDB/MI Async Records::
19833 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
19834 @end menu
19835
19836 @node GDB/MI Result Records
19837 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
19838
19839 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19840 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
19841 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
19842 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
19843
19844 @table @code
19845 @findex ^done
19846 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
19847 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
19848 values.
19849
19850 @item "^running"
19851 @findex ^running
19852 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
19853 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
19854 running.
19855
19856 @item "^connected"
19857 @findex ^connected
19858 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
19859
19860 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
19861 @findex ^error
19862 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
19863 error message.
19864
19865 @item "^exit"
19866 @findex ^exit
19867 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
19868
19869 @end table
19870
19871 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
19872 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
19873
19874 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
19875 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19876 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
19877 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
19878 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
19879
19880 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
19881 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
19882 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
19883 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
19884 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
19885
19886 @table @code
19887 @item "~" @var{string-output}
19888 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
19889 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
19890
19891 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
19892 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
19893 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
19894 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
19895
19896 @item "&" @var{string-output}
19897 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
19898 internals.
19899 @end table
19900
19901 @node GDB/MI Async Records
19902 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
19903
19904 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
19905 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
19906 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
19907 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
19908 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
19909 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
19910
19911 The following is the list of possible async records:
19912
19913 @table @code
19914
19915 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
19916 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
19917 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
19918 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
19919 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
19920 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
19921 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
19922 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
19923 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
19924 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
19925
19926 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}"
19927 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
19928 following values:
19929
19930 @table @code
19931 @item breakpoint-hit
19932 A breakpoint was reached.
19933 @item watchpoint-trigger
19934 A watchpoint was triggered.
19935 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
19936 A read watchpoint was triggered.
19937 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
19938 An access watchpoint was triggered.
19939 @item function-finished
19940 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19941 @item location-reached
19942 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
19943 @item watchpoint-scope
19944 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
19945 @item end-stepping-range
19946 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
19947 similar CLI command was accomplished.
19948 @item exited-signalled
19949 The inferior exited because of a signal.
19950 @item exited
19951 The inferior exited.
19952 @item exited-normally
19953 The inferior exited normally.
19954 @item signal-received
19955 A signal was received by the inferior.
19956 @end table
19957
19958 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
19959 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
19960 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
19961 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
19962 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
19963 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
19964 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
19965 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
19966 several threads in the list.
19967
19968 @item =thread-group-created,id="@var{id}"
19969 @itemx =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"
19970 A thread thread group either was attached to, or has exited/detached
19971 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
19972 thread group.
19973
19974 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19975 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
19976 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
19977 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
19978 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
19979
19980 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
19981 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
19982 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
19983 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
19984 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
19985 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
19986 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
19987
19988 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
19989 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
19990 that thread.
19991
19992 @item =library-loaded,...
19993 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
19994 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
19995 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
19996 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
19997 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
19998 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
19999 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
20000 @var{symbols-loaded} field reports if the debug symbols for this
20001 library are loaded.
20002
20003 @item =library-unloaded,...
20004 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
20005 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
20006 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification
20007
20008 @end table
20009
20010 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
20011 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
20012
20013 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
20014 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
20015 fields:
20016
20017 @table @code
20018 @item level
20019 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
20020 zero. This field is always present.
20021
20022 @item func
20023 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
20024 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
20025
20026 @item addr
20027 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
20028
20029 @item file
20030 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
20031 address. This field may be absent.
20032
20033 @item line
20034 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
20035 may be absent.
20036
20037 @item from
20038 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
20039 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
20040
20041 @end table
20042
20043
20044 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20045 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
20046 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
20047 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
20048
20049 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
20050 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
20051 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
20052 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
20053
20054 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
20055 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
20056
20057 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
20058
20059 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
20060 information of the breakpoint.
20061
20062 @smallexample
20063 -> -break-insert main
20064 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20065 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
20066 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",times="0"@}
20067 <- (gdb)
20068 @end smallexample
20069
20070 @subheading Program Execution
20071
20072 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
20073 reason that execution stopped.
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 -> -exec-run
20077 <- ^running
20078 <- (gdb)
20079 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
20080 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
20081 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
20082 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
20083 <- (gdb)
20084 -> -exec-continue
20085 <- ^running
20086 <- (gdb)
20087 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
20088 <- (gdb)
20089 @end smallexample
20090
20091 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
20092
20093 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
20094
20095 @smallexample
20096 -> (gdb)
20097 <- -gdb-exit
20098 <- ^exit
20099 @end smallexample
20100
20101 @subheading A Bad Command
20102
20103 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
20104
20105 @smallexample
20106 -> -rubbish
20107 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
20108 <- (gdb)
20109 @end smallexample
20110
20111
20112 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20113 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
20114 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
20115
20116 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
20117 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
20118
20119 @subheading Motivation
20120
20121 The motivation for this collection of commands.
20122
20123 @subheading Introduction
20124
20125 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
20126
20127 @subheading Commands
20128
20129 For each command in the block, the following is described:
20130
20131 @subsubheading Synopsis
20132
20133 @smallexample
20134 -command @var{args}@dots{}
20135 @end smallexample
20136
20137 @subsubheading Result
20138
20139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20140
20141 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
20142
20143 @subsubheading Example
20144
20145 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
20146 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
20147
20148
20149 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20150 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
20151 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
20152
20153 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
20154 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
20155 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
20156 breakpoints.
20157
20158 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
20159 @findex -break-after
20160
20161 @subsubheading Synopsis
20162
20163 @smallexample
20164 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
20165 @end smallexample
20166
20167 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
20168 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
20169 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
20170 @samp{-break-list} command below.
20171
20172 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20173
20174 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
20175
20176 @subsubheading Example
20177
20178 @smallexample
20179 (gdb)
20180 -break-insert main
20181 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
20182 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
20183 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}
20184 (gdb)
20185 -break-after 1 3
20186 ~
20187 ^done
20188 (gdb)
20189 -break-list
20190 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20191 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20192 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20193 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20194 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20195 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20196 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20197 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20198 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20199 line="5",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20200 (gdb)
20201 @end smallexample
20202
20203 @ignore
20204 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
20205 @findex -break-catch
20206
20207 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
20208 @findex -break-commands
20209 @end ignore
20210
20211
20212 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
20213 @findex -break-condition
20214
20215 @subsubheading Synopsis
20216
20217 @smallexample
20218 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
20219 @end smallexample
20220
20221 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
20222 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
20223 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
20224 command below).
20225
20226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20227
20228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
20229
20230 @subsubheading Example
20231
20232 @smallexample
20233 (gdb)
20234 -break-condition 1 1
20235 ^done
20236 (gdb)
20237 -break-list
20238 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20239 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20240 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20241 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20242 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20243 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20244 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20245 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20246 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20247 line="5",cond="1",times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
20248 (gdb)
20249 @end smallexample
20250
20251 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
20252 @findex -break-delete
20253
20254 @subsubheading Synopsis
20255
20256 @smallexample
20257 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20258 @end smallexample
20259
20260 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
20261 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
20262
20263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20264
20265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
20266
20267 @subsubheading Example
20268
20269 @smallexample
20270 (gdb)
20271 -break-delete 1
20272 ^done
20273 (gdb)
20274 -break-list
20275 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20276 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20277 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20278 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20279 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20280 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20281 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20282 body=[]@}
20283 (gdb)
20284 @end smallexample
20285
20286 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
20287 @findex -break-disable
20288
20289 @subsubheading Synopsis
20290
20291 @smallexample
20292 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20293 @end smallexample
20294
20295 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
20296 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
20297
20298 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20299
20300 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
20301
20302 @subsubheading Example
20303
20304 @smallexample
20305 (gdb)
20306 -break-disable 2
20307 ^done
20308 (gdb)
20309 -break-list
20310 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20311 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20312 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20313 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20314 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20315 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20316 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20317 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
20318 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20319 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20320 (gdb)
20321 @end smallexample
20322
20323 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
20324 @findex -break-enable
20325
20326 @subsubheading Synopsis
20327
20328 @smallexample
20329 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
20330 @end smallexample
20331
20332 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
20333
20334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20335
20336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
20337
20338 @subsubheading Example
20339
20340 @smallexample
20341 (gdb)
20342 -break-enable 2
20343 ^done
20344 (gdb)
20345 -break-list
20346 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20347 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20348 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20349 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20350 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20351 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20352 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20353 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20354 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20355 line="5",times="0"@}]@}
20356 (gdb)
20357 @end smallexample
20358
20359 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
20360 @findex -break-info
20361
20362 @subsubheading Synopsis
20363
20364 @smallexample
20365 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
20366 @end smallexample
20367
20368 @c REDUNDANT???
20369 Get information about a single breakpoint.
20370
20371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20372
20373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
20374
20375 @subsubheading Example
20376 N.A.
20377
20378 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
20379 @findex -break-insert
20380
20381 @subsubheading Synopsis
20382
20383 @smallexample
20384 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
20385 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
20386 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{location} ]
20387 @end smallexample
20388
20389 @noindent
20390 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
20391
20392 @itemize @bullet
20393 @item function
20394 @c @item +offset
20395 @c @item -offset
20396 @c @item linenum
20397 @item filename:linenum
20398 @item filename:function
20399 @item *address
20400 @end itemize
20401
20402 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
20403
20404 @table @samp
20405 @item -t
20406 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
20407 @item -h
20408 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
20409 @item -c @var{condition}
20410 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
20411 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
20412 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
20413 @item -f
20414 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
20415 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
20416 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
20417 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
20418 cannot be parsed.
20419 @item -d
20420 Create a disabled breakpoint.
20421 @end table
20422
20423 @subsubheading Result
20424
20425 The result is in the form:
20426
20427 @smallexample
20428 ^done,bkpt=@{number="@var{number}",type="@var{type}",disp="del"|"keep",
20429 enabled="y"|"n",addr="@var{hex}",func="@var{funcname}",file="@var{filename}",
20430 fullname="@var{full_filename}",line="@var{lineno}",[thread="@var{threadno},]
20431 times="@var{times}"@}
20432 @end smallexample
20433
20434 @noindent
20435 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint,
20436 @var{funcname} is the name of the function where the breakpoint was
20437 inserted, @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains
20438 this function, @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file
20439 and @var{times} the number of times that the breakpoint has been hit
20440 (always 0 for -break-insert but may be greater for -break-info or -break-list
20441 which use the same output).
20442
20443 Note: this format is open to change.
20444 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
20445
20446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20447
20448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
20449 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
20450
20451 @subsubheading Example
20452
20453 @smallexample
20454 (gdb)
20455 -break-insert main
20456 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
20457 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",times="0"@}
20458 (gdb)
20459 -break-insert -t foo
20460 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
20461 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",times="0"@}
20462 (gdb)
20463 -break-list
20464 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20465 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20466 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20467 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20468 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20469 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20470 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20471 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20472 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
20473 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",times="0"@},
20474 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
20475 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
20476 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
20477 (gdb)
20478 -break-insert -r foo.*
20479 ~int foo(int, int);
20480 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
20481 "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}
20482 (gdb)
20483 @end smallexample
20484
20485 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
20486 @findex -break-list
20487
20488 @subsubheading Synopsis
20489
20490 @smallexample
20491 -break-list
20492 @end smallexample
20493
20494 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
20495
20496 @table @samp
20497 @item Number
20498 number of the breakpoint
20499 @item Type
20500 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
20501 @item Disposition
20502 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
20503 or @samp{nokeep}
20504 @item Enabled
20505 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
20506 @item Address
20507 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
20508 @item What
20509 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
20510 name, line number
20511 @item Times
20512 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
20513 @end table
20514
20515 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
20516 @code{body} field is an empty list.
20517
20518 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20519
20520 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
20521
20522 @subsubheading Example
20523
20524 @smallexample
20525 (gdb)
20526 -break-list
20527 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20528 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20529 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20530 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20531 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20532 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20533 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20534 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20535 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
20536 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20537 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
20538 line="13",times="0"@}]@}
20539 (gdb)
20540 @end smallexample
20541
20542 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
20543
20544 @smallexample
20545 (gdb)
20546 -break-list
20547 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
20548 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20549 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20550 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20551 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20552 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20553 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20554 body=[]@}
20555 (gdb)
20556 @end smallexample
20557
20558 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
20559 @findex -break-watch
20560
20561 @subsubheading Synopsis
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
20565 @end smallexample
20566
20567 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
20568 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
20569 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
20570 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
20571 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
20572 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
20573 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
20574 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
20575
20576 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
20577 breakpoints inserted.
20578
20579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20580
20581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
20582 @samp{rwatch}.
20583
20584 @subsubheading Example
20585
20586 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
20587
20588 @smallexample
20589 (gdb)
20590 -break-watch x
20591 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
20592 (gdb)
20593 -exec-continue
20594 ^running
20595 (gdb)
20596 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
20597 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
20598 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
20599 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
20600 (gdb)
20601 @end smallexample
20602
20603 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
20604 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
20605 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
20606
20607 @smallexample
20608 (gdb)
20609 -break-watch C
20610 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
20611 (gdb)
20612 -exec-continue
20613 ^running
20614 (gdb)
20615 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
20616 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20617 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20618 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20619 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20620 (gdb)
20621 -exec-continue
20622 ^running
20623 (gdb)
20624 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
20625 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20626 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20627 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20628 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20629 (gdb)
20630 @end smallexample
20631
20632 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
20633 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
20634 deleted.
20635
20636 @smallexample
20637 (gdb)
20638 -break-watch C
20639 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
20640 (gdb)
20641 -break-list
20642 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20643 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20644 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20645 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20646 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20647 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20648 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20649 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20650 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20651 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20652 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",times="1"@},
20653 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20654 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
20655 (gdb)
20656 -exec-continue
20657 ^running
20658 (gdb)
20659 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
20660 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
20661 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
20662 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20663 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
20664 (gdb)
20665 -break-list
20666 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
20667 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20668 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20669 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20670 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20671 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20672 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20673 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20674 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20675 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20676 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
20677 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
20678 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
20679 (gdb)
20680 -exec-continue
20681 ^running
20682 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
20683 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
20684 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
20685 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20686 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
20687 (gdb)
20688 -break-list
20689 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
20690 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
20691 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
20692 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
20693 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
20694 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
20695 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
20696 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
20697 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
20698 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
20699 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
20700 times="1"@}]@}
20701 (gdb)
20702 @end smallexample
20703
20704 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20705 @node GDB/MI Program Context
20706 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
20707
20708 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
20709 @findex -exec-arguments
20710
20711
20712 @subsubheading Synopsis
20713
20714 @smallexample
20715 -exec-arguments @var{args}
20716 @end smallexample
20717
20718 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
20719 @samp{-exec-run}.
20720
20721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20722
20723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
20724
20725 @subsubheading Example
20726
20727 @smallexample
20728 (gdb)
20729 -exec-arguments -v word
20730 ^done
20731 (gdb)
20732 @end smallexample
20733
20734
20735 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
20736 @findex -exec-show-arguments
20737
20738 @subsubheading Synopsis
20739
20740 @smallexample
20741 -exec-show-arguments
20742 @end smallexample
20743
20744 Print the arguments of the program.
20745
20746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20747
20748 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
20749
20750 @subsubheading Example
20751 N.A.
20752
20753
20754 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
20755 @findex -environment-cd
20756
20757 @subsubheading Synopsis
20758
20759 @smallexample
20760 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
20761 @end smallexample
20762
20763 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
20764
20765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20766
20767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
20768
20769 @subsubheading Example
20770
20771 @smallexample
20772 (gdb)
20773 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20774 ^done
20775 (gdb)
20776 @end smallexample
20777
20778
20779 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
20780 @findex -environment-directory
20781
20782 @subsubheading Synopsis
20783
20784 @smallexample
20785 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20786 @end smallexample
20787
20788 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
20789 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
20790 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
20791 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20792 occurs as normal.
20793 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20794 multiple directories in a single command
20795 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20796 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20797 If blanks are needed as
20798 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20799 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20800 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20801 character must not be used
20802 in any directory name.
20803 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
20804
20805 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20806
20807 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
20808
20809 @subsubheading Example
20810
20811 @smallexample
20812 (gdb)
20813 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
20814 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20815 (gdb)
20816 -environment-directory ""
20817 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
20818 (gdb)
20819 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
20820 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
20821 (gdb)
20822 -environment-directory -r
20823 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
20824 (gdb)
20825 @end smallexample
20826
20827
20828 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
20829 @findex -environment-path
20830
20831 @subsubheading Synopsis
20832
20833 @smallexample
20834 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
20835 @end smallexample
20836
20837 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
20838 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
20839 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
20840 supplied in addition to the
20841 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
20842 occurs as normal.
20843 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
20844 multiple directories in a single command
20845 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
20846 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
20847 If blanks are needed as
20848 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
20849 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
20850 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
20851 character must not be used
20852 in any directory name.
20853 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
20854
20855
20856 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20857
20858 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
20859
20860 @subsubheading Example
20861
20862 @smallexample
20863 (gdb)
20864 -environment-path
20865 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
20866 (gdb)
20867 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
20868 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
20869 (gdb)
20870 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
20871 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
20872 (gdb)
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875
20876 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
20877 @findex -environment-pwd
20878
20879 @subsubheading Synopsis
20880
20881 @smallexample
20882 -environment-pwd
20883 @end smallexample
20884
20885 Show the current working directory.
20886
20887 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20888
20889 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
20890
20891 @subsubheading Example
20892
20893 @smallexample
20894 (gdb)
20895 -environment-pwd
20896 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
20897 (gdb)
20898 @end smallexample
20899
20900 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
20901 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
20902 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
20903
20904
20905 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
20906 @findex -thread-info
20907
20908 @subsubheading Synopsis
20909
20910 @smallexample
20911 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
20912 @end smallexample
20913
20914 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
20915 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
20916 threads. When printing information about all threads,
20917 also reports the current thread.
20918
20919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20920
20921 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
20922 about all threads.
20923
20924 @subsubheading Example
20925
20926 @smallexample
20927 -thread-info
20928 ^done,threads=[
20929 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
20930 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
20931 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
20932 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
20933 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}],
20934 current-thread-id="1"
20935 (gdb)
20936 @end smallexample
20937
20938 The @samp{state} field may have the following values:
20939
20940 @table @code
20941 @item stopped
20942 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
20943 threads.
20944
20945 @item running
20946 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
20947 threads.
20948
20949 @end table
20950
20951 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
20952 @findex -thread-list-ids
20953
20954 @subsubheading Synopsis
20955
20956 @smallexample
20957 -thread-list-ids
20958 @end smallexample
20959
20960 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
20961 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
20962
20963 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
20964 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
20965
20966 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20967
20968 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
20969
20970 @subsubheading Example
20971
20972 @smallexample
20973 (gdb)
20974 -thread-list-ids
20975 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
20976 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
20977 (gdb)
20978 @end smallexample
20979
20980
20981 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
20982 @findex -thread-select
20983
20984 @subsubheading Synopsis
20985
20986 @smallexample
20987 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
20988 @end smallexample
20989
20990 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
20991 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
20992
20993 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
20994 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
20995
20996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
20997
20998 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
20999
21000 @subsubheading Example
21001
21002 @smallexample
21003 (gdb)
21004 -exec-next
21005 ^running
21006 (gdb)
21007 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
21008 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
21009 (gdb)
21010 -thread-list-ids
21011 ^done,
21012 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
21013 number-of-threads="3"
21014 (gdb)
21015 -thread-select 3
21016 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
21017 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
21018 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
21019 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
21020 (gdb)
21021 @end smallexample
21022
21023 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21024 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
21025 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
21026
21027 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
21028 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
21029 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
21030 other cases.
21031
21032 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
21033 @findex -exec-continue
21034
21035 @subsubheading Synopsis
21036
21037 @smallexample
21038 -exec-continue [--all|--thread-group N]
21039 @end smallexample
21040
21041 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until a breakpoint is
21042 encountered, or until the inferior exits. In all-stop mode
21043 (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads,
21044 depending on the value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. In
21045 non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}), if the @samp{--all} is not
21046 specified, only the thread specified with the @samp{--thread} option
21047 (or current thread, if no @samp{--thread} is provided) is resumed. If
21048 @samp{--all} is specified, all threads will be resumed. The
21049 @samp{--all} option is ignored in all-stop mode. If the
21050 @samp{--thread-group} options is specified, then all threads in that
21051 thread group are resumed.
21052
21053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21054
21055 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
21056
21057 @subsubheading Example
21058
21059 @smallexample
21060 -exec-continue
21061 ^running
21062 (gdb)
21063 @@Hello world
21064 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
21065 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
21066 line="13"@}
21067 (gdb)
21068 @end smallexample
21069
21070
21071 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
21072 @findex -exec-finish
21073
21074 @subsubheading Synopsis
21075
21076 @smallexample
21077 -exec-finish
21078 @end smallexample
21079
21080 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
21081 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
21082
21083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21084
21085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
21086
21087 @subsubheading Example
21088
21089 Function returning @code{void}.
21090
21091 @smallexample
21092 -exec-finish
21093 ^running
21094 (gdb)
21095 @@hello from foo
21096 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21097 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
21098 (gdb)
21099 @end smallexample
21100
21101 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
21102 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
21103 value itself.
21104
21105 @smallexample
21106 -exec-finish
21107 ^running
21108 (gdb)
21109 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
21110 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
21111 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21112 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
21113 (gdb)
21114 @end smallexample
21115
21116
21117 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
21118 @findex -exec-interrupt
21119
21120 @subsubheading Synopsis
21121
21122 @smallexample
21123 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
21124 @end smallexample
21125
21126 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
21127 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
21128 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
21129 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
21130 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
21131
21132 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
21133 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
21134 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
21135 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
21136
21137 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
21138 All threads will be interrupted if the @samp{--all} option is
21139 specified. If the @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, all
21140 threads in that group will be interrupted.
21141
21142 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21143
21144 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
21145
21146 @subsubheading Example
21147
21148 @smallexample
21149 (gdb)
21150 111-exec-continue
21151 111^running
21152
21153 (gdb)
21154 222-exec-interrupt
21155 222^done
21156 (gdb)
21157 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
21158 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21159 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
21160 (gdb)
21161
21162 (gdb)
21163 -exec-interrupt
21164 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
21165 (gdb)
21166 @end smallexample
21167
21168
21169 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
21170 @findex -exec-next
21171
21172 @subsubheading Synopsis
21173
21174 @smallexample
21175 -exec-next
21176 @end smallexample
21177
21178 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21179 of the next source line is reached.
21180
21181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21182
21183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
21184
21185 @subsubheading Example
21186
21187 @smallexample
21188 -exec-next
21189 ^running
21190 (gdb)
21191 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
21192 (gdb)
21193 @end smallexample
21194
21195
21196 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
21197 @findex -exec-next-instruction
21198
21199 @subsubheading Synopsis
21200
21201 @smallexample
21202 -exec-next-instruction
21203 @end smallexample
21204
21205 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
21206 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
21207 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
21208 printed as well.
21209
21210 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21211
21212 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
21213
21214 @subsubheading Example
21215
21216 @smallexample
21217 (gdb)
21218 -exec-next-instruction
21219 ^running
21220
21221 (gdb)
21222 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21223 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
21224 (gdb)
21225 @end smallexample
21226
21227
21228 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
21229 @findex -exec-return
21230
21231 @subsubheading Synopsis
21232
21233 @smallexample
21234 -exec-return
21235 @end smallexample
21236
21237 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
21238 Displays the new current frame.
21239
21240 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21241
21242 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
21243
21244 @subsubheading Example
21245
21246 @smallexample
21247 (gdb)
21248 200-break-insert callee4
21249 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
21250 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21251 (gdb)
21252 000-exec-run
21253 000^running
21254 (gdb)
21255 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21256 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
21257 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21258 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
21259 (gdb)
21260 205-break-delete
21261 205^done
21262 (gdb)
21263 111-exec-return
21264 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
21265 args=[@{name="strarg",
21266 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
21267 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21268 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
21269 (gdb)
21270 @end smallexample
21271
21272
21273 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
21274 @findex -exec-run
21275
21276 @subsubheading Synopsis
21277
21278 @smallexample
21279 -exec-run
21280 @end smallexample
21281
21282 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
21283 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
21284 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
21285 the program has exited exceptionally.
21286
21287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21288
21289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
21290
21291 @subsubheading Examples
21292
21293 @smallexample
21294 (gdb)
21295 -break-insert main
21296 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21297 (gdb)
21298 -exec-run
21299 ^running
21300 (gdb)
21301 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
21302 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
21303 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
21304 (gdb)
21305 @end smallexample
21306
21307 @noindent
21308 Program exited normally:
21309
21310 @smallexample
21311 (gdb)
21312 -exec-run
21313 ^running
21314 (gdb)
21315 x = 55
21316 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
21317 (gdb)
21318 @end smallexample
21319
21320 @noindent
21321 Program exited exceptionally:
21322
21323 @smallexample
21324 (gdb)
21325 -exec-run
21326 ^running
21327 (gdb)
21328 x = 55
21329 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
21330 (gdb)
21331 @end smallexample
21332
21333 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
21334 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
21335
21336 @smallexample
21337 (gdb)
21338 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
21339 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
21340 @end smallexample
21341
21342
21343 @c @subheading -exec-signal
21344
21345
21346 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
21347 @findex -exec-step
21348
21349 @subsubheading Synopsis
21350
21351 @smallexample
21352 -exec-step
21353 @end smallexample
21354
21355 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
21356 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
21357 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
21358 function.
21359
21360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21361
21362 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
21363
21364 @subsubheading Example
21365
21366 Stepping into a function:
21367
21368 @smallexample
21369 -exec-step
21370 ^running
21371 (gdb)
21372 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21373 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
21374 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
21375 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
21376 (gdb)
21377 @end smallexample
21378
21379 Regular stepping:
21380
21381 @smallexample
21382 -exec-step
21383 ^running
21384 (gdb)
21385 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
21386 (gdb)
21387 @end smallexample
21388
21389
21390 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
21391 @findex -exec-step-instruction
21392
21393 @subsubheading Synopsis
21394
21395 @smallexample
21396 -exec-step-instruction
21397 @end smallexample
21398
21399 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. The
21400 output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on whether
21401 we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the former
21402 case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
21403 well.
21404
21405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21406
21407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
21408
21409 @subsubheading Example
21410
21411 @smallexample
21412 (gdb)
21413 -exec-step-instruction
21414 ^running
21415
21416 (gdb)
21417 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21418 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21419 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21420 (gdb)
21421 -exec-step-instruction
21422 ^running
21423
21424 (gdb)
21425 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
21426 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
21427 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
21428 (gdb)
21429 @end smallexample
21430
21431
21432 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
21433 @findex -exec-until
21434
21435 @subsubheading Synopsis
21436
21437 @smallexample
21438 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
21439 @end smallexample
21440
21441 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
21442 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
21443 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
21444 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
21445
21446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21447
21448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
21449
21450 @subsubheading Example
21451
21452 @smallexample
21453 (gdb)
21454 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
21455 ^running
21456 (gdb)
21457 x = 55
21458 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
21459 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
21460 (gdb)
21461 @end smallexample
21462
21463 @ignore
21464 @subheading -file-clear
21465 Is this going away????
21466 @end ignore
21467
21468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21469 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
21470 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
21471
21472
21473 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
21474 @findex -stack-info-frame
21475
21476 @subsubheading Synopsis
21477
21478 @smallexample
21479 -stack-info-frame
21480 @end smallexample
21481
21482 Get info on the selected frame.
21483
21484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21485
21486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
21487 (without arguments).
21488
21489 @subsubheading Example
21490
21491 @smallexample
21492 (gdb)
21493 -stack-info-frame
21494 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21495 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21496 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
21497 (gdb)
21498 @end smallexample
21499
21500 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
21501 @findex -stack-info-depth
21502
21503 @subsubheading Synopsis
21504
21505 @smallexample
21506 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
21507 @end smallexample
21508
21509 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
21510 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
21511
21512 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21513
21514 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
21515
21516 @subsubheading Example
21517
21518 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
21519
21520 @smallexample
21521 (gdb)
21522 -stack-info-depth
21523 ^done,depth="12"
21524 (gdb)
21525 -stack-info-depth 4
21526 ^done,depth="4"
21527 (gdb)
21528 -stack-info-depth 12
21529 ^done,depth="12"
21530 (gdb)
21531 -stack-info-depth 11
21532 ^done,depth="11"
21533 (gdb)
21534 -stack-info-depth 13
21535 ^done,depth="12"
21536 (gdb)
21537 @end smallexample
21538
21539 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
21540 @findex -stack-list-arguments
21541
21542 @subsubheading Synopsis
21543
21544 @smallexample
21545 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
21546 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21547 @end smallexample
21548
21549 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
21550 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
21551 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
21552 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
21553 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
21554 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
21555 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
21556 which case only existing frames will be returned.
21557
21558 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
21559 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
21560 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
21561
21562 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21563
21564 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
21565 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
21566 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
21567
21568 @subsubheading Example
21569
21570 @smallexample
21571 (gdb)
21572 -stack-list-frames
21573 ^done,
21574 stack=[
21575 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
21576 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21577 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
21578 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
21579 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21580 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
21581 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
21582 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21583 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
21584 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
21585 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21586 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
21587 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
21588 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
21589 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
21590 (gdb)
21591 -stack-list-arguments 0
21592 ^done,
21593 stack-args=[
21594 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21595 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
21596 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
21597 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
21598 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21599 (gdb)
21600 -stack-list-arguments 1
21601 ^done,
21602 stack-args=[
21603 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
21604 frame=@{level="1",
21605 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21606 frame=@{level="2",args=[
21607 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21608 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
21609 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
21610 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21611 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
21612 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
21613 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
21614 (gdb)
21615 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
21616 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
21617 (gdb)
21618 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
21619 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
21620 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
21621 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
21622 (gdb)
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
21626
21627
21628 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
21629 @findex -stack-list-frames
21630
21631 @subsubheading Synopsis
21632
21633 @smallexample
21634 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
21635 @end smallexample
21636
21637 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
21638 following info:
21639
21640 @table @samp
21641 @item @var{level}
21642 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
21643 @item @var{addr}
21644 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
21645 @item @var{func}
21646 Function name.
21647 @item @var{file}
21648 File name of the source file where the function lives.
21649 @item @var{line}
21650 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
21651 @end table
21652
21653 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
21654 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
21655 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
21656 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
21657 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
21658 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
21659 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be returned.
21660
21661 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21662
21663 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
21664
21665 @subsubheading Example
21666
21667 Full stack backtrace:
21668
21669 @smallexample
21670 (gdb)
21671 -stack-list-frames
21672 ^done,stack=
21673 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
21674 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
21675 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21676 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21677 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21678 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21679 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21680 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21681 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21682 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21683 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21684 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21685 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21686 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21687 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21688 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21689 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21690 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21691 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21692 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21693 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21694 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21695 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
21696 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
21697 (gdb)
21698 @end smallexample
21699
21700 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
21701
21702 @smallexample
21703 (gdb)
21704 -stack-list-frames 3 5
21705 ^done,stack=
21706 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21707 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21708 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21709 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
21710 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21711 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21712 (gdb)
21713 @end smallexample
21714
21715 Show a single frame:
21716
21717 @smallexample
21718 (gdb)
21719 -stack-list-frames 3 3
21720 ^done,stack=
21721 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
21722 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
21723 (gdb)
21724 @end smallexample
21725
21726
21727 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
21728 @findex -stack-list-locals
21729
21730 @subsubheading Synopsis
21731
21732 @smallexample
21733 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
21734 @end smallexample
21735
21736 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
21737 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
21738 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
21739 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
21740 type and value for simple data types and the name and type for arrays,
21741 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
21742 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
21743 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
21744 more detail.
21745
21746 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21747
21748 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
21749
21750 @subsubheading Example
21751
21752 @smallexample
21753 (gdb)
21754 -stack-list-locals 0
21755 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
21756 (gdb)
21757 -stack-list-locals --all-values
21758 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
21759 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
21760 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
21761 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
21762 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
21763 (gdb)
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766
21767 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
21768 @findex -stack-select-frame
21769
21770 @subsubheading Synopsis
21771
21772 @smallexample
21773 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
21774 @end smallexample
21775
21776 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
21777 the stack.
21778
21779 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
21780 option to every command.
21781
21782 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
21783
21784 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
21785 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
21786
21787 @subsubheading Example
21788
21789 @smallexample
21790 (gdb)
21791 -stack-select-frame 2
21792 ^done
21793 (gdb)
21794 @end smallexample
21795
21796 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
21797 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
21798 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
21799
21800 @ignore
21801
21802 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21803
21804 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
21805 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
21806 used by @code{Insight}.
21807
21808 The two main reasons for that are:
21809
21810 @enumerate 1
21811 @item
21812 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
21813
21814 @item
21815 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
21816 now).
21817 @end enumerate
21818
21819 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
21820 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
21821 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
21822 hints about their use.
21823
21824 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
21825 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
21826 least, the following operations:
21827
21828 @itemize @bullet
21829 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
21830 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
21831 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
21832 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
21833 @end itemize
21834
21835 @end ignore
21836
21837 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
21838
21839 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
21840
21841 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
21842 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
21843 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
21844 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
21845 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
21846 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
21847 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
21848 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
21849 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
21850 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
21851 object, or to change display format.
21852
21853 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
21854 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
21855 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
21856 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
21857 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
21858 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
21859 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
21860 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
21861 child will be created.
21862
21863 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
21864 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
21865 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
21866 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
21867 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
21868
21869 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
21870 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
21871 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
21872 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
21873 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
21874 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
21875 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
21876 variables that frontend has created.
21877
21878 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
21879 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
21880 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
21881 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
21882 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
21883 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
21884 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
21885 implicitly updated.
21886
21887 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
21888 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
21889 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
21890 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
21891 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
21892 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
21893 frame. Consider this example:
21894
21895 @smallexample
21896 void do_work(...)
21897 @{
21898 struct work_state state;
21899
21900 if (...)
21901 do_work(...);
21902 @}
21903 @end smallexample
21904
21905 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
21906 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the the variable
21907 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
21908 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
21909 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
21910
21911 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
21912 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
21913 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
21914 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
21915 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
21916 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
21917
21918 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
21919 access this functionality:
21920
21921 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
21922 @item @strong{Operation}
21923 @tab @strong{Description}
21924
21925 @item @code{-var-create}
21926 @tab create a variable object
21927 @item @code{-var-delete}
21928 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
21929 @item @code{-var-set-format}
21930 @tab set the display format of this variable
21931 @item @code{-var-show-format}
21932 @tab show the display format of this variable
21933 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
21934 @tab tells how many children this object has
21935 @item @code{-var-list-children}
21936 @tab return a list of the object's children
21937 @item @code{-var-info-type}
21938 @tab show the type of this variable object
21939 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
21940 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
21941 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
21942 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
21943 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
21944 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
21945 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
21946 @tab get the value of this variable
21947 @item @code{-var-assign}
21948 @tab set the value of this variable
21949 @item @code{-var-update}
21950 @tab update the variable and its children
21951 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
21952 @tab set frozeness attribute
21953 @end multitable
21954
21955 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
21956 how it can be used.
21957
21958 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
21959
21960 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
21961 @findex -var-create
21962
21963 @subsubheading Synopsis
21964
21965 @smallexample
21966 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
21967 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
21968 @end smallexample
21969
21970 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
21971 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
21972 register.
21973
21974 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
21975 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
21976 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
21977 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
21978 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
21979
21980 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
21981 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
21982 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
21983 object must be created.
21984
21985 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
21986 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
21987
21988 @itemize @bullet
21989 @item
21990 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
21991
21992 @item
21993 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
21994
21995 @item
21996 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
21997 @end itemize
21998
21999 @subsubheading Result
22000
22001 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
22002 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
22003 the @value{GDBN} CLI. If a fixed variable object is bound to a
22004 specific thread, the thread is is also printed:
22005
22006 @smallexample
22007 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}"
22008 @end smallexample
22009
22010
22011 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
22012 @findex -var-delete
22013
22014 @subsubheading Synopsis
22015
22016 @smallexample
22017 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
22018 @end smallexample
22019
22020 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
22021 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
22022
22023 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
22024
22025
22026 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
22027 @findex -var-set-format
22028
22029 @subsubheading Synopsis
22030
22031 @smallexample
22032 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
22033 @end smallexample
22034
22035 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
22036 @var{format-spec}.
22037
22038 @anchor{-var-set-format}
22039 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
22040
22041 @smallexample
22042 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
22043 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
22044 @end smallexample
22045
22046 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
22047 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
22048 for pointers, etc.).
22049
22050 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
22051 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
22052
22053 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
22054 @findex -var-show-format
22055
22056 @subsubheading Synopsis
22057
22058 @smallexample
22059 -var-show-format @var{name}
22060 @end smallexample
22061
22062 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
22063
22064 @smallexample
22065 @var{format} @expansion{}
22066 @var{format-spec}
22067 @end smallexample
22068
22069
22070 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
22071 @findex -var-info-num-children
22072
22073 @subsubheading Synopsis
22074
22075 @smallexample
22076 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
22077 @end smallexample
22078
22079 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
22080
22081 @smallexample
22082 numchild=@var{n}
22083 @end smallexample
22084
22085
22086 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
22087 @findex -var-list-children
22088
22089 @subsubheading Synopsis
22090
22091 @smallexample
22092 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name}
22093 @end smallexample
22094 @anchor{-var-list-children}
22095
22096 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
22097 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
22098 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value for of 0 or
22099 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
22100 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
22101 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
22102 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
22103 and unions.
22104
22105 @subsubheading Example
22106
22107 @smallexample
22108 (gdb)
22109 -var-list-children n
22110 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22111 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22112 (gdb)
22113 -var-list-children --all-values n
22114 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
22115 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
22116 @end smallexample
22117
22118
22119 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
22120 @findex -var-info-type
22121
22122 @subsubheading Synopsis
22123
22124 @smallexample
22125 -var-info-type @var{name}
22126 @end smallexample
22127
22128 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
22129 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
22130 @value{GDBN} CLI:
22131
22132 @smallexample
22133 type=@var{typename}
22134 @end smallexample
22135
22136
22137 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
22138 @findex -var-info-expression
22139
22140 @subsubheading Synopsis
22141
22142 @smallexample
22143 -var-info-expression @var{name}
22144 @end smallexample
22145
22146 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
22147 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
22148 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
22149
22150 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
22151 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
22152
22153 @smallexample
22154 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
22155 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
22156 @end smallexample
22157
22158 @noindent
22159 Here, the values of @code{lang} can be @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
22160
22161 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
22162 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
22163 is of limited use.
22164
22165 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
22166 @findex -var-info-path-expression
22167
22168 @subsubheading Synopsis
22169
22170 @smallexample
22171 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
22172 @end smallexample
22173
22174 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
22175 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
22176 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
22177 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
22178 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
22179 watchpoint from a variable object.
22180
22181 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
22182 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
22183 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
22184 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
22185 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
22186 @smallexample
22187 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
22188 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
22189 @end smallexample
22190
22191 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
22192 @findex -var-show-attributes
22193
22194 @subsubheading Synopsis
22195
22196 @smallexample
22197 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
22198 @end smallexample
22199
22200 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
22201
22202 @smallexample
22203 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
22204 @end smallexample
22205
22206 @noindent
22207 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
22208
22209 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
22210 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
22211
22212 @subsubheading Synopsis
22213
22214 @smallexample
22215 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
22216 @end smallexample
22217
22218 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
22219 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
22220 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
22221 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
22222 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
22223 the current display format will be used. The current display format
22224 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
22225
22226 @smallexample
22227 value=@var{value}
22228 @end smallexample
22229
22230 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
22231 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
22232
22233 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
22234 @findex -var-assign
22235
22236 @subsubheading Synopsis
22237
22238 @smallexample
22239 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
22240 @end smallexample
22241
22242 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
22243 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
22244 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
22245 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
22246
22247 @subsubheading Example
22248
22249 @smallexample
22250 (gdb)
22251 -var-assign var1 3
22252 ^done,value="3"
22253 (gdb)
22254 -var-update *
22255 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
22256 (gdb)
22257 @end smallexample
22258
22259 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
22260 @findex -var-update
22261
22262 @subsubheading Synopsis
22263
22264 @smallexample
22265 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
22266 @end smallexample
22267
22268 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
22269 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
22270 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
22271 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
22272 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
22273 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
22274 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
22275 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
22276 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
22277 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
22278 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
22279 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
22280 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
22281
22282 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
22283 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
22284 diagnostic.
22285
22286 @subsubheading Example
22287
22288 @smallexample
22289 (gdb)
22290 -var-assign var1 3
22291 ^done,value="3"
22292 (gdb)
22293 -var-update --all-values var1
22294 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
22295 type_changed="false"@}]
22296 (gdb)
22297 @end smallexample
22298
22299 @anchor{-var-update}
22300 The field in_scope may take three values:
22301
22302 @table @code
22303 @item "true"
22304 The variable object's current value is valid.
22305
22306 @item "false"
22307 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
22308 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
22309 scope.
22310
22311 @item "invalid"
22312 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
22313 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
22314 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
22315 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
22316 objects.
22317 @end table
22318
22319 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
22320 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
22321
22322 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
22323 @findex -var-set-frozen
22324 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
22325
22326 @subsubheading Synopsis
22327
22328 @smallexample
22329 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
22330 @end smallexample
22331
22332 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
22333 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
22334 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
22335 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
22336 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
22337 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
22338 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
22339 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
22340 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
22341 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
22342 @code{-var-update} does.
22343
22344 @subsubheading Example
22345
22346 @smallexample
22347 (gdb)
22348 -var-set-frozen V 1
22349 ^done
22350 (gdb)
22351 @end smallexample
22352
22353
22354 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22355 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
22356 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
22357
22358 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
22359 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
22360 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
22361 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
22362
22363 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
22364 @c @subheading -data-assign
22365 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
22366 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
22367 @c set variable
22368 @c @subsubheading Example
22369 @c N.A.
22370
22371 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
22372 @findex -data-disassemble
22373
22374 @subsubheading Synopsis
22375
22376 @smallexample
22377 -data-disassemble
22378 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
22379 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
22380 -- @var{mode}
22381 @end smallexample
22382
22383 @noindent
22384 Where:
22385
22386 @table @samp
22387 @item @var{start-addr}
22388 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
22389 @item @var{end-addr}
22390 is the end address
22391 @item @var{filename}
22392 is the name of the file to disassemble
22393 @item @var{linenum}
22394 is the line number to disassemble around
22395 @item @var{lines}
22396 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
22397 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
22398 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
22399 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
22400 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
22401 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
22402 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
22403 are displayed.
22404 @item @var{mode}
22405 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
22406 disassembly).
22407 @end table
22408
22409 @subsubheading Result
22410
22411 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
22412
22413 @itemize @bullet
22414 @item Address
22415 @item Func-name
22416 @item Offset
22417 @item Instruction
22418 @end itemize
22419
22420 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
22421 directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to adjust its format.
22422
22423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22424
22425 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
22426
22427 @subsubheading Example
22428
22429 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
22430
22431 @smallexample
22432 (gdb)
22433 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
22434 ^done,
22435 asm_insns=[
22436 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22437 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22438 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22439 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22440 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
22441 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
22442 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
22443 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22444 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
22445 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
22446 (gdb)
22447 @end smallexample
22448
22449 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
22450 @code{main}.
22451
22452 @smallexample
22453 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
22454 ^done,asm_insns=[
22455 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22456 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22457 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22458 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22459 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22460 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
22461 [@dots{}]
22462 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
22463 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
22464 (gdb)
22465 @end smallexample
22466
22467 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
22468
22469 @smallexample
22470 (gdb)
22471 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
22472 ^done,asm_insns=[
22473 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22474 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
22475 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22476 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22477 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22478 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
22479 (gdb)
22480 @end smallexample
22481
22482 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
22483
22484 @smallexample
22485 (gdb)
22486 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
22487 ^done,asm_insns=[
22488 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
22489 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22490 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22491 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
22492 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
22493 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
22494 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
22495 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
22496 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
22497 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
22498 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
22499 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
22500 (gdb)
22501 @end smallexample
22502
22503
22504 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
22505 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
22506
22507 @subsubheading Synopsis
22508
22509 @smallexample
22510 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
22511 @end smallexample
22512
22513 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
22514 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
22515 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
22516
22517 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22518
22519 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
22520 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
22521 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
22522
22523 @subsubheading Example
22524
22525 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
22526 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
22527 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
22528 output.
22529
22530 @smallexample
22531 211-data-evaluate-expression A
22532 211^done,value="1"
22533 (gdb)
22534 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
22535 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
22536 (gdb)
22537 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
22538 411^done,value="4"
22539 (gdb)
22540 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
22541 511^done,value="4"
22542 (gdb)
22543 @end smallexample
22544
22545
22546 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
22547 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
22548
22549 @subsubheading Synopsis
22550
22551 @smallexample
22552 -data-list-changed-registers
22553 @end smallexample
22554
22555 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
22556
22557 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22558
22559 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
22560 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
22561
22562 @subsubheading Example
22563
22564 On a PPC MBX board:
22565
22566 @smallexample
22567 (gdb)
22568 -exec-continue
22569 ^running
22570
22571 (gdb)
22572 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
22573 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
22574 line="5"@}
22575 (gdb)
22576 -data-list-changed-registers
22577 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
22578 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
22579 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
22580 (gdb)
22581 @end smallexample
22582
22583
22584 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
22585 @findex -data-list-register-names
22586
22587 @subsubheading Synopsis
22588
22589 @smallexample
22590 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
22591 @end smallexample
22592
22593 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
22594 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
22595 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
22596 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
22597 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
22598 include empty register names.
22599
22600 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22601
22602 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
22603 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
22604 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
22605
22606 @subsubheading Example
22607
22608 For the PPC MBX board:
22609 @smallexample
22610 (gdb)
22611 -data-list-register-names
22612 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
22613 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
22614 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
22615 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
22616 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
22617 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
22618 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
22619 (gdb)
22620 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
22621 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
22622 (gdb)
22623 @end smallexample
22624
22625 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
22626 @findex -data-list-register-values
22627
22628 @subsubheading Synopsis
22629
22630 @smallexample
22631 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
22632 @end smallexample
22633
22634 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
22635 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
22636 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
22637 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
22638
22639 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
22640
22641 @table @code
22642 @item x
22643 Hexadecimal
22644 @item o
22645 Octal
22646 @item t
22647 Binary
22648 @item d
22649 Decimal
22650 @item r
22651 Raw
22652 @item N
22653 Natural
22654 @end table
22655
22656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22657
22658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
22659 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
22660
22661 @subsubheading Example
22662
22663 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
22664 don't appear in the actual output):
22665
22666 @smallexample
22667 (gdb)
22668 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
22669 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22670 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
22671 (gdb)
22672 -data-list-register-values x
22673 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
22674 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22675 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
22676 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
22677 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
22678 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
22679 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
22680 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
22681 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
22682 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
22683 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
22684 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
22685 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
22686 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
22687 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
22688 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
22689 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
22690 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
22691 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
22692 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
22693 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
22694 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
22695 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
22696 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
22697 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
22698 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
22699 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
22700 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
22701 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
22702 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
22703 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
22704 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
22705 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
22706 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
22707 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
22708 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
22709 (gdb)
22710 @end smallexample
22711
22712
22713 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
22714 @findex -data-read-memory
22715
22716 @subsubheading Synopsis
22717
22718 @smallexample
22719 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
22720 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
22721 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
22722 @end smallexample
22723
22724 @noindent
22725 where:
22726
22727 @table @samp
22728 @item @var{address}
22729 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
22730 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
22731 quoted using the C convention.
22732
22733 @item @var{word-format}
22734 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
22735 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
22736 ,Output Formats}).
22737
22738 @item @var{word-size}
22739 The size of each memory word in bytes.
22740
22741 @item @var{nr-rows}
22742 The number of rows in the output table.
22743
22744 @item @var{nr-cols}
22745 The number of columns in the output table.
22746
22747 @item @var{aschar}
22748 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
22749 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
22750 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
22751 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
22752
22753 @item @var{byte-offset}
22754 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
22755 @end table
22756
22757 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
22758 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
22759 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
22760 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
22761 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
22762 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
22763 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
22764 @samp{addr}.
22765
22766 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
22767 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
22768 @samp{prev-page}.
22769
22770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22771
22772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
22773 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
22774
22775 @subsubheading Example
22776
22777 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
22778 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
22779 word. Display each word in hex.
22780
22781 @smallexample
22782 (gdb)
22783 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
22784 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
22785 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
22786 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
22787 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
22788 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
22789 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
22790 (gdb)
22791 @end smallexample
22792
22793 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
22794 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
22795
22796 @smallexample
22797 (gdb)
22798 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
22799 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
22800 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
22801 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
22802 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
22803 (gdb)
22804 @end smallexample
22805
22806 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
22807 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
22808 used as the non-printable character.
22809
22810 @smallexample
22811 (gdb)
22812 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
22813 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
22814 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
22815 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
22816 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22817 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22818 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22819 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
22820 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
22821 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
22822 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
22823 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
22824 (gdb)
22825 @end smallexample
22826
22827 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22828 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
22829 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
22830
22831 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
22832
22833 @c @subheading -trace-actions
22834
22835 @c @subheading -trace-delete
22836
22837 @c @subheading -trace-disable
22838
22839 @c @subheading -trace-dump
22840
22841 @c @subheading -trace-enable
22842
22843 @c @subheading -trace-exists
22844
22845 @c @subheading -trace-find
22846
22847 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
22848
22849 @c @subheading -trace-info
22850
22851 @c @subheading -trace-insert
22852
22853 @c @subheading -trace-list
22854
22855 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
22856
22857 @c @subheading -trace-save
22858
22859 @c @subheading -trace-start
22860
22861 @c @subheading -trace-stop
22862
22863
22864 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
22865 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
22866 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
22867
22868
22869 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
22870 @findex -symbol-info-address
22871
22872 @subsubheading Synopsis
22873
22874 @smallexample
22875 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
22876 @end smallexample
22877
22878 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
22879
22880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22881
22882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
22883
22884 @subsubheading Example
22885 N.A.
22886
22887
22888 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
22889 @findex -symbol-info-file
22890
22891 @subsubheading Synopsis
22892
22893 @smallexample
22894 -symbol-info-file
22895 @end smallexample
22896
22897 Show the file for the symbol.
22898
22899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22900
22901 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
22902 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
22903
22904 @subsubheading Example
22905 N.A.
22906
22907
22908 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
22909 @findex -symbol-info-function
22910
22911 @subsubheading Synopsis
22912
22913 @smallexample
22914 -symbol-info-function
22915 @end smallexample
22916
22917 Show which function the symbol lives in.
22918
22919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22920
22921 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
22922
22923 @subsubheading Example
22924 N.A.
22925
22926
22927 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
22928 @findex -symbol-info-line
22929
22930 @subsubheading Synopsis
22931
22932 @smallexample
22933 -symbol-info-line
22934 @end smallexample
22935
22936 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
22937
22938 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22939
22940 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
22941 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
22942
22943 @subsubheading Example
22944 N.A.
22945
22946
22947 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
22948 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
22949
22950 @subsubheading Synopsis
22951
22952 @smallexample
22953 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
22954 @end smallexample
22955
22956 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
22957
22958 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22959
22960 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
22961
22962 @subsubheading Example
22963 N.A.
22964
22965
22966 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
22967 @findex -symbol-list-functions
22968
22969 @subsubheading Synopsis
22970
22971 @smallexample
22972 -symbol-list-functions
22973 @end smallexample
22974
22975 List the functions in the executable.
22976
22977 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
22978
22979 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
22980 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
22981
22982 @subsubheading Example
22983 N.A.
22984
22985
22986 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
22987 @findex -symbol-list-lines
22988
22989 @subsubheading Synopsis
22990
22991 @smallexample
22992 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
22993 @end smallexample
22994
22995 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
22996 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
22997 ascending PC order.
22998
22999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23000
23001 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
23002
23003 @subsubheading Example
23004 @smallexample
23005 (gdb)
23006 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
23007 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
23008 (gdb)
23009 @end smallexample
23010
23011
23012 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
23013 @findex -symbol-list-types
23014
23015 @subsubheading Synopsis
23016
23017 @smallexample
23018 -symbol-list-types
23019 @end smallexample
23020
23021 List all the type names.
23022
23023 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23024
23025 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
23026 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23027
23028 @subsubheading Example
23029 N.A.
23030
23031
23032 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
23033 @findex -symbol-list-variables
23034
23035 @subsubheading Synopsis
23036
23037 @smallexample
23038 -symbol-list-variables
23039 @end smallexample
23040
23041 List all the global and static variable names.
23042
23043 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23044
23045 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
23046
23047 @subsubheading Example
23048 N.A.
23049
23050
23051 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
23052 @findex -symbol-locate
23053
23054 @subsubheading Synopsis
23055
23056 @smallexample
23057 -symbol-locate
23058 @end smallexample
23059
23060 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23061
23062 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
23063
23064 @subsubheading Example
23065 N.A.
23066
23067
23068 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
23069 @findex -symbol-type
23070
23071 @subsubheading Synopsis
23072
23073 @smallexample
23074 -symbol-type @var{variable}
23075 @end smallexample
23076
23077 Show type of @var{variable}.
23078
23079 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23080
23081 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
23082 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
23083
23084 @subsubheading Example
23085 N.A.
23086
23087
23088 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23089 @node GDB/MI File Commands
23090 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
23091
23092 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
23093 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
23094
23095 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
23096 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
23097
23098 @subsubheading Synopsis
23099
23100 @smallexample
23101 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
23102 @end smallexample
23103
23104 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
23105 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
23106 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
23107 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
23108 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
23109 notification.
23110
23111 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23112
23113 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
23114
23115 @subsubheading Example
23116
23117 @smallexample
23118 (gdb)
23119 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23120 ^done
23121 (gdb)
23122 @end smallexample
23123
23124
23125 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
23126 @findex -file-exec-file
23127
23128 @subsubheading Synopsis
23129
23130 @smallexample
23131 -file-exec-file @var{file}
23132 @end smallexample
23133
23134 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
23135 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
23136 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
23137 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
23138 notification.
23139
23140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23141
23142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
23143
23144 @subsubheading Example
23145
23146 @smallexample
23147 (gdb)
23148 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23149 ^done
23150 (gdb)
23151 @end smallexample
23152
23153
23154 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
23155 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
23156
23157 @subsubheading Synopsis
23158
23159 @smallexample
23160 -file-list-exec-sections
23161 @end smallexample
23162
23163 List the sections of the current executable file.
23164
23165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23166
23167 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
23168 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
23169 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
23170
23171 @subsubheading Example
23172 N.A.
23173
23174
23175 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
23176 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
23177
23178 @subsubheading Synopsis
23179
23180 @smallexample
23181 -file-list-exec-source-file
23182 @end smallexample
23183
23184 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
23185 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
23186 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
23187 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
23188
23189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23190
23191 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
23192
23193 @subsubheading Example
23194
23195 @smallexample
23196 (gdb)
23197 123-file-list-exec-source-file
23198 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
23199 (gdb)
23200 @end smallexample
23201
23202
23203 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
23204 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
23205
23206 @subsubheading Synopsis
23207
23208 @smallexample
23209 -file-list-exec-source-files
23210 @end smallexample
23211
23212 List the source files for the current executable.
23213
23214 It will always output the filename, but only when @value{GDBN} can find
23215 the absolute file name of a source file, will it output the fullname.
23216
23217 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23218
23219 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
23220 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
23221
23222 @subsubheading Example
23223 @smallexample
23224 (gdb)
23225 -file-list-exec-source-files
23226 ^done,files=[
23227 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
23228 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
23229 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
23230 (gdb)
23231 @end smallexample
23232
23233 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
23234 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
23235
23236 @subsubheading Synopsis
23237
23238 @smallexample
23239 -file-list-shared-libraries
23240 @end smallexample
23241
23242 List the shared libraries in the program.
23243
23244 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23245
23246 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
23247
23248 @subsubheading Example
23249 N.A.
23250
23251
23252 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
23253 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
23254
23255 @subsubheading Synopsis
23256
23257 @smallexample
23258 -file-list-symbol-files
23259 @end smallexample
23260
23261 List symbol files.
23262
23263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23264
23265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
23266
23267 @subsubheading Example
23268 N.A.
23269
23270
23271 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
23272 @findex -file-symbol-file
23273
23274 @subsubheading Synopsis
23275
23276 @smallexample
23277 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
23278 @end smallexample
23279
23280 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
23281 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
23282 produced, except for a completion notification.
23283
23284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23285
23286 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
23287
23288 @subsubheading Example
23289
23290 @smallexample
23291 (gdb)
23292 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
23293 ^done
23294 (gdb)
23295 @end smallexample
23296
23297 @ignore
23298 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23299 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
23300 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
23301
23302 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
23303
23304 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
23305
23306 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
23307
23308 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
23309
23310 @c @subheading -overlay-map
23311
23312 @c @subheading -overlay-off
23313
23314 @c @subheading -overlay-on
23315
23316 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
23317
23318 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23319 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
23320 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
23321
23322 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
23323
23324 @c @subheading -signal-handle
23325
23326 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
23327
23328 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
23329 @end ignore
23330
23331
23332 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23333 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
23334 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
23335
23336
23337 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
23338 @findex -target-attach
23339
23340 @subsubheading Synopsis
23341
23342 @smallexample
23343 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
23344 @end smallexample
23345
23346 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
23347 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
23348 group, the id previously returned by
23349 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
23350
23351 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23352
23353 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
23354
23355 @subsubheading Example
23356 @smallexample
23357 (gdb)
23358 -target-attach 34
23359 =thread-created,id="1"
23360 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
23361 ^done
23362 (gdb)
23363 @end smallexample
23364
23365 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
23366 @findex -target-compare-sections
23367
23368 @subsubheading Synopsis
23369
23370 @smallexample
23371 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
23372 @end smallexample
23373
23374 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
23375 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
23376
23377 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23378
23379 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
23380
23381 @subsubheading Example
23382 N.A.
23383
23384
23385 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
23386 @findex -target-detach
23387
23388 @subsubheading Synopsis
23389
23390 @smallexample
23391 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
23392 @end smallexample
23393
23394 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
23395 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
23396 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
23397
23398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23399
23400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
23401
23402 @subsubheading Example
23403
23404 @smallexample
23405 (gdb)
23406 -target-detach
23407 ^done
23408 (gdb)
23409 @end smallexample
23410
23411
23412 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
23413 @findex -target-disconnect
23414
23415 @subsubheading Synopsis
23416
23417 @smallexample
23418 -target-disconnect
23419 @end smallexample
23420
23421 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
23422 generally not resumed.
23423
23424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23425
23426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
23427
23428 @subsubheading Example
23429
23430 @smallexample
23431 (gdb)
23432 -target-disconnect
23433 ^done
23434 (gdb)
23435 @end smallexample
23436
23437
23438 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
23439 @findex -target-download
23440
23441 @subsubheading Synopsis
23442
23443 @smallexample
23444 -target-download
23445 @end smallexample
23446
23447 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
23448 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
23449
23450 @table @samp
23451 @item section
23452 The name of the section.
23453 @item section-sent
23454 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
23455 @item section-size
23456 The size of the section.
23457 @item total-sent
23458 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
23459 @item total-size
23460 The size of the overall executable to download.
23461 @end table
23462
23463 @noindent
23464 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
23465 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
23466
23467 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
23468 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
23469
23470 @table @samp
23471 @item section
23472 The name of the section.
23473 @item section-size
23474 The size of the section.
23475 @item total-size
23476 The size of the overall executable to download.
23477 @end table
23478
23479 @noindent
23480 At the end, a summary is printed.
23481
23482 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23483
23484 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
23485
23486 @subsubheading Example
23487
23488 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
23489 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
23490
23491 @smallexample
23492 (gdb)
23493 -target-download
23494 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
23495 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
23496 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
23497 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
23498 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
23499 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
23500 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
23501 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
23502 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
23503 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
23504 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
23505 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
23506 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
23507 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
23508 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
23509 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
23510 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
23511 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
23512 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
23513 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
23514 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
23515 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
23516 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
23517 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
23518 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
23519 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
23520 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
23521 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23522 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
23523 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
23524 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
23525 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
23526 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
23527 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
23528 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
23529 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
23530 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
23531 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
23532 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
23533 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
23534 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
23535 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
23536 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
23537 write-rate="429"
23538 (gdb)
23539 @end smallexample
23540
23541
23542 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
23543 @findex -target-exec-status
23544
23545 @subsubheading Synopsis
23546
23547 @smallexample
23548 -target-exec-status
23549 @end smallexample
23550
23551 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
23552 not, for instance).
23553
23554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23555
23556 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
23557
23558 @subsubheading Example
23559 N.A.
23560
23561
23562 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
23563 @findex -target-list-available-targets
23564
23565 @subsubheading Synopsis
23566
23567 @smallexample
23568 -target-list-available-targets
23569 @end smallexample
23570
23571 List the possible targets to connect to.
23572
23573 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23574
23575 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
23576
23577 @subsubheading Example
23578 N.A.
23579
23580
23581 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
23582 @findex -target-list-current-targets
23583
23584 @subsubheading Synopsis
23585
23586 @smallexample
23587 -target-list-current-targets
23588 @end smallexample
23589
23590 Describe the current target.
23591
23592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23593
23594 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
23595 other things).
23596
23597 @subsubheading Example
23598 N.A.
23599
23600
23601 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
23602 @findex -target-list-parameters
23603
23604 @subsubheading Synopsis
23605
23606 @smallexample
23607 -target-list-parameters
23608 @end smallexample
23609
23610 @c ????
23611
23612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23613
23614 No equivalent.
23615
23616 @subsubheading Example
23617 N.A.
23618
23619
23620 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
23621 @findex -target-select
23622
23623 @subsubheading Synopsis
23624
23625 @smallexample
23626 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
23627 @end smallexample
23628
23629 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
23630
23631 @table @samp
23632 @item @var{type}
23633 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
23634 @item @var{parameters}
23635 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
23636 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
23637 @end table
23638
23639 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
23640 which the target program is, in the following form:
23641
23642 @smallexample
23643 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
23644 args=[@var{arg list}]
23645 @end smallexample
23646
23647 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23648
23649 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
23650
23651 @subsubheading Example
23652
23653 @smallexample
23654 (gdb)
23655 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
23656 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
23657 (gdb)
23658 @end smallexample
23659
23660 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23661 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
23662 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
23663
23664
23665 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
23666 @findex -target-file-put
23667
23668 @subsubheading Synopsis
23669
23670 @smallexample
23671 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
23672 @end smallexample
23673
23674 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
23675 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
23676
23677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23678
23679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
23680
23681 @subsubheading Example
23682
23683 @smallexample
23684 (gdb)
23685 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
23686 ^done
23687 (gdb)
23688 @end smallexample
23689
23690
23691 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
23692 @findex -target-file-get
23693
23694 @subsubheading Synopsis
23695
23696 @smallexample
23697 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
23698 @end smallexample
23699
23700 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
23701 on the host system.
23702
23703 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23704
23705 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
23706
23707 @subsubheading Example
23708
23709 @smallexample
23710 (gdb)
23711 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
23712 ^done
23713 (gdb)
23714 @end smallexample
23715
23716
23717 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
23718 @findex -target-file-delete
23719
23720 @subsubheading Synopsis
23721
23722 @smallexample
23723 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
23724 @end smallexample
23725
23726 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
23727
23728 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23729
23730 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
23731
23732 @subsubheading Example
23733
23734 @smallexample
23735 (gdb)
23736 -target-file-delete remotefile
23737 ^done
23738 (gdb)
23739 @end smallexample
23740
23741
23742 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
23743 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
23744 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
23745
23746 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
23747
23748 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
23749 @findex -gdb-exit
23750
23751 @subsubheading Synopsis
23752
23753 @smallexample
23754 -gdb-exit
23755 @end smallexample
23756
23757 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
23758
23759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23760
23761 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
23762
23763 @subsubheading Example
23764
23765 @smallexample
23766 (gdb)
23767 -gdb-exit
23768 ^exit
23769 @end smallexample
23770
23771
23772 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
23773 @findex -exec-abort
23774
23775 @subsubheading Synopsis
23776
23777 @smallexample
23778 -exec-abort
23779 @end smallexample
23780
23781 Kill the inferior running program.
23782
23783 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23784
23785 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
23786
23787 @subsubheading Example
23788 N.A.
23789
23790
23791 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
23792 @findex -gdb-set
23793
23794 @subsubheading Synopsis
23795
23796 @smallexample
23797 -gdb-set
23798 @end smallexample
23799
23800 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
23801 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
23802
23803 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23804
23805 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
23806
23807 @subsubheading Example
23808
23809 @smallexample
23810 (gdb)
23811 -gdb-set $foo=3
23812 ^done
23813 (gdb)
23814 @end smallexample
23815
23816
23817 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
23818 @findex -gdb-show
23819
23820 @subsubheading Synopsis
23821
23822 @smallexample
23823 -gdb-show
23824 @end smallexample
23825
23826 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
23827
23828 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23829
23830 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
23831
23832 @subsubheading Example
23833
23834 @smallexample
23835 (gdb)
23836 -gdb-show annotate
23837 ^done,value="0"
23838 (gdb)
23839 @end smallexample
23840
23841 @c @subheading -gdb-source
23842
23843
23844 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
23845 @findex -gdb-version
23846
23847 @subsubheading Synopsis
23848
23849 @smallexample
23850 -gdb-version
23851 @end smallexample
23852
23853 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
23854
23855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
23856
23857 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
23858 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
23859
23860 @subsubheading Example
23861
23862 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
23863 @c box in TeX.
23864 @smallexample
23865 (gdb)
23866 -gdb-version
23867 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
23868 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
23869 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
23870 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
23871 ~ certain conditions.
23872 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
23873 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
23874 ~ details.
23875 ~This GDB was configured as
23876 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
23877 ^done
23878 (gdb)
23879 @end smallexample
23880
23881 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
23882 @findex -list-features
23883
23884 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
23885 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
23886 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
23887 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
23888 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
23889 startup.
23890
23891 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
23892 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
23893 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
23894 is given below.
23895
23896 Example output:
23897
23898 @smallexample
23899 (gdb) -list-features
23900 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
23901 @end smallexample
23902
23903 The current list of features is:
23904
23905 @table @samp
23906 @item frozen-varobjs
23907 Indicates presence of the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
23908 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
23909 of @code{-varobj-create}.
23910 @item pending-breakpoints
23911 Indicates presence of the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert} command.
23912 @item thread-info
23913 Indicates presence of the @code{-thread-info} command.
23914
23915 @end table
23916
23917 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
23918 @findex -list-target-features
23919
23920 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
23921 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
23922 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
23923 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
23924 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
23925 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
23926 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
23927 Example output:
23928
23929 @smallexample
23930 (gdb) -list-features
23931 ^done,result=["async"]
23932 @end smallexample
23933
23934 The current list of features is:
23935
23936 @table @samp
23937 @item async
23938 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
23939 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
23940 while the target is running.
23941
23942 @end table
23943
23944 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
23945 @findex -list-thread-groups
23946
23947 @subheading Synopsis
23948
23949 @smallexample
23950 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ @var{group} ]
23951 @end smallexample
23952
23953 When used without the @var{group} parameter, lists top-level thread
23954 groups that are being debugged. When used with the @var{group}
23955 parameter, the children of the specified group are listed. The
23956 children can be either threads, or other groups. At present,
23957 @value{GDBN} will not report both threads and groups as children at
23958 the same time, but it may change in future.
23959
23960 With the @samp{--available} option, instead of reporting groups that
23961 are been debugged, GDB will report all thread groups available on the
23962 target. Using the @samp{--available} option together with @var{group}
23963 is not allowed.
23964
23965 @subheading Example
23966
23967 @smallexample
23968 @value{GDBP}
23969 -list-thread-groups
23970 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
23971 -list-thread-groups 17
23972 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
23973 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
23974 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
23975 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
23976 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
23977 @end smallexample
23978
23979 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
23980 @findex -interpreter-exec
23981
23982 @subheading Synopsis
23983
23984 @smallexample
23985 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
23986 @end smallexample
23987 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
23988
23989 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
23990
23991 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
23992
23993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
23994
23995 @subheading Example
23996
23997 @smallexample
23998 (gdb)
23999 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
24000 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
24001 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
24002 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
24003 ^done
24004 (gdb)
24005 @end smallexample
24006
24007 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
24008 @findex -inferior-tty-set
24009
24010 @subheading Synopsis
24011
24012 @smallexample
24013 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24014 @end smallexample
24015
24016 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
24017
24018 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24019
24020 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
24021
24022 @subheading Example
24023
24024 @smallexample
24025 (gdb)
24026 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24027 ^done
24028 (gdb)
24029 @end smallexample
24030
24031 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
24032 @findex -inferior-tty-show
24033
24034 @subheading Synopsis
24035
24036 @smallexample
24037 -inferior-tty-show
24038 @end smallexample
24039
24040 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
24041
24042 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24043
24044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
24045
24046 @subheading Example
24047
24048 @smallexample
24049 (gdb)
24050 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
24051 ^done
24052 (gdb)
24053 -inferior-tty-show
24054 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
24055 (gdb)
24056 @end smallexample
24057
24058 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
24059 @findex -enable-timings
24060
24061 @subheading Synopsis
24062
24063 @smallexample
24064 -enable-timings [yes | no]
24065 @end smallexample
24066
24067 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
24068 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
24069 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
24070 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
24071
24072 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
24073
24074 No equivalent.
24075
24076 @subheading Example
24077
24078 @smallexample
24079 (gdb)
24080 -enable-timings
24081 ^done
24082 (gdb)
24083 -break-insert main
24084 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
24085 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
24086 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",times="0"@},
24087 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
24088 (gdb)
24089 -enable-timings no
24090 ^done
24091 (gdb)
24092 -exec-run
24093 ^running
24094 (gdb)
24095 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
24096 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
24097 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
24098 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
24099 (gdb)
24100 @end smallexample
24101
24102 @node Annotations
24103 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
24104
24105 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
24106 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
24107 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
24108 relatively high level.
24109
24110 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
24111 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
24112
24113 @ignore
24114 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
24115 @end ignore
24116
24117 @menu
24118 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
24119 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
24120 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
24121 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
24122 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
24123 * Annotations for Running::
24124 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
24125 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
24126 @end menu
24127
24128 @node Annotations Overview
24129 @section What is an Annotation?
24130 @cindex annotations
24131
24132 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
24133 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
24134 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
24135 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
24136 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
24137 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
24138 cannot contain newline characters.
24139
24140 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
24141 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
24142 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
24143 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
24144 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
24145 means those three characters as output.
24146
24147 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
24148 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
24149 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
24150 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
24151 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
24152 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
24153 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
24154 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
24155 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
24156
24157 @table @code
24158 @kindex set annotate
24159 @item set annotate @var{level}
24160 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
24161 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
24162
24163 @item show annotate
24164 @kindex show annotate
24165 Show the current annotation level.
24166 @end table
24167
24168 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
24169
24170 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
24171
24172 @smallexample
24173 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
24174 GNU gdb 6.0
24175 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
24176 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
24177 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
24178 under certain conditions.
24179 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
24180 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
24181 for details.
24182 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
24183
24184 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24185 (@value{GDBP})
24186 ^Z^Zprompt
24187 @kbd{quit}
24188
24189 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24190 $
24191 @end smallexample
24192
24193 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
24194 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
24195 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
24196 output from @value{GDBN}.
24197
24198 @node Server Prefix
24199 @section The Server Prefix
24200 @cindex server prefix
24201
24202 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
24203 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
24204 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
24205 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
24206 a transparent manner.
24207
24208 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24209 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24210 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24211
24212 @node Prompting
24213 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
24214
24215 @cindex annotations for prompts
24216 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
24217 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
24218 over, etc.
24219
24220 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
24221 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
24222 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
24223 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
24224 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
24225 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
24226 features the following annotations:
24227
24228 @smallexample
24229 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
24230 ^Z^Zprompt
24231 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
24232 @end smallexample
24233
24234 The input types are
24235
24236 @table @code
24237 @findex pre-prompt annotation
24238 @findex prompt annotation
24239 @findex post-prompt annotation
24240 @item prompt
24241 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
24242
24243 @findex pre-commands annotation
24244 @findex commands annotation
24245 @findex post-commands annotation
24246 @item commands
24247 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
24248 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
24249
24250 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
24251 @findex overload-choice annotation
24252 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
24253 @item overload-choice
24254 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
24255
24256 @findex pre-query annotation
24257 @findex query annotation
24258 @findex post-query annotation
24259 @item query
24260 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
24261
24262 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
24263 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
24264 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
24265 @item prompt-for-continue
24266 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
24267 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
24268 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
24269 presence of annotations.
24270 @end table
24271
24272 @node Errors
24273 @section Errors
24274 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
24275
24276 @findex quit annotation
24277 @smallexample
24278 ^Z^Zquit
24279 @end smallexample
24280
24281 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
24282
24283 @findex error annotation
24284 @smallexample
24285 ^Z^Zerror
24286 @end smallexample
24287
24288 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
24289
24290 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
24291 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
24292 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
24293 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
24294 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
24295 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
24296 to the top level.
24297
24298 @findex error-begin annotation
24299 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
24300
24301 @smallexample
24302 ^Z^Zerror-begin
24303 @end smallexample
24304
24305 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
24306 message.
24307
24308 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
24309 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
24310 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
24311
24312 @node Invalidation
24313 @section Invalidation Notices
24314
24315 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
24316 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
24317 changed.
24318
24319 @table @code
24320 @findex frames-invalid annotation
24321 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
24322
24323 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
24324 have changed.
24325
24326 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
24327 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
24328
24329 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
24330 deleted a breakpoint.
24331 @end table
24332
24333 @node Annotations for Running
24334 @section Running the Program
24335 @cindex annotations for running programs
24336
24337 @findex starting annotation
24338 @findex stopping annotation
24339 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
24340 @code{step} or @code{continue},
24341
24342 @smallexample
24343 ^Z^Zstarting
24344 @end smallexample
24345
24346 is output. When the program stops,
24347
24348 @smallexample
24349 ^Z^Zstopped
24350 @end smallexample
24351
24352 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
24353 annotations describe how the program stopped.
24354
24355 @table @code
24356 @findex exited annotation
24357 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
24358 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
24359 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
24360
24361 @findex signalled annotation
24362 @findex signal-name annotation
24363 @findex signal-name-end annotation
24364 @findex signal-string annotation
24365 @findex signal-string-end annotation
24366 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
24367 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
24368 annotation continues:
24369
24370 @smallexample
24371 @var{intro-text}
24372 ^Z^Zsignal-name
24373 @var{name}
24374 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
24375 @var{middle-text}
24376 ^Z^Zsignal-string
24377 @var{string}
24378 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
24379 @var{end-text}
24380 @end smallexample
24381
24382 @noindent
24383 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
24384 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
24385 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
24386 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
24387 user's benefit and have no particular format.
24388
24389 @findex signal annotation
24390 @item ^Z^Zsignal
24391 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
24392 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
24393 terminated with it.
24394
24395 @findex breakpoint annotation
24396 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
24397 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
24398
24399 @findex watchpoint annotation
24400 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
24401 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
24402 @end table
24403
24404 @node Source Annotations
24405 @section Displaying Source
24406 @cindex annotations for source display
24407
24408 @findex source annotation
24409 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
24410
24411 @smallexample
24412 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
24413 @end smallexample
24414
24415 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
24416 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
24417 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
24418 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
24419 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
24420 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
24421 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
24422 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
24423 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
24424 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
24425 depend on the language).
24426
24427 @node GDB Bugs
24428 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
24429 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
24430 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
24431
24432 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
24433
24434 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
24435 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
24436 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
24437 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
24438
24439 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
24440 information that enables us to fix the bug.
24441
24442 @menu
24443 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
24444 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
24445 @end menu
24446
24447 @node Bug Criteria
24448 @section Have You Found a Bug?
24449 @cindex bug criteria
24450
24451 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
24452
24453 @itemize @bullet
24454 @cindex fatal signal
24455 @cindex debugger crash
24456 @cindex crash of debugger
24457 @item
24458 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
24459 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
24460
24461 @cindex error on valid input
24462 @item
24463 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
24464 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
24465 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
24466
24467 @cindex invalid input
24468 @item
24469 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
24470 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
24471 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
24472 for traditional practice''.
24473
24474 @item
24475 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
24476 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
24477 @end itemize
24478
24479 @node Bug Reporting
24480 @section How to Report Bugs
24481 @cindex bug reports
24482 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
24483
24484 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
24485 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
24486 contact that organization first.
24487
24488 You can find contact information for many support companies and
24489 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
24490 distribution.
24491 @c should add a web page ref...
24492
24493 @ifset BUGURL
24494 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
24495 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24496 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
24497 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
24498 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
24499 be used.
24500
24501 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
24502 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
24503 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
24504 @samp{bug-gdb}.
24505
24506 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
24507 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
24508 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
24509 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
24510 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
24511 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
24512 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
24513 bug reports to the mailing list.
24514 @end ifset
24515 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
24516 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
24517 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
24518 @end ifclear
24519 @end ifset
24520
24521 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
24522 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
24523 fact or leave it out, state it!
24524
24525 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
24526 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
24527 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
24528 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
24529 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
24530 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
24531 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
24532 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
24533 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
24534
24535 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
24536 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
24537 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
24538 self-contained.
24539
24540 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
24541 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
24542 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
24543 bugs properly.
24544
24545 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
24546
24547 @itemize @bullet
24548 @item
24549 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
24550 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
24551 version}.
24552
24553 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
24554 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
24555
24556 @item
24557 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
24558 version number.
24559
24560 @item
24561 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
24562 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
24563
24564 @item
24565 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
24566 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
24567 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
24568 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
24569 those compilers.
24570
24571 @item
24572 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
24573 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
24574 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
24575 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
24576
24577 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
24578 and then we might not encounter the bug.
24579
24580 @item
24581 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
24582 reproduce the bug.
24583
24584 @item
24585 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
24586 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
24587
24588 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
24589 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
24590 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
24591 a chance to make a mistake.
24592
24593 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
24594 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
24595 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
24596 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
24597 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
24598 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
24599 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
24600 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
24601
24602 @pindex script
24603 @cindex recording a session script
24604 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
24605 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
24606 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
24607 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
24608
24609 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
24610 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
24611
24612 @item
24613 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
24614 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
24615 it by context, not by line number.
24616
24617 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
24618 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
24619
24620 @end itemize
24621
24622 Here are some things that are not necessary:
24623
24624 @itemize @bullet
24625 @item
24626 A description of the envelope of the bug.
24627
24628 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
24629 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
24630 changes will not affect it.
24631
24632 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
24633 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
24634 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
24635 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
24636
24637 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
24638 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
24639 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
24640 less time, and so on.
24641
24642 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
24643 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
24644
24645 @item
24646 A patch for the bug.
24647
24648 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
24649 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
24650 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
24651 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
24652
24653 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
24654 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
24655 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
24656 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
24657
24658 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
24659 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
24660 help us to understand.
24661
24662 @item
24663 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
24664
24665 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
24666 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
24667 @end itemize
24668
24669 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
24670 @c and consists of the two following files:
24671 @c rluser.texinfo
24672 @c inc-hist.texinfo
24673 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
24674 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
24675 @include rluser.texi
24676 @include inc-hist.texinfo
24677
24678
24679 @node Formatting Documentation
24680 @appendix Formatting Documentation
24681
24682 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
24683 @cindex reference card
24684 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
24685 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
24686 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
24687 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
24688 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
24689 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
24690
24691 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
24692 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
24693
24694 @smallexample
24695 make refcard.dvi
24696 @end smallexample
24697
24698 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
24699 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
24700 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
24701 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
24702 your @sc{dvi} output program.
24703
24704 @cindex documentation
24705
24706 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
24707 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
24708 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
24709 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
24710 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
24711 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
24712
24713 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
24714 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
24715 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
24716 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
24717 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
24718 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
24719 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
24720 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
24721
24722 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
24723 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
24724 @code{makeinfo}.
24725
24726 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
24727 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
24728 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
24729
24730 @smallexample
24731 cd gdb
24732 make gdb.info
24733 @end smallexample
24734
24735 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
24736 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
24737 Texinfo definitions file.
24738
24739 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
24740 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
24741 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
24742 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
24743 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
24744 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
24745 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
24746
24747 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
24748 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
24749 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
24750 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
24751 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
24752 directory.
24753
24754 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
24755 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
24756 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
24757 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
24758
24759 @smallexample
24760 make gdb.dvi
24761 @end smallexample
24762
24763 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
24764
24765 @node Installing GDB
24766 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
24767 @cindex installation
24768
24769 @menu
24770 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
24771 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
24772 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
24773 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
24774 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
24775 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
24776 @end menu
24777
24778 @node Requirements
24779 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
24780 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
24781
24782 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
24783 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
24784
24785 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
24786 @table @asis
24787 @item ISO C90 compiler
24788 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
24789 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
24790
24791 @end table
24792
24793 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
24794 @table @asis
24795 @item Expat
24796 @anchor{Expat}
24797 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
24798 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
24799 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
24800 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
24801 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
24802 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
24803
24804 Expat is used for:
24805
24806 @itemize @bullet
24807 @item
24808 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
24809 @item
24810 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
24811 @item
24812 Remote shared library lists (@pxref{Library List Format})
24813 @item
24814 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
24815 @end itemize
24816
24817 @item zlib
24818 @cindex compressed debug sections
24819 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
24820 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
24821 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
24822 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
24823 information in such binaries.
24824
24825 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
24826 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
24827 @url{http://zlib.net}.
24828
24829 @end table
24830
24831 @node Running Configure
24832 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
24833 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
24834 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
24835 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
24836 build the @code{gdb} program.
24837 @iftex
24838 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
24839 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
24840 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
24841 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
24842 @end iftex
24843
24844 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
24845 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
24846 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
24847
24848 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
24849 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
24850
24851 @table @code
24852 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
24853 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
24854
24855 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
24856 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
24857
24858 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
24859 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
24860
24861 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
24862 @sc{gnu} include files
24863
24864 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
24865 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
24866
24867 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
24868 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
24869
24870 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
24871 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
24872
24873 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
24874 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
24875
24876 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
24877 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
24878 @end table
24879
24880 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
24881 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
24882 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
24883
24884 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
24885 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
24886 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
24887 argument.
24888
24889 For example:
24890
24891 @smallexample
24892 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24893 ./configure @var{host}
24894 make
24895 @end smallexample
24896
24897 @noindent
24898 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
24899 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
24900 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
24901 correct value by examining your system.)
24902
24903 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
24904 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
24905 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
24906 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
24907
24908 @need 750
24909 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
24910 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
24911 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
24912
24913 @smallexample
24914 sh configure @var{host}
24915 @end smallexample
24916
24917 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
24918 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
24919 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
24920 @file{configure}
24921 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
24922 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
24923
24924 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
24925 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
24926 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
24927 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
24928 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
24929 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
24930 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
24931 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
24932 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24933
24934 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
24935 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
24936 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
24937 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
24938 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
24939
24940 @node Separate Objdir
24941 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
24942
24943 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
24944 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
24945 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
24946 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
24947 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
24948 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
24949 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
24950 program specified there.
24951
24952 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
24953 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
24954 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
24955 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
24956 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
24957 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
24958
24959 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
24960 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
24961
24962 @smallexample
24963 @group
24964 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
24965 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
24966 cd ../gdb-sun4
24967 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
24968 make
24969 @end group
24970 @end smallexample
24971
24972 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
24973 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
24974 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
24975 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
24976 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
24977 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
24978
24979 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
24980 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
24981 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
24982 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
24983 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
24984
24985 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
24986 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
24987 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
24988 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
24989 You specify a cross-debugging target by
24990 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
24991
24992 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
24993 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
24994 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
24995
24996 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
24997 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
24998 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
24999 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
25000 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
25001
25002 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
25003 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
25004 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
25005 with each other.
25006
25007 @node Config Names
25008 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
25009
25010 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
25011 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
25012 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
25013 of information in the following pattern:
25014
25015 @smallexample
25016 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
25017 @end smallexample
25018
25019 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
25020 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
25021 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
25022
25023 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
25024 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
25025 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
25026 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
25027 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
25028 abbreviations---for example:
25029
25030 @smallexample
25031 % sh config.sub i386-linux
25032 i386-pc-linux-gnu
25033 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
25034 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
25035 % sh config.sub hp9k700
25036 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
25037 % sh config.sub sun4
25038 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
25039 % sh config.sub sun3
25040 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
25041 % sh config.sub i986v
25042 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
25043 @end smallexample
25044
25045 @noindent
25046 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
25047 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
25048
25049 @node Configure Options
25050 @section @file{configure} Options
25051
25052 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
25053 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
25054 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
25055 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
25056
25057 @smallexample
25058 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
25059 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25060 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
25061 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
25062 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
25063 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
25064 @var{host}
25065 @end smallexample
25066
25067 @noindent
25068 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
25069 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
25070 @samp{--}.
25071
25072 @table @code
25073 @item --help
25074 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
25075
25076 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
25077 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
25078 @file{@var{dir}}.
25079
25080 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
25081 Configure the source to install programs under directory
25082 @file{@var{dir}}.
25083
25084 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
25085 @need 2000
25086 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
25087 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
25088 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
25089 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
25090 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
25091 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
25092 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
25093 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
25094 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
25095 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
25096 @var{dirname}.
25097
25098 @item --norecursion
25099 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
25100 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
25101
25102 @item --target=@var{target}
25103 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
25104 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
25105 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
25106
25107 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
25108
25109 @item @var{host} @dots{}
25110 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
25111
25112 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
25113 @end table
25114
25115 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
25116 needed for special purposes only.
25117
25118 @node System-wide configuration
25119 @section System-wide configuration and settings
25120 @cindex system-wide init file
25121
25122 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
25123 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
25124 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
25125
25126 Here is the corresponding configure option:
25127
25128 @table @code
25129 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
25130 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
25131 @var{file}.
25132 @end table
25133
25134 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
25135 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
25136
25137 @itemize @bullet
25138 @item
25139 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
25140 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
25141 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
25142 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
25143 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
25144 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
25145
25146 @item
25147 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
25148 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
25149 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25150 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
25151 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
25152 @end itemize
25153
25154 @node Maintenance Commands
25155 @appendix Maintenance Commands
25156 @cindex maintenance commands
25157 @cindex internal commands
25158
25159 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
25160 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
25161 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
25162 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
25163 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
25164
25165 @table @code
25166 @kindex maint agent
25167 @item maint agent @var{expression}
25168 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
25169 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
25170 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
25171
25172 @kindex maint info breakpoints
25173 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
25174 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
25175 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
25176 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
25177 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
25178 is shown:
25179
25180 @table @code
25181 @item breakpoint
25182 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
25183
25184 @item watchpoint
25185 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
25186
25187 @item longjmp
25188 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
25189 @code{longjmp} calls.
25190
25191 @item longjmp resume
25192 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
25193
25194 @item until
25195 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
25196
25197 @item finish
25198 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
25199
25200 @item shlib events
25201 Shared library events.
25202
25203 @end table
25204
25205 @kindex set displaced-stepping
25206 @kindex show displaced-stepping
25207 @cindex displaced stepping support
25208 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
25209 @item set displaced-stepping
25210 @itemx show displaced-stepping
25211 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
25212 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
25213 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
25214 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
25215 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
25216
25217 @table @code
25218 @item set displaced-stepping on
25219 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
25220 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
25221
25222 @item set displaced-stepping off
25223 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
25224 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
25225
25226 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
25227 @item set displaced-stepping auto
25228 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
25229 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
25230 architecture supports displaced stepping.
25231 @end table
25232
25233 @kindex maint check-symtabs
25234 @item maint check-symtabs
25235 Check the consistency of psymtabs and symtabs.
25236
25237 @kindex maint cplus first_component
25238 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
25239 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
25240
25241 @kindex maint cplus namespace
25242 @item maint cplus namespace
25243 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
25244
25245 @kindex maint demangle
25246 @item maint demangle @var{name}
25247 Demangle a C@t{++} or Objective-C mangled @var{name}.
25248
25249 @kindex maint deprecate
25250 @kindex maint undeprecate
25251 @cindex deprecated commands
25252 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
25253 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
25254 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
25255 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
25256 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
25257 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
25258 the replacement as part of the warning.
25259
25260 @kindex maint dump-me
25261 @item maint dump-me
25262 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
25263 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
25264 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
25265 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
25266
25267 @kindex maint internal-error
25268 @kindex maint internal-warning
25269 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25270 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
25271 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
25272 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
25273 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
25274 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
25275 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
25276 @value{GDBN} session.
25277
25278 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
25279 used as the text of the error or warning message.
25280
25281 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
25282
25283 @smallexample
25284 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
25285 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
25286 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
25287 debugging may prove unreliable.
25288 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25289 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
25290 (@value{GDBP})
25291 @end smallexample
25292
25293 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
25294 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
25295
25296 @kindex maint set internal-error
25297 @kindex maint show internal-error
25298 @kindex maint set internal-warning
25299 @kindex maint show internal-warning
25300 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25301 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
25302 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
25303 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
25304 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
25305 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
25306 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
25307 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
25308 described in the table below.
25309
25310 @table @samp
25311 @item quit
25312 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25313 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25314
25315 @item corefile
25316 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
25317 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do.
25318 @end table
25319
25320 @kindex maint packet
25321 @item maint packet @var{text}
25322 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
25323 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
25324 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
25325 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
25326 checksum.
25327
25328 @kindex maint print architecture
25329 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25330 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
25331 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
25332
25333 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
25334 @item maint print c-tdesc
25335 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
25336 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
25337 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
25338
25339 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
25340 @item maint print dummy-frames
25341 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
25342
25343 @smallexample
25344 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
25345 @dots{}
25346 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
25347 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
25348 58 return (a + b);
25349 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
25350 @dots{}
25351 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
25352 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
25353 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
25354 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
25355 (@value{GDBP})
25356 @end smallexample
25357
25358 Takes an optional file parameter.
25359
25360 @kindex maint print registers
25361 @kindex maint print raw-registers
25362 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
25363 @kindex maint print register-groups
25364 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25365 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25366 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25367 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25368 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
25369
25370 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
25371 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
25372 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
25373 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
25374 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
25375 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
25376
25377 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
25378 write the information.
25379
25380 @kindex maint print reggroups
25381 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
25382 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
25383 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
25384 information.
25385
25386 The register groups info looks like this:
25387
25388 @smallexample
25389 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
25390 Group Type
25391 general user
25392 float user
25393 all user
25394 vector user
25395 system user
25396 save internal
25397 restore internal
25398 @end smallexample
25399
25400 @kindex flushregs
25401 @item flushregs
25402 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
25403
25404 @kindex maint print objfiles
25405 @cindex info for known object files
25406 @item maint print objfiles
25407 Print a dump of all known object files. For each object file, this
25408 command prints its name, address in memory, and all of its psymtabs
25409 and symtabs.
25410
25411 @kindex maint print statistics
25412 @cindex bcache statistics
25413 @item maint print statistics
25414 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
25415 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
25416 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
25417 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
25418 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
25419 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
25420 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
25421 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
25422 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
25423 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
25424 lengths.
25425
25426 @kindex maint print target-stack
25427 @cindex target stack description
25428 @item maint print target-stack
25429 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
25430 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
25431 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
25432 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
25433 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
25434 address.
25435
25436 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
25437 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
25438
25439 @kindex maint print type
25440 @cindex type chain of a data type
25441 @item maint print type @var{expr}
25442 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
25443 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
25444 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
25445 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
25446 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
25447
25448 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25449 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25450 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
25451 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
25452 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
25453
25454 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
25455 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
25456 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
25457 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
25458 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
25459 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
25460 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
25461 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
25462 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
25463
25464 @kindex maint set profile
25465 @kindex maint show profile
25466 @cindex profiling GDB
25467 @item maint set profile
25468 @itemx maint show profile
25469 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
25470
25471 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
25472 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
25473 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
25474 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
25475 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
25476 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
25477 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
25478
25479 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
25480 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
25481
25482 @kindex maint show-debug-regs
25483 @cindex x86 hardware debug registers
25484 @item maint show-debug-regs
25485 Control whether to show variables that mirror the x86 hardware debug
25486 registers. Use @code{ON} to enable, @code{OFF} to disable. If
25487 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
25488 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
25489 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
25490
25491 @kindex maint space
25492 @cindex memory used by commands
25493 @item maint space
25494 Control whether to display memory usage for each command. If set to a
25495 nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
25496 took, following the command's own output. This can also be requested
25497 by invoking @value{GDBN} with the @option{--statistics} command-line
25498 switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25499
25500 @kindex maint time
25501 @cindex time of command execution
25502 @item maint time
25503 Control whether to display the execution time for each command. If
25504 set to a nonzero value, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
25505 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
25506 The time is not printed for the commands that run the target, since
25507 there's no mechanism currently to compute how much time was spend
25508 by @value{GDBN} and how much time was spend by the program been debugged.
25509 it's not possibly currently
25510 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
25511 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
25512
25513 @kindex maint translate-address
25514 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
25515 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
25516 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
25517 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
25518 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
25519 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
25520 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
25521
25522 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
25523 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
25524 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
25525
25526 @end table
25527
25528 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
25529 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
25530
25531 @table @code
25532 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
25533 @kindex set watchdog
25534 @cindex watchdog timer
25535 @cindex timeout for commands
25536 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
25537 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
25538 reports and error and the command is aborted.
25539
25540 @item show watchdog
25541 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
25542 @end table
25543
25544 @node Remote Protocol
25545 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
25546
25547 @menu
25548 * Overview::
25549 * Packets::
25550 * Stop Reply Packets::
25551 * General Query Packets::
25552 * Register Packet Format::
25553 * Tracepoint Packets::
25554 * Host I/O Packets::
25555 * Interrupts::
25556 * Notification Packets::
25557 * Remote Non-Stop::
25558 * Packet Acknowledgment::
25559 * Examples::
25560 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
25561 * Library List Format::
25562 * Memory Map Format::
25563 @end menu
25564
25565 @node Overview
25566 @section Overview
25567
25568 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
25569 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
25570 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
25571 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
25572
25573 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
25574 transmitted and received data, respectively.
25575
25576 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
25577 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
25578 @cindex remote serial protocol
25579 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
25580 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
25581 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
25582 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
25583 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
25584
25585 @smallexample
25586 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25587 @end smallexample
25588 @noindent
25589
25590 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
25591 @noindent
25592 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
25593 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
25594 eight bit unsigned checksum).
25595
25596 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
25597 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
25598
25599 @smallexample
25600 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25601 @end smallexample
25602
25603 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
25604 @noindent
25605 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
25606 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
25607 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
25608
25609 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
25610 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
25611 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
25612 retransmission):
25613
25614 @smallexample
25615 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
25616 <- @code{+}
25617 @end smallexample
25618 @noindent
25619
25620 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
25621 once a connection is established.
25622 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
25623
25624 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
25625 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
25626 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
25627 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
25628 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
25629 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
25630 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
25631
25632 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
25633 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
25634 exceptions).
25635
25636 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
25637 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
25638 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
25639 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
25640
25641 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
25642 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
25643 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
25644
25645 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
25646 @anchor{Binary Data}
25647 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
25648 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
25649 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
25650 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
25651 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
25652 binary data.
25653
25654 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
25655 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
25656 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
25657 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
25658 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
25659 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
25660 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
25661 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
25662 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
25663 (described next).
25664
25665 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
25666 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
25667 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
25668 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
25669 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
25670 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
25671 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
25672 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
25673 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
25674 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
25675 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
25676 3}} more times.
25677
25678 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
25679 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
25680 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
25681 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
25682 @samp{0*"00}.
25683
25684 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
25685 error number. That number is not well defined.
25686
25687 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
25688 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
25689 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
25690 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
25691 on that response.
25692
25693 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
25694 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
25695 optional.
25696
25697 @node Packets
25698 @section Packets
25699
25700 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
25701 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
25702 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
25703 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
25704
25705 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
25706 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
25707 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
25708 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
25709 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
25710 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
25711 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
25712 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
25713 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
25714 @var{baz}.
25715
25716 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
25717 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
25718 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
25719 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
25720 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
25721 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
25722 pick any thread.
25723
25724 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
25725 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
25726 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
25727 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
25728 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
25729 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
25730 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
25731 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
25732 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
25733 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
25734 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
25735 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
25736 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
25737
25738 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
25739 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
25740 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
25741 more information.
25742
25743 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
25744 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
25745
25746 Here are the packet descriptions.
25747
25748 @table @samp
25749
25750 @item !
25751 @cindex @samp{!} packet
25752 @anchor{extended mode}
25753 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
25754 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
25755 debugged.
25756
25757 Reply:
25758 @table @samp
25759 @item OK
25760 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
25761 @end table
25762
25763 @item ?
25764 @cindex @samp{?} packet
25765 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
25766 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
25767 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
25768
25769 Reply:
25770 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25771
25772 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
25773 @cindex @samp{A} packet
25774 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
25775 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
25776 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
25777
25778 Reply:
25779 @table @samp
25780 @item OK
25781 The arguments were set.
25782 @item E @var{NN}
25783 An error occurred.
25784 @end table
25785
25786 @item b @var{baud}
25787 @cindex @samp{b} packet
25788 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
25789 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
25790
25791 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
25792 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
25793 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
25794
25795 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
25796 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
25797 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
25798 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
25799 of view, nothing actually happened.}
25800
25801 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
25802 @cindex @samp{B} packet
25803 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
25804 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
25805
25806 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
25807 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
25808
25809 @item bc
25810 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
25811 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
25812 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25813
25814 Reply:
25815 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25816
25817 @item bs
25818 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
25819 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
25820 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
25821
25822 Reply:
25823 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25824
25825 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
25826 @cindex @samp{c} packet
25827 Continue. @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted,
25828 resume at current address.
25829
25830 Reply:
25831 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25832
25833 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
25834 @cindex @samp{C} packet
25835 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
25836 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
25837
25838 Reply:
25839 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
25840
25841 @item d
25842 @cindex @samp{d} packet
25843 Toggle debug flag.
25844
25845 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
25846 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
25847
25848 @item D
25849 @itemx D;@var{pid}
25850 @cindex @samp{D} packet
25851 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
25852 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
25853 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
25854
25855 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
25856 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
25857 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
25858 big-endian hex string.
25859
25860 Reply:
25861 @table @samp
25862 @item OK
25863 for success
25864 @item E @var{NN}
25865 for an error
25866 @end table
25867
25868 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
25869 @cindex @samp{F} packet
25870 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
25871 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
25872 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
25873
25874 @item g
25875 @anchor{read registers packet}
25876 @cindex @samp{g} packet
25877 Read general registers.
25878
25879 Reply:
25880 @table @samp
25881 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25882 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
25883 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
25884 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
25885 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
25886 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
25887 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
25888 @item E @var{NN}
25889 for an error.
25890 @end table
25891
25892 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
25893 @cindex @samp{G} packet
25894 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
25895 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
25896
25897 Reply:
25898 @table @samp
25899 @item OK
25900 for success
25901 @item E @var{NN}
25902 for an error
25903 @end table
25904
25905 @item H @var{c} @var{thread-id}
25906 @cindex @samp{H} packet
25907 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
25908 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
25909 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
25910 operations. The thread designator @var{thread-id} has the format and
25911 interpretation described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
25912
25913 Reply:
25914 @table @samp
25915 @item OK
25916 for success
25917 @item E @var{NN}
25918 for an error
25919 @end table
25920
25921 @c FIXME: JTC:
25922 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
25923 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
25924 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
25925 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
25926 @c described. For example:
25927 @c
25928 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25929 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
25930 @c otherwise returns current registers.
25931 @c
25932 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
25933 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
25934 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
25935
25936 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
25937 @anchor{cycle step packet}
25938 @cindex @samp{i} packet
25939 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
25940 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
25941 step starting at that address.
25942
25943 @item I
25944 @cindex @samp{I} packet
25945 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
25946 step packet}.
25947
25948 @item k
25949 @cindex @samp{k} packet
25950 Kill request.
25951
25952 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
25953 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
25954 thread?)}.
25955
25956 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
25957 @cindex @samp{m} packet
25958 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25959 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
25960
25961 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
25962 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
25963 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
25964 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
25965 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
25966 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
25967 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
25968 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
25969
25970 Reply:
25971 @table @samp
25972 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
25973 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
25974 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
25975 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
25976 @item E @var{NN}
25977 @var{NN} is errno
25978 @end table
25979
25980 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
25981 @cindex @samp{M} packet
25982 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
25983 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
25984 hexadecimal number.
25985
25986 Reply:
25987 @table @samp
25988 @item OK
25989 for success
25990 @item E @var{NN}
25991 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
25992 written).
25993 @end table
25994
25995 @item p @var{n}
25996 @cindex @samp{p} packet
25997 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
25998 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
25999 register value is encoded.
26000
26001 Reply:
26002 @table @samp
26003 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
26004 the register's value
26005 @item E @var{NN}
26006 for an error
26007 @item
26008 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
26009 @end table
26010
26011 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
26012 @anchor{write register packet}
26013 @cindex @samp{P} packet
26014 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
26015 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
26016 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
26017
26018 Reply:
26019 @table @samp
26020 @item OK
26021 for success
26022 @item E @var{NN}
26023 for an error
26024 @end table
26025
26026 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26027 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
26028 @cindex @samp{q} packet
26029 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
26030 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
26031 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
26032
26033 @item r
26034 @cindex @samp{r} packet
26035 Reset the entire system.
26036
26037 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
26038
26039 @item R @var{XX}
26040 @cindex @samp{R} packet
26041 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
26042 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26043
26044 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
26045
26046 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
26047 @cindex @samp{s} packet
26048 Single step. @var{addr} is the address at which to resume. If
26049 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
26050
26051 Reply:
26052 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26053
26054 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
26055 @anchor{step with signal packet}
26056 @cindex @samp{S} packet
26057 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
26058 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
26059
26060 Reply:
26061 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26062
26063 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
26064 @cindex @samp{t} packet
26065 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
26066 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
26067 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
26068
26069 @item T @var{thread-id}
26070 @cindex @samp{T} packet
26071 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26072
26073 Reply:
26074 @table @samp
26075 @item OK
26076 thread is still alive
26077 @item E @var{NN}
26078 thread is dead
26079 @end table
26080
26081 @item v
26082 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
26083 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
26084
26085 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
26086 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
26087 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
26088 The process ID is a
26089 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
26090 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
26091 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
26092
26093 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
26094 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
26095 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
26096 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
26097 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
26098 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
26099 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
26100 @c stopping or restarting threads.
26101
26102 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26103
26104 Reply:
26105 @table @samp
26106 @item E @var{nn}
26107 for an error
26108 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26109 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26110 @item OK
26111 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
26112 @end table
26113
26114 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
26115 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
26116 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
26117 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
26118 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
26119 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
26120 in their current state in non-stop mode.
26121 Specifying multiple
26122 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
26123 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26124
26125 Currently supported actions are:
26126
26127 @table @samp
26128 @item c
26129 Continue.
26130 @item C @var{sig}
26131 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26132 @item s
26133 Step.
26134 @item S @var{sig}
26135 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26136 @item t
26137 Stop.
26138 @item T @var{sig}
26139 Stop with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
26140 @end table
26141
26142 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
26143 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
26144 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
26145
26146 The @samp{t} and @samp{T} actions are only relevant in non-stop mode
26147 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
26148 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
26149 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
26150 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
26151 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
26152 as an implementation detail.
26153
26154 Reply:
26155 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
26156
26157 @item vCont?
26158 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
26159 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
26160
26161 Reply:
26162 @table @samp
26163 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
26164 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
26165 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
26166 @item
26167 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
26168 @end table
26169
26170 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
26171 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
26172 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
26173 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
26174
26175 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
26176 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
26177 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
26178 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
26179 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
26180 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
26181 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
26182 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
26183 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26184 packet is received.
26185
26186 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
26187 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
26188 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
26189 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
26190 @var{thread-id}.
26191
26192 Reply:
26193 @table @samp
26194 @item OK
26195 for success
26196 @item E @var{NN}
26197 for an error
26198 @end table
26199
26200 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26201 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
26202 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
26203 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
26204 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
26205 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
26206 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
26207 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
26208 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
26209 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
26210 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
26211 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
26212
26213
26214 Reply:
26215 @table @samp
26216 @item OK
26217 for success
26218 @item E.memtype
26219 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
26220 @item E @var{NN}
26221 for an error
26222 @end table
26223
26224 @item vFlashDone
26225 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
26226 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
26227 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
26228 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
26229 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
26230 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
26231 request is completed.
26232
26233 @item vKill;@var{pid}
26234 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
26235 Kill the process with the specified process ID. @var{pid} is a
26236 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
26237 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
26238 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26239
26240 Reply:
26241 @table @samp
26242 @item E @var{nn}
26243 for an error
26244 @item OK
26245 for success
26246 @end table
26247
26248 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
26249 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
26250 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
26251 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
26252 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
26253 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
26254 state.
26255
26256 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
26257
26258 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
26259
26260 Reply:
26261 @table @samp
26262 @item E @var{nn}
26263 for an error
26264 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26265 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26266 @end table
26267
26268 @item vStopped
26269 @anchor{vStopped packet}
26270 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
26271
26272 In non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}), acknowledge a previous stop
26273 reply and prompt for the stub to report another one.
26274
26275 Reply:
26276 @table @samp
26277 @item @r{Any stop packet}
26278 if there is another unreported stop event (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
26279 @item OK
26280 if there are no unreported stop events
26281 @end table
26282
26283 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
26284 @anchor{X packet}
26285 @cindex @samp{X} packet
26286 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
26287 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes,
26288 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
26289
26290 Reply:
26291 @table @samp
26292 @item OK
26293 for success
26294 @item E @var{NN}
26295 for an error
26296 @end table
26297
26298 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26299 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{length}
26300 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
26301 @cindex @samp{z} packet
26302 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
26303 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
26304 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
26305 @var{length} bytes.
26306
26307 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
26308 separately.
26309
26310 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
26311 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
26312 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
26313 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
26314 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
26315 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
26316
26317 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26318 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{length}
26319 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
26320 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
26321 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
26322 @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26323
26324 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
26325 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
26326 @var{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
26327 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
26328 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
26329
26330 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
26331 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
26332 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
26333 target, is not defined.}
26334
26335 Reply:
26336 @table @samp
26337 @item OK
26338 success
26339 @item
26340 not supported
26341 @item E @var{NN}
26342 for an error
26343 @end table
26344
26345 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26346 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{length}
26347 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
26348 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
26349 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
26350 address @var{addr} of size @var{length}.
26351
26352 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
26353 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
26354
26355 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
26356 movement.}
26357
26358 Reply:
26359 @table @samp
26360 @item OK
26361 success
26362 @item
26363 not supported
26364 @item E @var{NN}
26365 for an error
26366 @end table
26367
26368 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26369 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{length}
26370 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
26371 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
26372 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint.
26373
26374 Reply:
26375 @table @samp
26376 @item OK
26377 success
26378 @item
26379 not supported
26380 @item E @var{NN}
26381 for an error
26382 @end table
26383
26384 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26385 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{length}
26386 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
26387 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
26388 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint.
26389
26390 Reply:
26391 @table @samp
26392 @item OK
26393 success
26394 @item
26395 not supported
26396 @item E @var{NN}
26397 for an error
26398 @end table
26399
26400 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26401 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{length}
26402 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
26403 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
26404 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint.
26405
26406 Reply:
26407 @table @samp
26408 @item OK
26409 success
26410 @item
26411 not supported
26412 @item E @var{NN}
26413 for an error
26414 @end table
26415
26416 @end table
26417
26418 @node Stop Reply Packets
26419 @section Stop Reply Packets
26420 @cindex stop reply packets
26421
26422 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
26423 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
26424 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
26425 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
26426 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
26427 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
26428 @value{GDBN} source code.
26429
26430 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
26431 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
26432 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
26433 components.
26434
26435 @table @samp
26436
26437 @item S @var{AA}
26438 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26439 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
26440 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
26441
26442 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
26443 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
26444 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
26445 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
26446 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
26447 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
26448 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
26449 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
26450
26451 @itemize @bullet
26452 @item
26453 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
26454 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. @var{r} is a
26455 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
26456 two-digit hex number.
26457
26458 @item
26459 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
26460 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26461
26462 @item
26463 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
26464 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
26465 reasons are listed below. @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
26466 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
26467
26468 @item
26469 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
26470 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
26471 future.
26472 @end itemize
26473
26474 The currently defined stop reasons are:
26475
26476 @table @samp
26477 @item watch
26478 @itemx rwatch
26479 @itemx awatch
26480 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
26481 hex.
26482
26483 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
26484 @item library
26485 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
26486 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
26487 list of loaded libraries. @var{r} is ignored.
26488
26489 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
26490 @item replaylog
26491 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
26492 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
26493 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
26494 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
26495 for more information.
26496
26497
26498 @end table
26499
26500 @item W @var{AA}
26501 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26502 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
26503 applicable to certain targets.
26504
26505 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
26506 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
26507 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
26508 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26509
26510 @item X @var{AA}
26511 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
26512 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
26513
26514 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
26515 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
26516 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
26517 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
26518
26519 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
26520 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
26521 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
26522 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
26523 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
26524
26525 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
26526 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
26527 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
26528 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
26529 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
26530 system calls.
26531
26532 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
26533 this very system call.
26534
26535 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
26536 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
26537 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
26538 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
26539 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
26540 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
26541
26542 @end table
26543
26544 @node General Query Packets
26545 @section General Query Packets
26546 @cindex remote query requests
26547
26548 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
26549 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
26550 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
26551 sending information to and from the stub.
26552
26553 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
26554 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
26555 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
26556 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
26557 conventions:
26558
26559 @itemize @bullet
26560 @item
26561 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
26562 @item
26563 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
26564 letter.
26565 @item
26566 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
26567 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
26568 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
26569 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
26570 @end itemize
26571
26572 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
26573 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
26574 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
26575 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
26576 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
26577 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
26578 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
26579 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
26580 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
26581 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
26582 packet.}.
26583
26584 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
26585 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
26586 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
26587 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
26588 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
26589
26590 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
26591
26592 @table @samp
26593
26594 @item qC
26595 @cindex current thread, remote request
26596 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
26597 Return the current thread ID.
26598
26599 Reply:
26600 @table @samp
26601 @item QC @var{thread-id}
26602 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
26603 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
26604 @item @r{(anything else)}
26605 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
26606 @end table
26607
26608 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
26609 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
26610 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
26611 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory.
26612 Reply:
26613 @table @samp
26614 @item E @var{NN}
26615 An error (such as memory fault)
26616 @item C @var{crc32}
26617 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
26618 @end table
26619
26620 @item qfThreadInfo
26621 @itemx qsThreadInfo
26622 @cindex list active threads, remote request
26623 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
26624 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
26625 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
26626 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
26627 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
26628 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
26629 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
26630 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
26631
26632 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
26633
26634 Reply:
26635 @table @samp
26636 @item m @var{thread-id}
26637 A single thread ID
26638 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
26639 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
26640 @item l
26641 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
26642 @end table
26643
26644 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
26645 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
26646 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
26647 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
26648 with @samp{l} (lower-case el, for @dfn{last}).
26649 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
26650 fields.
26651
26652 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
26653 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
26654 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
26655 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
26656 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
26657
26658 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
26659 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
26660
26661 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
26662 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
26663 information associated with the variable.)
26664
26665 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
26666 the load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
26667 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
26668 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
26669 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
26670 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
26671
26672 Reply:
26673 @table @samp
26674 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
26675 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
26676 local storage requested.
26677
26678 @item E @var{nn}
26679 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26680
26681 @item
26682 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
26683 @end table
26684
26685 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
26686 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
26687 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
26688 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
26689 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
26690 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
26691 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
26692
26693 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
26694
26695 Reply:
26696 @table @samp
26697 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
26698 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
26699 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
26700 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
26701 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
26702 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
26703 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
26704 @end table
26705
26706 @item qOffsets
26707 @cindex section offsets, remote request
26708 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
26709 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
26710 image.
26711
26712 Reply:
26713 @table @samp
26714 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
26715 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
26716 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
26717 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
26718 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
26719 segments by the supplied offsets.
26720
26721 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
26722 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
26723 to the @code{Bss} section.}
26724
26725 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
26726 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
26727 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
26728 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
26729 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
26730 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
26731 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
26732 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
26733 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
26734 @end table
26735
26736 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
26737 @cindex thread information, remote request
26738 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
26739 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
26740 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
26741 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
26742
26743 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
26744 (see below).
26745
26746 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
26747
26748 @item QNonStop:1
26749 @item QNonStop:0
26750 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
26751 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
26752 @anchor{QNonStop}
26753 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
26754 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
26755
26756 Reply:
26757 @table @samp
26758 @item OK
26759 The request succeeded.
26760
26761 @item E @var{nn}
26762 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26763
26764 @item
26765 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
26766 the stub.
26767 @end table
26768
26769 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26770 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26771 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
26772 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
26773
26774 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
26775 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
26776 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
26777 @anchor{QPassSignals}
26778 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
26779 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
26780 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
26781 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
26782 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
26783 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
26784 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
26785 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
26786 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
26787
26788 Reply:
26789 @table @samp
26790 @item OK
26791 The request succeeded.
26792
26793 @item E @var{nn}
26794 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
26795
26796 @item
26797 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
26798 the stub.
26799 @end table
26800
26801 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
26802 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
26803 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
26804 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
26805
26806 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
26807 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
26808 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
26809 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
26810 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
26811 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
26812 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
26813 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
26814 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
26815
26816 Reply:
26817 @table @samp
26818 @item OK
26819 A command response with no output.
26820 @item @var{OUTPUT}
26821 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
26822 @item E @var{NN}
26823 Indicate a badly formed request.
26824 @item
26825 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
26826 @end table
26827
26828 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
26829 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
26830 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
26831 packets.)
26832
26833 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
26834 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
26835 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
26836 @anchor{qSearch memory}
26837 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
26838 @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex.
26839 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, hex encoded.
26840
26841 Reply:
26842 @table @samp
26843 @item 0
26844 The pattern was not found.
26845 @item 1,address
26846 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
26847 @item E @var{NN}
26848 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
26849 @item
26850 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
26851 @end table
26852
26853 @item QStartNoAckMode
26854 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
26855 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
26856 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
26857 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
26858
26859 Reply:
26860 @table @samp
26861 @item OK
26862 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
26863 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
26864 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
26865 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
26866 @item
26867 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
26868 @end table
26869
26870 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
26871 @cindex supported packets, remote query
26872 @cindex features of the remote protocol
26873 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
26874 @anchor{qSupported}
26875 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
26876 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
26877 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
26878 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
26879 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
26880 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
26881 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
26882 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
26883 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
26884 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
26885 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
26886 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
26887 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
26888 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
26889
26890 Reply:
26891 @table @samp
26892 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
26893 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
26894 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
26895 possible forms).
26896 @item
26897 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
26898 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
26899 @end table
26900
26901 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
26902 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
26903 are:
26904
26905 @table @samp
26906 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
26907 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
26908 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
26909 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
26910 @item @var{name}+
26911 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
26912 need an associated value.
26913 @item @var{name}-
26914 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
26915 @item @var{name}?
26916 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
26917 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
26918 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
26919 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
26920 @end table
26921
26922 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
26923 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
26924 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
26925 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
26926 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
26927
26928 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
26929 are defined:
26930
26931 @table @samp
26932 @item multiprocess
26933 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
26934 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
26935 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
26936 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
26937 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
26938 @end table
26939
26940 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
26941 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
26942 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
26943 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
26944 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
26945 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
26946 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
26947 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
26948 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
26949 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
26950 all the features it supports.
26951
26952 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
26953 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
26954
26955 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
26956 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
26957 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
26958 form response.
26959
26960 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
26961 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
26962 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
26963 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
26964
26965 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
26966 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
26967 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
26968 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
26969 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
26970
26971 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
26972
26973 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
26974 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
26975 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
26976 @item Feature Name
26977 @tab Value Required
26978 @tab Default
26979 @tab Probe Allowed
26980
26981 @item @samp{PacketSize}
26982 @tab Yes
26983 @tab @samp{-}
26984 @tab No
26985
26986 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
26987 @tab No
26988 @tab @samp{-}
26989 @tab Yes
26990
26991 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
26992 @tab No
26993 @tab @samp{-}
26994 @tab Yes
26995
26996 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
26997 @tab No
26998 @tab @samp{-}
26999 @tab Yes
27000
27001 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
27002 @tab No
27003 @tab @samp{-}
27004 @tab Yes
27005
27006 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
27007 @tab No
27008 @tab @samp{-}
27009 @tab Yes
27010
27011 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
27012 @tab No
27013 @tab @samp{-}
27014 @tab Yes
27015
27016 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
27017 @tab No
27018 @tab @samp{-}
27019 @tab Yes
27020
27021 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
27022 @tab No
27023 @tab @samp{-}
27024 @tab Yes
27025
27026 @item @samp{QNonStop}
27027 @tab No
27028 @tab @samp{-}
27029 @tab Yes
27030
27031 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
27032 @tab No
27033 @tab @samp{-}
27034 @tab Yes
27035
27036 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
27037 @tab No
27038 @tab @samp{-}
27039 @tab Yes
27040
27041 @item @samp{multiprocess}
27042 @tab No
27043 @tab @samp{-}
27044 @tab No
27045
27046 @end multitable
27047
27048 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
27049
27050 @table @samp
27051 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
27052 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
27053 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
27054 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
27055 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
27056 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
27057 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
27058 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
27059 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
27060 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
27061
27062 @item qXfer:auxv:read
27063 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
27064 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
27065
27066 @item qXfer:features:read
27067 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
27068 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
27069
27070 @item qXfer:libraries:read
27071 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
27072 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
27073
27074 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
27075 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
27076 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
27077
27078 @item qXfer:spu:read
27079 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
27080 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
27081
27082 @item qXfer:spu:write
27083 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
27084 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
27085
27086 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
27087 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
27088 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
27089
27090 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
27091 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
27092 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
27093
27094 @item QNonStop
27095 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
27096 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
27097
27098 @item QPassSignals
27099 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
27100 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
27101
27102 @item QStartNoAckMode
27103 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
27104 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
27105
27106 @item multiprocess
27107 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
27108 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
27109 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
27110 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
27111 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
27112 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
27113 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
27114 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
27115 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
27116 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
27117 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
27118
27119 @item qXfer:osdata:read
27120 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
27121 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
27122
27123 @end table
27124
27125 @item qSymbol::
27126 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
27127 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
27128 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
27129 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
27130
27131 Reply:
27132 @table @samp
27133 @item OK
27134 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27135 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27136 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
27137 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
27138 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
27139 below.
27140 @end table
27141
27142 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
27143 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
27144
27145 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
27146 target has previously requested.
27147
27148 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
27149 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
27150 will be empty.
27151
27152 Reply:
27153 @table @samp
27154 @item OK
27155 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
27156 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
27157 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
27158 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
27159 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
27160 @end table
27161
27162 @item QTDP
27163 @itemx QTFrame
27164 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27165
27166 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
27167 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
27168 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
27169 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
27170 the target OS. @var{thread-id} is a thread ID;
27171 see @ref{thread-id syntax}. This
27172 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
27173 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
27174 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
27175 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
27176 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
27177
27178 Reply:
27179 @table @samp
27180 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
27181 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
27182 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
27183 the thread's attributes.
27184 @end table
27185
27186 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
27187 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
27188 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
27189 packets.)
27190
27191 @item QTStart
27192 @itemx QTStop
27193 @itemx QTinit
27194 @itemx QTro
27195 @itemx qTStatus
27196 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
27197
27198 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27199 @cindex read special object, remote request
27200 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
27201 @anchor{qXfer read}
27202 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
27203 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
27204 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
27205 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
27206 additional details about what data to access.
27207
27208 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27209 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27210 formats, listed below.
27211
27212 @table @samp
27213 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27214 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
27215 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
27216 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
27217
27218 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27219 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27220
27221 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27222 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
27223 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
27224 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
27225 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
27226
27227 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27228 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27229
27230 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27231 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
27232 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
27233 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27234 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27235
27236 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
27237 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
27238 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
27239
27240 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27241 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27242
27243 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27244 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
27245 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
27246 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
27247 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27248
27249 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27250 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27251
27252 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27253 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
27254 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
27255 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27256 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
27257
27258 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27259 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27260 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27261
27262 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
27263 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
27264 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27265 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
27266 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27267 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27268 in that context to be accessed.
27269
27270 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27271 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27272 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27273
27274 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
27275 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
27276 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
27277 @xref{Operating System Information}.
27278
27279 @end table
27280
27281 Reply:
27282 @table @samp
27283 @item m @var{data}
27284 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
27285 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
27286 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
27287 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
27288 @var{data} may have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
27289 request.
27290
27291 @item l @var{data}
27292 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
27293 There is no more data to be read. @var{data} may have fewer bytes
27294 than the @var{length} in the request.
27295
27296 @item l
27297 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
27298 There is no more data to be read.
27299
27300 @item E00
27301 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27302
27303 @item E @var{nn}
27304 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
27305 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27306
27307 @item
27308 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
27309 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
27310 @end table
27311
27312 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27313 @cindex write data into object, remote request
27314 @anchor{qXfer write}
27315 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
27316 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
27317 into the data. @var{data}@dots{} is the binary-encoded data
27318 (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be written. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
27319 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
27320 to access.
27321
27322 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
27323 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
27324 formats, listed below.
27325
27326 @table @samp
27327 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27328 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
27329 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
27330 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
27331 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
27332
27333 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27334 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
27335 (@pxref{qSupported}).
27336
27337 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
27338 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
27339 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
27340 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
27341 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
27342 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
27343 in that context to be accessed.
27344
27345 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
27346 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27347 @end table
27348
27349 Reply:
27350 @table @samp
27351 @item @var{nn}
27352 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
27353 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
27354
27355 @item E00
27356 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
27357
27358 @item E @var{nn}
27359 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
27360 @var{nn} is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
27361
27362 @item
27363 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
27364 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
27365 @end table
27366
27367 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
27368 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
27369 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
27370 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
27371 must respond with an empty packet.
27372
27373 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
27374 @cindex query attached, remote request
27375 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
27376 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
27377 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
27378 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
27379 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
27380 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
27381 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
27382
27383 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
27384 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
27385 the @code{quit} command.
27386
27387 Reply:
27388 @table @samp
27389 @item 1
27390 The remote server attached to an existing process.
27391 @item 0
27392 The remote server created a new process.
27393 @item E @var{NN}
27394 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
27395 @end table
27396
27397 @end table
27398
27399 @node Register Packet Format
27400 @section Register Packet Format
27401
27402 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
27403 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
27404 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
27405 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
27406 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
27407 most-significant - least-significant.
27408
27409 @table @r
27410
27411 @item MIPS32
27412
27413 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
27414 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
27415 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
27416
27417 @item MIPS64
27418
27419 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
27420 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
27421 as @code{MIPS32}.
27422
27423 @end table
27424
27425 @node Tracepoint Packets
27426 @section Tracepoint Packets
27427 @cindex tracepoint packets
27428 @cindex packets, tracepoint
27429
27430 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
27431 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
27432
27433 @table @samp
27434
27435 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}@r{[}-@r{]}
27436 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
27437 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
27438 the tracepoint is disabled. @var{step} is the tracepoint's step
27439 count, and @var{pass} is its pass count. If the trailing @samp{-} is
27440 present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this
27441 tracepoint's actions.
27442
27443 Replies:
27444 @table @samp
27445 @item OK
27446 The packet was understood and carried out.
27447 @item
27448 The packet was not recognized.
27449 @end table
27450
27451 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
27452 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. @var{n} and
27453 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
27454 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
27455 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
27456 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
27457 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
27458
27459 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
27460 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
27461 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
27462 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
27463 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
27464 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
27465 tracepoint actions.
27466
27467 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
27468 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
27469 following forms:
27470
27471 @table @samp
27472
27473 @item R @var{mask}
27474 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask}. @var{mask} is
27475 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
27476 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
27477 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
27478 not fit in a 32-bit word.
27479
27480 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
27481 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
27482 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
27483 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
27484 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
27485 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
27486 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
27487
27488 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
27489 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
27490 it directs. @var{expr} is an agent expression, as described in
27491 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
27492 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
27493 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
27494 packet).
27495
27496 @end table
27497
27498 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
27499 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
27500 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
27501 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
27502 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
27503 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
27504 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
27505 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
27506
27507 Replies:
27508 @table @samp
27509 @item OK
27510 The packet was understood and carried out.
27511 @item
27512 The packet was not recognized.
27513 @end table
27514
27515 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
27516 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
27517 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
27518 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
27519
27520 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
27521 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
27522 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
27523 one of the following forms:
27524
27525 @table @samp
27526 @item F @var{f}
27527 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
27528 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
27529 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
27530
27531 @item T @var{t}
27532 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
27533 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
27534
27535 @end table
27536
27537 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
27538 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27539 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
27540 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
27541
27542 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
27543 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27544 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
27545 is a hexadecimal number.
27546
27547 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
27548 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
27549 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
27550 and @var{end} (exclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
27551 numbers.
27552
27553 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
27554 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
27555 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses.
27556
27557 @item QTStart
27558 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from tracepoint
27559 hits in the trace frame buffer.
27560
27561 @item QTStop
27562 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
27563
27564 @item QTinit
27565 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
27566
27567 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
27568 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
27569 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
27570 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
27571
27572 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
27573 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
27574 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
27575 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
27576
27577 @item qTStatus
27578 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
27579
27580 Replies:
27581 @table @samp
27582 @item T0
27583 There is no trace experiment running.
27584 @item T1
27585 There is a trace experiment running.
27586 @end table
27587
27588 @end table
27589
27590
27591 @node Host I/O Packets
27592 @section Host I/O Packets
27593 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
27594 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
27595
27596 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
27597 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
27598 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
27599 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
27600 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
27601 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
27602 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
27603 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
27604 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
27605 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
27606
27607 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
27608 its arguments. They have this format:
27609
27610 @table @samp
27611
27612 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
27613 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
27614 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
27615 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
27616 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
27617 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
27618 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
27619 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
27620 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
27621
27622 @end table
27623
27624 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
27625
27626 @table @samp
27627
27628 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
27629 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
27630 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
27631 @var{errno} will be included in the result. @var{errno} will have a
27632 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
27633 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
27634 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
27635 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
27636 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
27637 @var{attachment}.
27638
27639 @item
27640 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
27641
27642 @end table
27643
27644 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
27645
27646 @table @samp
27647 @item vFile:open: @var{pathname}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
27648 Open a file at @var{pathname} and return a file descriptor for it, or
27649 return -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string,
27650 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
27651 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
27652 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
27653 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
27654
27655 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
27656 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
27657 -1 if an error occurs.
27658
27659 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
27660 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
27661 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
27662 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
27663 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
27664 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
27665 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
27666 @var{count} was zero.
27667
27668 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
27669 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
27670 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
27671 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
27672 some characters were escaped.
27673
27674 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
27675 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
27676 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
27677 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
27678 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
27679 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
27680 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
27681 error occurred.
27682
27683 @item vFile:unlink: @var{pathname}
27684 Delete the file at @var{pathname} on the target. Return 0,
27685 or -1 if an error occurs. @var{pathname} is a string.
27686
27687 @end table
27688
27689 @node Interrupts
27690 @section Interrupts
27691 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
27692
27693 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
27694 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C} or a @code{BREAK},
27695 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{remotebreak}
27696 setting (@pxref{set remotebreak}).
27697
27698 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
27699 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
27700 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
27701 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
27702 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
27703
27704 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
27705 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
27706 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
27707 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
27708 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
27709 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
27710 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
27711 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
27712
27713 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
27714 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
27715 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
27716 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
27717 currently-executing threads and processes.
27718 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
27719 running program, it should send one of the stop
27720 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
27721 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
27722 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
27723 Interrupts received while the
27724 program is stopped are discarded.
27725
27726 @node Notification Packets
27727 @section Notification Packets
27728 @cindex notification packets
27729 @cindex packets, notification
27730
27731 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
27732 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
27733 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
27734 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
27735 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
27736 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
27737 is not a problem.
27738
27739 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
27740 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
27741 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
27742 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
27743 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
27744 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
27745 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
27746
27747 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
27748 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
27749
27750 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
27751 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
27752 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
27753 not they understand it.
27754
27755 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
27756 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
27757 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
27758 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
27759 recipients.
27760
27761 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
27762 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
27763 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
27764 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
27765 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
27766
27767 The following notification packets from the stub to @value{GDBN} are
27768 defined:
27769
27770 @table @samp
27771 @item Stop: @var{reply}
27772 Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
27773 The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
27774 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
27775 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
27776 @value{GDBN}.
27777 @end table
27778
27779 @node Remote Non-Stop
27780 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
27781
27782 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
27783 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
27784 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
27785 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
27786
27787 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
27788 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
27789 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
27790 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
27791 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
27792 probe the target state after a mode change.
27793
27794 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
27795 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
27796 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
27797 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
27798 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
27799 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
27800 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
27801 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
27802 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
27803 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
27804 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
27805
27806 Only one stop reply notification at a time may be pending; if
27807 additional stop events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
27808 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
27809 synchronous transmission in response to @samp{vStopped} packets from
27810 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
27811 the stub is permitted to resend a stop reply notification
27812 if it believes @value{GDBN} may not have received it. @value{GDBN}
27813 ignores additional stop reply notifications received before it has
27814 finished processing a previous notification and the stub has completed
27815 sending any queued stop events.
27816
27817 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} must be prepared to receive a stop reply
27818 notification at any time. Specifically, they may appear when
27819 @value{GDBN} is not otherwise reading input from the stub, or when
27820 @value{GDBN} is expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
27821 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
27822 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
27823 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
27824
27825 After receiving a stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall
27826 acknowledge it by sending a @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{vStopped packet})
27827 as a regular, synchronous request to the stub. Such acknowledgment
27828 is not required to happen immediately, as @value{GDBN} is permitted to
27829 send other, unrelated packets to the stub first, which the stub should
27830 process normally.
27831
27832 Upon receiving a @samp{vStopped} packet, if the stub has other queued
27833 stop events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
27834 normal stop reply response. @value{GDBN} shall then send another
27835 @samp{vStopped} packet to solicit further responses; again, it is
27836 permitted to send other, unrelated packets as well which the stub
27837 should process normally.
27838
27839 If the stub receives a @samp{vStopped} packet and there are no
27840 additional stop events to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK}
27841 response. At this point, if further stop events occur, the stub shall
27842 send a new stop reply notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the
27843 notification, and the process shall be repeated.
27844
27845 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
27846 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
27847 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
27848 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
27849 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
27850 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
27851 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
27852 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
27853 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
27854 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
27855 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
27856 @samp{OK}.
27857
27858 @node Packet Acknowledgment
27859 @section Packet Acknowledgment
27860
27861 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27862 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
27863 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
27864 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
27865 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
27866 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
27867 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
27868
27869 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
27870 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
27871 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
27872 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
27873 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
27874
27875 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
27876 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
27877 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
27878 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
27879
27880 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
27881 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
27882 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
27883 @pxref{qSupported}.
27884 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
27885 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
27886 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
27887 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
27888 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
27889 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
27890 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
27891
27892 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
27893 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
27894 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
27895 connection.
27896 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
27897 new connection is established,
27898 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
27899 for the current connection, once disabled.
27900
27901 @node Examples
27902 @section Examples
27903
27904 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
27905 does not get any direct output:
27906
27907 @smallexample
27908 -> @code{R00}
27909 <- @code{+}
27910 @emph{target restarts}
27911 -> @code{?}
27912 <- @code{+}
27913 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27914 -> @code{+}
27915 @end smallexample
27916
27917 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
27918
27919 @smallexample
27920 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
27921 <- @code{+}
27922 -> @code{s}
27923 <- @code{+}
27924 @emph{time passes}
27925 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
27926 -> @code{+}
27927 -> @code{g}
27928 <- @code{+}
27929 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
27930 -> @code{+}
27931 @end smallexample
27932
27933 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27934 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
27935 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
27936
27937 @menu
27938 * File-I/O Overview::
27939 * Protocol Basics::
27940 * The F Request Packet::
27941 * The F Reply Packet::
27942 * The Ctrl-C Message::
27943 * Console I/O::
27944 * List of Supported Calls::
27945 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
27946 * Constants::
27947 * File-I/O Examples::
27948 @end menu
27949
27950 @node File-I/O Overview
27951 @subsection File-I/O Overview
27952 @cindex file-i/o overview
27953
27954 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
27955 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
27956 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
27957 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
27958 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
27959 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
27960
27961 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
27962 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
27963 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
27964 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
27965 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
27966
27967 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
27968 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
27969 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
27970 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
27971 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
27972 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
27973 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
27974
27975 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
27976 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
27977 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
27978 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
27979 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
27980
27981 @smallexample
27982 (@value{GDBP}) continue
27983 <- target requests 'system call X'
27984 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
27985 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
27986 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
27987 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
27988 @end smallexample
27989
27990 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
27991 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
27992 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
27993 system are not supported by this protocol.
27994
27995 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
27996
27997 @node Protocol Basics
27998 @subsection Protocol Basics
27999 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
28000
28001 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
28002 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
28003 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
28004 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
28005 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
28006 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
28007 to call the appropriate host system call:
28008
28009 @itemize @bullet
28010 @item
28011 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
28012
28013 @item
28014 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
28015 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
28016 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
28017 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
28018
28019 @end itemize
28020
28021 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
28022
28023 @itemize @bullet
28024 @item
28025 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
28026 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
28027 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
28028 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
28029 packet.
28030
28031 @item
28032 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
28033 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
28034
28035 @item
28036 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
28037
28038 @item
28039 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
28040
28041 @item
28042 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
28043 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
28044 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
28045 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
28046 packet.
28047
28048 @end itemize
28049
28050 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
28051 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
28052
28053 @itemize @bullet
28054 @item
28055 Return value.
28056
28057 @item
28058 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
28059
28060 @item
28061 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
28062
28063 @end itemize
28064
28065 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
28066 the latest continue or step action.
28067
28068 @node The F Request Packet
28069 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
28070 @cindex file-i/o request packet
28071 @cindex @code{F} request packet
28072
28073 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
28074
28075 @table @samp
28076 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
28077
28078 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
28079 This is just the name of the function.
28080
28081 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
28082 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
28083 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
28084 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
28085 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
28086 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
28087 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
28088
28089 @end table
28090
28091
28092
28093 @node The F Reply Packet
28094 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
28095 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
28096 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
28097
28098 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
28099
28100 @table @samp
28101
28102 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
28103
28104 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
28105
28106 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
28107 representation.
28108 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
28109
28110 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
28111 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
28112 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
28113
28114 @smallexample
28115 F0,0,C
28116 @end smallexample
28117
28118 @noindent
28119 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
28120
28121 @smallexample
28122 F-1,4,C
28123 @end smallexample
28124
28125 @noindent
28126 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
28127
28128 @end table
28129
28130
28131 @node The Ctrl-C Message
28132 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
28133 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
28134
28135 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
28136 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
28137 the target should behave as if it had
28138 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
28139 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
28140 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
28141 packet.
28142
28143 It's important for the target to know in which
28144 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
28145
28146 @itemize @bullet
28147 @item
28148 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
28149
28150 @item
28151 The system call on the host has been finished.
28152
28153 @end itemize
28154
28155 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
28156 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
28157 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
28158 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
28159 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
28160 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
28161
28162 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
28163 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
28164 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
28165 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
28166 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
28167 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
28168 or the full action has been completed.
28169
28170 @node Console I/O
28171 @subsection Console I/O
28172 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
28173
28174 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
28175 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
28176 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
28177 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
28178 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
28179 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
28180 conditions is met:
28181
28182 @itemize @bullet
28183 @item
28184 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
28185 @code{read}
28186 system call is treated as finished.
28187
28188 @item
28189 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
28190 newline.
28191
28192 @item
28193 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
28194 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
28195
28196 @end itemize
28197
28198 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
28199 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
28200 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
28201 is stopped at the user's request.
28202
28203
28204 @node List of Supported Calls
28205 @subsection List of Supported Calls
28206 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
28207
28208 @menu
28209 * open::
28210 * close::
28211 * read::
28212 * write::
28213 * lseek::
28214 * rename::
28215 * unlink::
28216 * stat/fstat::
28217 * gettimeofday::
28218 * isatty::
28219 * system::
28220 @end menu
28221
28222 @node open
28223 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
28224 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
28225
28226 @table @asis
28227 @item Synopsis:
28228 @smallexample
28229 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
28230 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
28231 @end smallexample
28232
28233 @item Request:
28234 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
28235
28236 @noindent
28237 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28238
28239 @table @code
28240 @item O_CREAT
28241 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
28242 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
28243 are concerned.
28244
28245 @item O_EXCL
28246 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
28247 an error and open() fails.
28248
28249 @item O_TRUNC
28250 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
28251 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
28252 truncated to zero length.
28253
28254 @item O_APPEND
28255 The file is opened in append mode.
28256
28257 @item O_RDONLY
28258 The file is opened for reading only.
28259
28260 @item O_WRONLY
28261 The file is opened for writing only.
28262
28263 @item O_RDWR
28264 The file is opened for reading and writing.
28265 @end table
28266
28267 @noindent
28268 Other bits are silently ignored.
28269
28270
28271 @noindent
28272 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
28273
28274 @table @code
28275 @item S_IRUSR
28276 User has read permission.
28277
28278 @item S_IWUSR
28279 User has write permission.
28280
28281 @item S_IRGRP
28282 Group has read permission.
28283
28284 @item S_IWGRP
28285 Group has write permission.
28286
28287 @item S_IROTH
28288 Others have read permission.
28289
28290 @item S_IWOTH
28291 Others have write permission.
28292 @end table
28293
28294 @noindent
28295 Other bits are silently ignored.
28296
28297
28298 @item Return value:
28299 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
28300 occurred.
28301
28302 @item Errors:
28303
28304 @table @code
28305 @item EEXIST
28306 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
28307
28308 @item EISDIR
28309 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
28310
28311 @item EACCES
28312 The requested access is not allowed.
28313
28314 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28315 @var{pathname} was too long.
28316
28317 @item ENOENT
28318 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28319
28320 @item ENODEV
28321 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
28322
28323 @item EROFS
28324 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
28325 write access was requested.
28326
28327 @item EFAULT
28328 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
28329
28330 @item ENOSPC
28331 No space on device to create the file.
28332
28333 @item EMFILE
28334 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
28335
28336 @item ENFILE
28337 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
28338 has been reached.
28339
28340 @item EINTR
28341 The call was interrupted by the user.
28342 @end table
28343
28344 @end table
28345
28346 @node close
28347 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
28348 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
28349
28350 @table @asis
28351 @item Synopsis:
28352 @smallexample
28353 int close(int fd);
28354 @end smallexample
28355
28356 @item Request:
28357 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
28358
28359 @item Return value:
28360 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
28361
28362 @item Errors:
28363
28364 @table @code
28365 @item EBADF
28366 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
28367
28368 @item EINTR
28369 The call was interrupted by the user.
28370 @end table
28371
28372 @end table
28373
28374 @node read
28375 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
28376 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
28377
28378 @table @asis
28379 @item Synopsis:
28380 @smallexample
28381 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
28382 @end smallexample
28383
28384 @item Request:
28385 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28386
28387 @item Return value:
28388 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
28389 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
28390 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
28391
28392 @item Errors:
28393
28394 @table @code
28395 @item EBADF
28396 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28397 reading.
28398
28399 @item EFAULT
28400 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28401
28402 @item EINTR
28403 The call was interrupted by the user.
28404 @end table
28405
28406 @end table
28407
28408 @node write
28409 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
28410 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
28411
28412 @table @asis
28413 @item Synopsis:
28414 @smallexample
28415 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
28416 @end smallexample
28417
28418 @item Request:
28419 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
28420
28421 @item Return value:
28422 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
28423 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
28424 is returned.
28425
28426 @item Errors:
28427
28428 @table @code
28429 @item EBADF
28430 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
28431 writing.
28432
28433 @item EFAULT
28434 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28435
28436 @item EFBIG
28437 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
28438 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
28439
28440 @item ENOSPC
28441 No space on device to write the data.
28442
28443 @item EINTR
28444 The call was interrupted by the user.
28445 @end table
28446
28447 @end table
28448
28449 @node lseek
28450 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
28451 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
28452
28453 @table @asis
28454 @item Synopsis:
28455 @smallexample
28456 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
28457 @end smallexample
28458
28459 @item Request:
28460 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
28461
28462 @var{flag} is one of:
28463
28464 @table @code
28465 @item SEEK_SET
28466 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
28467
28468 @item SEEK_CUR
28469 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
28470 bytes.
28471
28472 @item SEEK_END
28473 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
28474 bytes.
28475 @end table
28476
28477 @item Return value:
28478 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
28479 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
28480 value of -1 is returned.
28481
28482 @item Errors:
28483
28484 @table @code
28485 @item EBADF
28486 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
28487
28488 @item ESPIPE
28489 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
28490
28491 @item EINVAL
28492 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
28493
28494 @item EINTR
28495 The call was interrupted by the user.
28496 @end table
28497
28498 @end table
28499
28500 @node rename
28501 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
28502 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
28503
28504 @table @asis
28505 @item Synopsis:
28506 @smallexample
28507 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
28508 @end smallexample
28509
28510 @item Request:
28511 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
28512
28513 @item Return value:
28514 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28515
28516 @item Errors:
28517
28518 @table @code
28519 @item EISDIR
28520 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
28521 directory.
28522
28523 @item EEXIST
28524 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
28525
28526 @item EBUSY
28527 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
28528 process.
28529
28530 @item EINVAL
28531 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
28532 of itself.
28533
28534 @item ENOTDIR
28535 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
28536 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
28537 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
28538
28539 @item EFAULT
28540 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
28541
28542 @item EACCES
28543 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28544
28545 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28546
28547 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
28548
28549 @item ENOENT
28550 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
28551
28552 @item EROFS
28553 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28554
28555 @item ENOSPC
28556 The device containing the file has no room for the new
28557 directory entry.
28558
28559 @item EINTR
28560 The call was interrupted by the user.
28561 @end table
28562
28563 @end table
28564
28565 @node unlink
28566 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
28567 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
28568
28569 @table @asis
28570 @item Synopsis:
28571 @smallexample
28572 int unlink(const char *pathname);
28573 @end smallexample
28574
28575 @item Request:
28576 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
28577
28578 @item Return value:
28579 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28580
28581 @item Errors:
28582
28583 @table @code
28584 @item EACCES
28585 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28586
28587 @item EPERM
28588 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
28589
28590 @item EBUSY
28591 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
28592 being used by another process.
28593
28594 @item EFAULT
28595 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28596
28597 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28598 @var{pathname} was too long.
28599
28600 @item ENOENT
28601 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
28602
28603 @item ENOTDIR
28604 A component of the path is not a directory.
28605
28606 @item EROFS
28607 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
28608
28609 @item EINTR
28610 The call was interrupted by the user.
28611 @end table
28612
28613 @end table
28614
28615 @node stat/fstat
28616 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
28617 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
28618 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
28619
28620 @table @asis
28621 @item Synopsis:
28622 @smallexample
28623 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
28624 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
28625 @end smallexample
28626
28627 @item Request:
28628 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
28629 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
28630
28631 @item Return value:
28632 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
28633
28634 @item Errors:
28635
28636 @table @code
28637 @item EBADF
28638 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
28639
28640 @item ENOENT
28641 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
28642 path is an empty string.
28643
28644 @item ENOTDIR
28645 A component of the path is not a directory.
28646
28647 @item EFAULT
28648 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28649
28650 @item EACCES
28651 No access to the file or the path of the file.
28652
28653 @item ENAMETOOLONG
28654 @var{pathname} was too long.
28655
28656 @item EINTR
28657 The call was interrupted by the user.
28658 @end table
28659
28660 @end table
28661
28662 @node gettimeofday
28663 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
28664 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
28665
28666 @table @asis
28667 @item Synopsis:
28668 @smallexample
28669 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
28670 @end smallexample
28671
28672 @item Request:
28673 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
28674
28675 @item Return value:
28676 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
28677
28678 @item Errors:
28679
28680 @table @code
28681 @item EINVAL
28682 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
28683
28684 @item EFAULT
28685 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
28686 @end table
28687
28688 @end table
28689
28690 @node isatty
28691 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
28692 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
28693
28694 @table @asis
28695 @item Synopsis:
28696 @smallexample
28697 int isatty(int fd);
28698 @end smallexample
28699
28700 @item Request:
28701 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
28702
28703 @item Return value:
28704 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
28705
28706 @item Errors:
28707
28708 @table @code
28709 @item EINTR
28710 The call was interrupted by the user.
28711 @end table
28712
28713 @end table
28714
28715 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
28716 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
28717 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
28718 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
28719 needed.
28720
28721
28722 @node system
28723 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
28724 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
28725
28726 @table @asis
28727 @item Synopsis:
28728 @smallexample
28729 int system(const char *command);
28730 @end smallexample
28731
28732 @item Request:
28733 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
28734
28735 @item Return value:
28736 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
28737 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
28738 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
28739 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
28740 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
28741 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
28742 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
28743
28744 @item Errors:
28745
28746 @table @code
28747 @item EINTR
28748 The call was interrupted by the user.
28749 @end table
28750
28751 @end table
28752
28753 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
28754 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
28755 the host is simplified before it's returned
28756 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
28757 is discarded, and the return value consists
28758 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
28759
28760 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
28761 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
28762 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
28763
28764 @table @code
28765 @item set remote system-call-allowed
28766 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
28767 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
28768 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
28769
28770 @item show remote system-call-allowed
28771 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
28772 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
28773 protocol.
28774 @end table
28775
28776 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28777 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
28778 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28779
28780 @menu
28781 * Integral Datatypes::
28782 * Pointer Values::
28783 * Memory Transfer::
28784 * struct stat::
28785 * struct timeval::
28786 @end menu
28787
28788 @node Integral Datatypes
28789 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
28790 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
28791
28792 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
28793 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
28794 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
28795
28796 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
28797 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
28798
28799 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
28800
28801 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
28802 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
28803
28804 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
28805
28806 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
28807 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
28808 byte order.
28809
28810 @node Pointer Values
28811 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
28812 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
28813
28814 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
28815 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
28816 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
28817 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
28818
28819 @smallexample
28820 @code{1aaf/12}
28821 @end smallexample
28822
28823 @noindent
28824 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
28825 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
28826 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
28827 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
28828
28829 @smallexample
28830 @code{123456/d}
28831 @end smallexample
28832
28833 @node Memory Transfer
28834 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
28835 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
28836
28837 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
28838 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
28839 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
28840 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
28841 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
28842 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
28843 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
28844
28845
28846 @node struct stat
28847 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
28848 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
28849
28850 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
28851 is defined as follows:
28852
28853 @smallexample
28854 struct stat @{
28855 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
28856 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
28857 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
28858 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
28859 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
28860 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
28861 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
28862 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
28863 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
28864 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
28865 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
28866 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
28867 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
28868 @};
28869 @end smallexample
28870
28871 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28872 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28873 structure is of size 64 bytes.
28874
28875 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
28876 range of values.
28877
28878 @table @code
28879
28880 @item st_dev
28881 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
28882
28883 @item st_ino
28884 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28885
28886 @item st_mode
28887 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
28888 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
28889
28890 @item st_uid
28891 @itemx st_gid
28892 @itemx st_rdev
28893 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
28894
28895 @item st_atime
28896 @itemx st_mtime
28897 @itemx st_ctime
28898 These values have a host and file system dependent
28899 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
28900 support exact timing values.
28901 @end table
28902
28903 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
28904 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
28905 continuing.
28906
28907 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
28908 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
28909 get truncated on the target.
28910
28911 @node struct timeval
28912 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
28913 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
28914
28915 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
28916 is defined as follows:
28917
28918 @smallexample
28919 struct timeval @{
28920 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
28921 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
28922 @};
28923 @end smallexample
28924
28925 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
28926 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
28927 structure is of size 8 bytes.
28928
28929 @node Constants
28930 @subsection Constants
28931 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
28932
28933 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
28934 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
28935 values before and after the call as needed.
28936
28937 @menu
28938 * Open Flags::
28939 * mode_t Values::
28940 * Errno Values::
28941 * Lseek Flags::
28942 * Limits::
28943 @end menu
28944
28945 @node Open Flags
28946 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
28947 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
28948
28949 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
28950
28951 @smallexample
28952 O_RDONLY 0x0
28953 O_WRONLY 0x1
28954 O_RDWR 0x2
28955 O_APPEND 0x8
28956 O_CREAT 0x200
28957 O_TRUNC 0x400
28958 O_EXCL 0x800
28959 @end smallexample
28960
28961 @node mode_t Values
28962 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
28963 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
28964
28965 All values are given in octal representation.
28966
28967 @smallexample
28968 S_IFREG 0100000
28969 S_IFDIR 040000
28970 S_IRUSR 0400
28971 S_IWUSR 0200
28972 S_IXUSR 0100
28973 S_IRGRP 040
28974 S_IWGRP 020
28975 S_IXGRP 010
28976 S_IROTH 04
28977 S_IWOTH 02
28978 S_IXOTH 01
28979 @end smallexample
28980
28981 @node Errno Values
28982 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
28983 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
28984
28985 All values are given in decimal representation.
28986
28987 @smallexample
28988 EPERM 1
28989 ENOENT 2
28990 EINTR 4
28991 EBADF 9
28992 EACCES 13
28993 EFAULT 14
28994 EBUSY 16
28995 EEXIST 17
28996 ENODEV 19
28997 ENOTDIR 20
28998 EISDIR 21
28999 EINVAL 22
29000 ENFILE 23
29001 EMFILE 24
29002 EFBIG 27
29003 ENOSPC 28
29004 ESPIPE 29
29005 EROFS 30
29006 ENAMETOOLONG 91
29007 EUNKNOWN 9999
29008 @end smallexample
29009
29010 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
29011 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
29012
29013 @node Lseek Flags
29014 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
29015 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
29016
29017 @smallexample
29018 SEEK_SET 0
29019 SEEK_CUR 1
29020 SEEK_END 2
29021 @end smallexample
29022
29023 @node Limits
29024 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
29025 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
29026
29027 All values are given in decimal representation.
29028
29029 @smallexample
29030 INT_MIN -2147483648
29031 INT_MAX 2147483647
29032 UINT_MAX 4294967295
29033 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
29034 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
29035 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
29036 @end smallexample
29037
29038 @node File-I/O Examples
29039 @subsection File-I/O Examples
29040 @cindex file-i/o examples
29041
29042 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29043 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
29044
29045 @smallexample
29046 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
29047 @emph{request memory read from target}
29048 -> @code{m1234,6}
29049 <- XXXXXX
29050 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
29051 -> @code{F6}
29052 @end smallexample
29053
29054 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
29055 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
29056
29057 @smallexample
29058 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29059 @emph{request memory write to target}
29060 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29061 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
29062 -> @code{F6}
29063 @end smallexample
29064
29065 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
29066 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
29067
29068 @smallexample
29069 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29070 -> @code{F-1,9}
29071 @end smallexample
29072
29073 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
29074 host is called:
29075
29076 @smallexample
29077 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29078 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
29079 <- @code{T02}
29080 @end smallexample
29081
29082 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
29083 host is called:
29084
29085 @smallexample
29086 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
29087 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
29088 <- @code{T02}
29089 @end smallexample
29090
29091 @node Library List Format
29092 @section Library List Format
29093 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
29094
29095 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
29096 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
29097 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
29098 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
29099 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
29100 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
29101 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
29102 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
29103 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
29104 are loaded.
29105
29106 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
29107 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
29108 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
29109 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
29110
29111 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
29112 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
29113 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
29114 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
29115 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
29116 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
29117
29118 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29119 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
29120
29121 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
29122 offset, looks like this:
29123
29124 @smallexample
29125 <library-list>
29126 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
29127 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
29128 </library>
29129 </library-list>
29130 @end smallexample
29131
29132 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
29133 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
29134
29135 @smallexample
29136 <library-list>
29137 <library name="sharedlib.o">
29138 <section address="0x10000000"/>
29139 <section address="0x20000000"/>
29140 <section address="0x30000000"/>
29141 </library>
29142 </library-list>
29143 @end smallexample
29144
29145 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
29146
29147 @smallexample
29148 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
29149 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
29150 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
29151 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
29152 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29153 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
29154 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29155 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
29156 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
29157 @end smallexample
29158
29159 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
29160 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
29161 section for each library.
29162
29163 @node Memory Map Format
29164 @section Memory Map Format
29165 @cindex memory map format
29166
29167 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
29168 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
29169 memory map.
29170
29171 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
29172 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
29173 lists memory regions.
29174
29175 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29176 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
29177
29178 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
29179
29180 @smallexample
29181 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29182 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
29183 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
29184 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
29185 <memory-map>
29186 region...
29187 </memory-map>
29188 @end smallexample
29189
29190 Each region can be either:
29191
29192 @itemize
29193
29194 @item
29195 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
29196 bytes from there:
29197
29198 @smallexample
29199 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29200 @end smallexample
29201
29202
29203 @item
29204 A region of read-only memory:
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
29208 @end smallexample
29209
29210
29211 @item
29212 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
29213 bytes in length:
29214
29215 @smallexample
29216 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
29217 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
29218 </memory>
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 @end itemize
29222
29223 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
29224 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
29225 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
29226
29227 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
29228
29229 @smallexample
29230 <!-- ................................................... -->
29231 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
29232 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
29233 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
29234 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
29235 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
29236 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
29237 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
29238 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
29239 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
29240 and its type, or device. -->
29241 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
29242 start CDATA #REQUIRED
29243 length CDATA #REQUIRED
29244 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
29245 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
29246 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
29247 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
29248 @end smallexample
29249
29250 @include agentexpr.texi
29251
29252 @node Target Descriptions
29253 @appendix Target Descriptions
29254 @cindex target descriptions
29255
29256 @strong{Warning:} target descriptions are still under active development,
29257 and the contents and format may change between @value{GDBN} releases.
29258 The format is expected to stabilize in the future.
29259
29260 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
29261 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
29262 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
29263 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or MIPS, for example ---
29264 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
29265 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
29266 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
29267
29268 @itemize @bullet
29269 @item
29270 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
29271 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
29272 @item
29273 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
29274 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
29275 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
29276 @item
29277 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
29278 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
29279 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
29280 @end itemize
29281
29282 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
29283 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
29284 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
29285 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
29286 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
29287
29288 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
29289 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
29290
29291 @menu
29292 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
29293 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
29294 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
29295 descriptions.
29296 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
29297 @end menu
29298
29299 @node Retrieving Descriptions
29300 @section Retrieving Descriptions
29301
29302 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
29303 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
29304 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
29305 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
29306 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
29307 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
29308 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
29309 Format}.
29310
29311 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
29312 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
29313 specify a file are:
29314
29315 @table @code
29316 @cindex set tdesc filename
29317 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
29318 Read the target description from @var{path}.
29319
29320 @cindex unset tdesc filename
29321 @item unset tdesc filename
29322 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
29323 will use the description supplied by the current target.
29324
29325 @cindex show tdesc filename
29326 @item show tdesc filename
29327 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
29328 @end table
29329
29330
29331 @node Target Description Format
29332 @section Target Description Format
29333 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
29334
29335 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
29336 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
29337 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
29338 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
29339 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
29340 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
29341 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
29342
29343 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
29344 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
29345 sets. @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
29346 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
29347
29348 Here is a simple target description:
29349
29350 @smallexample
29351 <target version="1.0">
29352 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
29353 </target>
29354 @end smallexample
29355
29356 @noindent
29357 This minimal description only says that the target uses
29358 the x86-64 architecture.
29359
29360 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
29361 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
29362 are explained further below.
29363
29364 @smallexample
29365 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29366 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
29367 <target version="1.0">
29368 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
29369 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
29370 </target>
29371 @end smallexample
29372
29373 @noindent
29374 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
29375 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
29376 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
29377 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
29378 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
29379 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
29380 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
29381 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
29382 the version mismatch.
29383
29384 @subsection Inclusion
29385 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
29386 @cindex XInclude
29387 @ifnotinfo
29388 @cindex <xi:include>
29389 @end ifnotinfo
29390
29391 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
29392 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
29393 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
29394 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
29395 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
29396
29397 @smallexample
29398 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
29399 @end smallexample
29400
29401 @noindent
29402 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
29403 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
29404 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
29405 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
29406 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
29407 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
29408 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
29409 original description.
29410
29411 @subsection Architecture
29412 @cindex <architecture>
29413
29414 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
29415
29416 @smallexample
29417 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
29418 @end smallexample
29419
29420 @var{arch} is an architecture name from the same selection
29421 accepted by @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a
29422 Debugging Target}).
29423
29424 @subsection Features
29425 @cindex <feature>
29426
29427 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
29428 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
29429 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
29430 has this form:
29431
29432 @smallexample
29433 <feature name="@var{name}">
29434 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
29435 @var{reg}@dots{}
29436 </feature>
29437 @end smallexample
29438
29439 @noindent
29440 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
29441 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
29442 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
29443 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
29444
29445 @subsection Types
29446
29447 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
29448 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
29449 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
29450 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
29451 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
29452
29453 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
29454 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
29455 Types must be defined before they are used.
29456
29457 @cindex <vector>
29458 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
29459 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
29460 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
29461 @var{count}:
29462
29463 @smallexample
29464 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
29465 @end smallexample
29466
29467 @cindex <union>
29468 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
29469 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
29470 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
29471 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
29472
29473 @smallexample
29474 <union id="@var{id}">
29475 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
29476 @dots{}
29477 </union>
29478 @end smallexample
29479
29480 @subsection Registers
29481 @cindex <reg>
29482
29483 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
29484
29485 @smallexample
29486 <reg name="@var{name}"
29487 bitsize="@var{size}"
29488 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
29489 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
29490 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
29491 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
29492 @end smallexample
29493
29494 @noindent
29495 The components are as follows:
29496
29497 @table @var
29498
29499 @item name
29500 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
29501
29502 @item bitsize
29503 The register's size, in bits.
29504
29505 @item regnum
29506 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
29507 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
29508 a preceeding feature); the first register in the target description
29509 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
29510 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
29511 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
29512 in order of increasing register number.
29513
29514 @item save-restore
29515 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
29516 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
29517 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
29518 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
29519 ABI.
29520
29521 @item type
29522 The type of the register. @var{type} may be a predefined type, a type
29523 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
29524 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
29525 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
29526 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
29527 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
29528
29529 @item group
29530 The register group to which this register belongs. @var{group} must
29531 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
29532 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
29533 in @code{info registers}.
29534
29535 @end table
29536
29537 @node Predefined Target Types
29538 @section Predefined Target Types
29539 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
29540
29541 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
29542 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
29543 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
29544 types. The currently supported types are:
29545
29546 @table @code
29547
29548 @item int8
29549 @itemx int16
29550 @itemx int32
29551 @itemx int64
29552 @itemx int128
29553 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29554
29555 @item uint8
29556 @itemx uint16
29557 @itemx uint32
29558 @itemx uint64
29559 @itemx uint128
29560 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
29561
29562 @item code_ptr
29563 @itemx data_ptr
29564 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
29565 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
29566 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
29567 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
29568 may be marked as data pointers.
29569
29570 @item ieee_single
29571 Single precision IEEE floating point.
29572
29573 @item ieee_double
29574 Double precision IEEE floating point.
29575
29576 @item arm_fpa_ext
29577 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
29578
29579 @end table
29580
29581 @node Standard Target Features
29582 @section Standard Target Features
29583 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
29584
29585 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
29586 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
29587 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
29588 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
29589 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
29590 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
29591 can recognize them.
29592
29593 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
29594 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
29595 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
29596 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
29597 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
29598 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
29599 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
29600 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
29601
29602 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
29603 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
29604 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
29605
29606 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
29607 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
29608 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
29609 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
29610
29611 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
29612 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
29613 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
29614
29615 @menu
29616 * ARM Features::
29617 * MIPS Features::
29618 * M68K Features::
29619 * PowerPC Features::
29620 @end menu
29621
29622
29623 @node ARM Features
29624 @subsection ARM Features
29625 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
29626
29627 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for ARM targets.
29628 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
29629 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
29630
29631 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
29632 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
29633
29634 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
29635 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
29636 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
29637 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
29638
29639 @node MIPS Features
29640 @subsection MIPS Features
29641 @cindex target descriptions, MIPS features
29642
29643 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for MIPS targets.
29644 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
29645 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
29646 on the target.
29647
29648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
29649 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
29650 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29651
29652 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
29653 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
29654 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
29655 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29656
29657 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
29658 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
29659 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
29660
29661 @node M68K Features
29662 @subsection M68K Features
29663 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
29664
29665 @table @code
29666 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
29667 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
29668 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
29669 One of those features must be always present.
29670 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
29671 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
29672 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
29673 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
29674
29675 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
29676 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
29677 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
29678 @samp{fpiaddr}.
29679 @end table
29680
29681 @node PowerPC Features
29682 @subsection PowerPC Features
29683 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
29684
29685 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
29686 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
29687 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
29688 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
29689
29690 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
29691 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
29692
29693 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
29694 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
29695 and @samp{vrsave}.
29696
29697 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
29698 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
29699 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
29700 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
29701 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
29702 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
29703
29704 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
29705 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
29706 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
29707 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
29708 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
29709 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
29710 user.
29711
29712 @node Operating System Information
29713 @appendix Operating System Information
29714 @cindex operating system information
29715
29716 @menu
29717 * Process list::
29718 @end menu
29719
29720 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
29721 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
29722 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
29723 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
29724 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
29725 on a different aspect of target.
29726
29727 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
29728 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
29729 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
29730 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
29731
29732 @node Process list
29733 @appendixsection Process list
29734 @cindex operating system information, process list
29735
29736 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
29737 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
29738 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
29739 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
29740
29741 An example document is:
29742
29743 @smallexample
29744 <?xml version="1.0"?>
29745 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
29746 <osdata type="processes">
29747 <item>
29748 <column name="pid">1</column>
29749 <column name="user">root</column>
29750 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
29751 </item>
29752 </osdata>
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
29756 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
29757 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
29758 displayed by @value{GDBN}. Target may provide additional columns,
29759 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
29760
29761 @include gpl.texi
29762
29763 @raisesections
29764 @include fdl.texi
29765 @lowersections
29766
29767 @node Index
29768 @unnumbered Index
29769
29770 @printindex cp
29771
29772 @tex
29773 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
29774 % meantime:
29775 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
29776 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
29777 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
29778 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
29779 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
29780 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
29781 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
29782 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
29783 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
29784 \page\colophon
29785 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
29786 @end tex
29787
29788 @bye
This page took 0.697377 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.